Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 User Guide
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 User Guide
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 User Guide
User's Guide
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010. All rights reserved. Acronis and Acronis Secure Zone are registered trademarks of Acronis, Inc. "Acronis Compute with Confidence", Acronis Startup Recovery Manager, Acronis Active Restore and the Acronis logo are trademarks of Acronis, Inc. Linux is a registered trademark of Linus Torvalds. VMware and VMware Ready are trademarks and/or registered trademarks of VMware, Inc. in the United States and/or other jurisdictions. Windows and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. All other trademarks and copyrights referred to are the property of their respective owners. Distribution of substantively modified versions of this document is prohibited without the explicit permission of the copyright holder. Distribution of this work or derivative work in any standard (paper) book form for commercial purposes is prohibited unless prior permission is obtained from the copyright holder. DOCUMENTATION IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND ALL EXPRESS OR IMPLIED CONDITIONS, REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES, INCLUDING ANY IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR NON-INFRINGEMENT, ARE DISCLAIMED, EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT THAT SUCH DISCLAIMERS ARE HELD TO BE LEGALLY INVALID. Third party code may be provided with the Software and/or Service. The license terms for such thirdparties are detailed in the license.txt file located in the root installation directory. You can always find the latest up-to-date list of the third party code and the associated license terms used with the Software and/or Service at http://kb.acronis.com/content/7696
Table of contents
1 Introducing Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 ........................................................................ 7 1.1 1.2 1.3 Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 overview............................................................................ 7 Getting started................................................................................................................. 8
Using the management console.....................................................................................................................10 Agent for Windows ..........................................................................................................................................16 Components for centralized management ...................................................................................................17 Management Console .....................................................................................................................................20 Bootable Media Builder...................................................................................................................................20 Acronis WOL Proxy ..........................................................................................................................................20
1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.9
Supported file systems ................................................................................................... 21 Supported operating systems.......................................................................................... 21 System requirements...................................................................................................... 22 Technical support........................................................................................................... 23 Basic concepts................................................................................................................ 24 Full, incremental and differential backups........................................................................ 28 User privileges on a managed machine ............................................................................ 30 Owners and credentials .................................................................................................. 30 GFS backup scheme ........................................................................................................ 31 Tower of Hanoi backup scheme....................................................................................... 35 Retention rules............................................................................................................... 37 Backing up dynamic volumes (Windows) ......................................................................... 40 Tape support.................................................................................................................. 42
Tape compatibility table..................................................................................................................................42 Using a single tape drive..................................................................................................................................43 Acronis Secure Zone ........................................................................................................................................44 Acronis Startup Recovery Manager ...............................................................................................................45 Universal Restore (Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Universal Restore)......................................................45 Acronis Active Restore.....................................................................................................................................47 Basic concepts ..................................................................................................................................................49 Setting up centralized data protection in a heterogeneous network.........................................................50 Grouping the registered machines.................................................................................................................53 Policies on machines and groups ...................................................................................................................53 Backup policy's state and statuses .................................................................................................................58 Deduplication ...................................................................................................................................................61 Privileges for centralized management .........................................................................................................65 Communication between Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components....................................................70
2.9.1 2.9.2 2.10.1 2.10.2 2.10.3 2.10.4 2.11.1 2.11.2 2.11.3 2.11.4 2.11.5 2.11.6 2.11.7 2.11.8
Time-based alerts.............................................................................................................................................77 Number of tasks ...............................................................................................................................................77 Fonts..................................................................................................................................................................77 Logging level .....................................................................................................................................................78 Log cleanup rules .............................................................................................................................................78 Event tracing.....................................................................................................................................................79 Domain access credentials..............................................................................................................................80 Acronis WOL Proxy ..........................................................................................................................................80 VM protection options ....................................................................................................................................80 Machine management ....................................................................................................................................82 Event tracing.....................................................................................................................................................82 Log cleanup rules .............................................................................................................................................84 Customer Experience Program.......................................................................................................................85 Default backup options ...................................................................................................................................85 Default recovery options...............................................................................................................................107
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.4.1 3.4.2
4.2
4.2.1 4.2.2
4.3
Scheduling......................................................................................................................... 152 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 Daily schedule .............................................................................................................. 153 Weekly schedule .......................................................................................................... 155 Monthly schedule......................................................................................................... 157 Advanced scheduling settings ....................................................................................... 159 At Windows Event Log event......................................................................................... 160 Conditions ................................................................................................................... 162
User is idle.......................................................................................................................................................163 Location's host is available............................................................................................................................163 Fits time interval.............................................................................................................................................164 User logged off...............................................................................................................................................165 Time since last backup...................................................................................................................................165
6.2
6.2.1 6.2.2 6.2.3 6.2.4 6.2.5 6.2.6 6.2.7 6.2.8 6.2.9 6.2.10 6.2.11
6.3
6.3.1 6.3.2 6.3.3 6.3.4 6.3.5 6.3.6 6.3.7 6.3.8 6.3.9 6.3.10 6.3.11 6.3.12
6.4
6.5
6.6 6.7
6.8
6.8.1 6.8.2
6.9
6.10.4 6.10.5 6.10.6 6.11.1 6.11.2 6.11.3 6.11.4 6.11.5 6.11.6 6.11.7
List of commands and utilities available in Linux-based bootable media ................................................245 Recovering MD devices and logical volumes ..............................................................................................246 Acronis PXE Server .........................................................................................................................................250 Basic precautions ...........................................................................................................................................252 Running Acronis Disk Director Lite ...............................................................................................................252 Choosing the operating system for disk management ..............................................................................253 "Disk management" view..............................................................................................................................253 Disk operations...............................................................................................................................................254 Volume operations ........................................................................................................................................259 Pending operations........................................................................................................................................266
6.12 Collecting system information....................................................................................... 266 7 Centralized management ................................................................................................... 267 7.1 Administering Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server ................................. 267
Dashboard ......................................................................................................................................................267 Backup policies ...............................................................................................................................................269 Physical machines ..........................................................................................................................................274 Virtual machines ............................................................................................................................................291 Storage nodes.................................................................................................................................................296 Tasks ................................................................................................................................................................299 Log ...................................................................................................................................................................301 Reporting ........................................................................................................................................................305 Parameters set through administrative template ......................................................................................311 Parameters set through GUI .........................................................................................................................325 Parameters set through Windows registry .................................................................................................325 Policy credentials ...........................................................................................................................................328 Items to back up.............................................................................................................................................329 Access credentials for source........................................................................................................................333 Exclusions........................................................................................................................................................333 Archive ............................................................................................................................................................334 Access credentials for location .....................................................................................................................335 Backup scheme selection..............................................................................................................................336 Archive validation...........................................................................................................................................345 7.1.1 7.1.2 7.1.3 7.1.4 7.1.5 7.1.6 7.1.7 7.1.8
7.2
7.3
8 9
Backup of an entire disk or volume, including the operating system, all applications, and data Bare metal recovery to any hardware File and folder backup and recovery Scalability from a single machine to an enterprise Centralized management for distributed workstations Dedicated servers for storage resource optimization.
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Advanced Workstation offers new benefits that help organizations meet challenging Recovery Time Objectives while reducing both capital expense and software maintenance costs.
Leveraging existing IT infrastructure Data deduplication to reduce storage consumption and network bandwidth utilization Flexible deduplication mechanism allowing deduplication of backup data both at the source and at the storage Improved support for robotic tape libraries Backward compatibility and an easy upgrade from Acronis True Image Echo Highly automated data protection All-round planning of data protection (backup, retention and validation of backups) within a backup policy Built-in Tower of Hanoi and Grandfather-Father-Son backup schemes with customizable parameters A variety of events and conditions can be chosen to trigger a backup Policy-based centralized management Applying backup policies to groups of machines Static and dynamic machine grouping Easy work with virtual environments Conversion of a backup to a fully configured VMware, Microsoft, Parallels, or Citrix virtual machine Redesigned GUI Dashboard for quick operational decision making Overview of all configured and running operations with color-coding for successful and failed operations Enterprise level of security Controlling user rights to perform operations and access backups Running services with minimal user rights
7
Restricted remote access to a backup agent Secure communication between the product components Using third-party certificates for authentication of the components Data encryption options for both data transmission and storage Backup of remote machines to a centralized storage node behind firewalls.
1.2
Getting started
Direct management
1. Install Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console and Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent. 2. Start the console. Windows Start the console by selecting it from the start menu. 3. Connect the console to the machine where the agent is installed. Where to go from here For what to do next see "Basic concepts (p. 24)". For understanding of the GUI elements see "Using the management console (p. 10)".
Centralized management
We recommend that you first try to manage the single machine using direct management as described above.
Backup
Using the Back up control, select the machine which you want to back up and then create a backup plan (p. 348) on the machine. You can create backup plans on multiple machines in turn.
Recovery
Using the Recover control, select the machine where the data recovery is required and create a recovery task on the machine. You can create recovery tasks on multiple machines in turn.
To recover the entire machine or the operating system that fails to start, use the bootable media (p. 349). You cannot control operations under bootable media using the management server, but you can disconnect the console from the server and connect it to the machine booted from the media.
To manage the plans and tasks existing on the registered machines, select Machines > All machines in the Navigation tree and then select each machine in turn. The Information pane below shows the state and the details of plans and tasks existing on each machine and enables you to start, stop, edit, and delete the plans and tasks. You can also use the Tasks view that displays all tasks existing on the registered machines. The tasks can be filtered by machines, backup plans and other parameters. Refer to the context help for details.
Viewing log
To view the centralized log, collected from the registered machines, select Log in the Navigation tree. The log entries can be filtered by machines, backup plans and other parameters. Refer to the context help for details.
If you opt for storing all backup archives in a single or a few networked locations, create centralized vaults in these locations. After a vault is created, you can view and administer its content by selecting Vaults > Centralized > 'Vault name' in the Navigation tree. The shortcut to the vault will be deployed to all the registered machines. The vault can be specified as a backup destination in any backup plan created by you or by the registered machines' users. The advanced way of centralized management To make the best use of the centralized management capabilities offered by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10, you can opt for:
Using deduplication 1. Install Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node (p. 18) and add it to the management server. 2. Create the deduplicating managed vault on the storage node. 3. Install the Acronis Deduplication add-on to the agent on all machines that will back up to the deduplicating vault. 4. Ensure that the backup plans you create use the managed vault as destination for the backup archives. Creating a backup policy rather than backup plans
Set up a centralized backup policy and apply it to the All machines group. This way you will deploy backup plans on each machine with a single action. Select Actions > Create backup policy from the top menu and then refer to the context help.
Group the registered machines by appropriate parameters, create several policies and apply each policy to the appropriate group of machines. For more information please refer to "Grouping the registered machines (p. 53)". The comprehensive example of advanced centralized management is provided in the "Setting up centralized data protection in a heterogeneous network (p. 50)" section.
1.2.1
As soon as the console connects to a managed machine (p. 355) or to a management server (p. 356), the respective items appear across the console's workspace (in the menu, in the main area with the Welcome screen, the Navigation pane, the Actions and tools pane) enabling you to perform agentspecific or server-specific operations.
Menu bar
1024x768 or higher display resolution is required for comfortable work with the management console.
10
"Navigation" pane
The navigation pane includes the Navigation tree and the Shortcuts bar.
Navigation tree
The Navigation tree enables you to navigate across the program views. Views depend on whether the console is connected to a managed machine or to the management server.
[Machine name]. Root of the tree also called a Welcome view. Displays the name of the machine the console is currently connected to. Use this view for quick access to the main operations, available on the managed machine.
Dashboard. Use this view to estimate at a glance whether the data is successfully protected on the managed machine. Backup plans and tasks. Use this view to manage backup plans and tasks on the managed machine: run, edit, stop and delete plans and tasks, view their states and statuses, monitor plans. Vaults. Use this view to manage personal vaults and archives stored in there, add new vaults, rename and delete the existing ones, validate vaults, explore backup content, mount backups as virtual drives, etc. Log. Use this view to examine information on operations performed by the program on the managed machine. Disk management. Use this view to perform operations on the machine's hard disk drives.
[Management server name]. Root of the tree also called a Welcome view. Displays the name of the management server the console is currently connected to. Use this view for quick access to the main operations, available on the management server.
Dashboard. Use this view to estimate at a glance whether the data is successfully protected on the machines registered on the management server. Backup policies. Use this view to manage backup policies existing on the management server. Physical machines. Use this view to manage machines registered on the management server. Vaults. Use this view to manage centralized vaults and archives stored in there: create new managed and unmanaged vaults, rename and delete the existing ones. Storage nodes. Use this view to manage storage nodes. Add a storage node to be able to create centralized vaults that will be managed by the node. Tasks. Use this view to manage tasks, run, edit, stop and delete tasks, monitor their states, examine task history. Log. Use this view to examine the history of centralized management operations, such as creating a managed entities group, applying a policy, managing a centralized vault; as well as
11
the history of operations logged in the local logs of the registered machines and the storage nodes.
Shortcuts bar
The Shortcuts bar appears under the navigation tree. It offers you an easy and convenient way of connection to the machines in demand by adding them as shortcuts.
Bars
'[Item's name]' actions
Contains a set of actions that can be performed on the items selected in any of the navigation views. Clicking the action opens the respective action page (p. 14). Items of different navigation views have their own set of actions. The bar's name changes in accordance with the item you select. For example, if you select the backup plan named System backup in the Backup plans and tasks view, the actions bar will be named as 'System backup' actions and will have the set of actions typical to backup plans. All actions can also be accessed in the respective menu items. A menu item appears on the menu bar when you select an item in any of the navigation views.
Actions
Contains a list of common operations that can be performed on a managed machine or on a management server. Always the same for all views. Clicking the operation opens the respective action page (see the Action pages (p. 14) section.)
12 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
Tools
Contains a list of the Acronis tools. Always the same across all the program views. All the tools can also be accessed in the Tools menu.
"Tools" bar
Help
Contains a list of help topics. Different views and action pages of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 provided with lists of specific help topics.
and action pages according the items you select in the menu, Navigation tree, or on the Actions and Tools pane.
Views
A view appears on the main area when clicking any item in the Navigation tree in the Navigation pane (p. 11).
"Tasks" view
Use filtering and sorting capabilities to search the table for the item in question In the table, select the desired item In the Information panel (collapsed by default), view the item's details Perform actions on the selected item. There are several ways of performing the same action on selected items:
By clicking the buttons on the table toolbar; By clicking in the items in the [Item's name] Actions bar (on the Actions and Tools pane); By selecting the items in the Actions menu; By right-clicking the item and selecting the operation in the context menu.
Action pages
An action page appears in the main area when clicking any action item in the Actions menu, or in the Actions bar on the Actions and tools pane. It contains steps you need to perform in order to create and launch any task, or a backup plan, or backup policy.
14 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 remembers the changes you made on the action pages. For example, if you started to create a backup plan, and then for any reason switched to another view without accomplishing the plan creation, you can click the Back navigation button on the menu. Or, if you have passed several steps forward, click the Down arrow and select the page where you started the plan creation from the list. Thus, you can perform the remaining steps and accomplish the backup plan creation.
15
Navigation buttons
1.3
This section contains a full list of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components with a brief description of their functionality. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 includes the following main types of components.
Console
The console provides Graphical User Interface and remote connection to the agents and other Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components. Usage of the console is not licensed.
1.3.1
Disk backup
This agent enables disk-level and file-level data protection under Windows.
Disk-level data protection is based on backing up either a disk or a volume file system as a whole, along with all the information necessary for the operating system to boot; or all the disk sectors using the sector-by-sector approach (raw mode). A backup that contains a copy of a disk or a volume in a packaged form is called a disk (volume) backup or a disk (volume) image. It is possible to recover disks or volumes as a whole from such backup, as well as individual folders or files.
16
File backup
File-level data protection is based on backing up files and folders residing on the machine where the agent is installed or on a network share. Files can be recovered to their original location or to another place. It is possible to recover all files and folders that were backed up or select which of them to recover.
Other operations
Conversion to a virtual machine Rather than converting a disk backup to a virtual disk file, which requires additional operations to bring the virtual disk into use, Agent for Windows performs the conversion by recovering a disk backup to a new virtual machine of any of the following types: VMware Workstation, Microsoft Virtual PC, Parallels Workstation or Citrix XenServer virtual appliance. Files of the fully configured and operational machine will be placed in the folder you select. You can start the machine using the respective virtualization software or prepare the machine files for further usage. Disk management Agent for Windows includes Acronis Disk Director Lite - a handy disk management utility. Disk management operations, such as cloning disks; converting disks; creating, formatting and deleting volumes; changing a disk partitioning style between MBR and GPT or changing a disk label, can be performed either in the operating system or using bootable media.
Universal Restore
The Universal Restore add-on enables you to use the restore to dissimilar hardware functionality on the machine where the agent is installed, and create bootable media with this functionality. Universal Restore handles differences in devices that are critical for Windows start-up, such as storage controllers, motherboard or chipset.
Deduplication
This add-on enables the agent to back up data to deduplicating vaults managed by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node.
1.3.2
This section lists the components included in the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 editions that provide the centralized management capability. Besides these components, Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agents have to be installed on all machines that need data protection.
Management Server
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server is the central server that drives data protection within the enterprise network. The management server provides the administrator with:
a single entry point to the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 infrastructure an easy way to protect data on numerous machines (p. 355) using backup policies (p. 348) and grouping enterprise-wide monitoring and reporting functionality the ability to create centralized vaults (p. 350) for storing enterprise backup archives (p. 347)
17
If there are multiple management servers on the network, they operate independently, manage different machines and use different centralized vaults for storing archives.
The configuration database that stores the list of registered machines and other configuration information, including backup policies created by the administrator. The synchronization database used for synchronization of the management server with registered machines and storage nodes. This is a database with rapidly changing operational data. The reporting database that stores the centralized log. This database may grow large. Its size depends on the logging level you set.
The configuration and synchronization databases should reside on the same Microsoft SQL Server (called an operational server) preferably installed on the same machine as the management server. The reporting database can be configured on the same or different SQL server. When installing a management server, you can select for both operational and reporting servers what server to use. The following options are available: 1. Microsoft SQL Server 2005 Express that comes with the installation package and installs on the same machine. In this case, an SQL server instance with three databases will be created on the machine. 2. Microsoft SQL Server 2008 (any edition) previously installed on any machine. 3. Microsoft SQL Server 2005 (any edition) previously installed on any machine.
Storage Node
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node is a server aimed to optimize usage of various resources (such as the corporate storage capacity, the network bandwidth, or the managed machines' CPU load) required for the enterprise data protection. This goal is achieved through organizing and managing the locations that serve as dedicated storages of the enterprise backup archives (managed vaults). The storage nodes enable creating highly scalable and flexible, in terms of the hardware support, storage infrastructure. Up to 20 storage nodes can be set up, each being able to manage up to 20 vaults. The administrator controls the storage nodes centrally from the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server (p. 356). Direct console connection to a storage node is not possible.
18
on the hard drives local to the storage node on a network share on a Storage Area Network (SAN) on a Network Attached Storage (NAS) on a tape library locally attached to the storage node.
Deduplication
A managed vault can be configured as a deduplicating vault. This means that identical data will be backed up to this vault only once to minimize the network usage during backup and storage space taken by the archives. For more information, please see the "Deduplication (p. 61)" section in the User Guide.
Encryption
A managed vault can be configured so that anything written to it is encrypted and anything read from it is decrypted transparently by the storage node, using a vault-specific encryption key stored on the node server. In case the storage medium is stolen or accessed by an unauthorized person, the malefactor will not be able to decrypt the vault contents without access to this specific storage node. If the archive is already encrypted by the agent, the storage node-side encryption is applied over the encryption performed by the agent.
PXE Server
Acronis PXE Server allows for booting machines into Acronis bootable components through the network. The network booting:
Eliminates the need to have a technician onsite to install the bootable media (p. 349) into the system that has to be booted
19
During group operations, reduces the time required for booting multiple machines as compared to using physical bootable media.
License Server
The server enables you to manage licenses of Acronis products and install the components that require licenses. For more information about Acronis License Server please see "Using Acronis License Server".
1.3.3
Management Console
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console is an administrative tool for remote or local access to Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agents, and in the product editions that include the centralized management capability, to the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server. The console has two distributions for installation on Windows and installation on Linux. While both distributions enable connection to any Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent and Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server, we recommend that you use the console for Windows if you have a choice between the two. The console that installs on Linux has limited functionality:
remote installation of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components is not available the Active Directory-related features, such as browsing the AD, are not available.
1.3.4
Acronis Bootable Media Builder is a dedicated tool for creating bootable media (p. 349). The media builder that installs on Windows can create bootable media based on either Windows Preinstallation Environment, or Linux kernel. The Universal Restore (p. 17) add-on enables you to create bootable media with the restore to dissimilar hardware functionality. Universal Restore handles differences in devices that are critical for Windows start-up, such as storage controllers, motherboard or chipset. The Deduplication (p. 17) add-on enables you to create bootable media with the back up to a deduplicating vault functionality.
1.3.5
This option works in combination with the Use Wake-On-LAN (p. 159) advanced scheduling setting. Use this option if the management server has to wake up for backup machines located in another subnet. When the scheduled operation is about to start, the management server sends out magic packets to wake up the appropriate machines. (A magic packet is a packet that contains 16 contiguous copies of the receiving NIC's MAC address). The Acronis WOL Proxy, installed in the other subnet, transfers the packets to machines located in that subnet. The preset is: Disabled.
20
2. Enable Acronis WOL Proxy in the Management server options as follows: a. Select the Use the following proxies check box. b. Click Add, and then enter the name or IP address of the machine where the Acronis WOL Proxy is installed. Provide access credentials for the machine. c. Repeat this step if there are several Acronis WOL Proxies. 3. When scheduling a backup policy, enable the Use Wake-On-LAN setting. You also have the ability to delete proxies from the list. Please keep in mind that any change to this option affects the entire management server. If you delete a proxy from the list, the Wake-On-LAN functionality in the corresponding subnet will be disabled for all policies, including the policies already applied.
1.4
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 can back up and recover the following file systems with the following limitations: FAT16/32 NTFS Ext2/Ext3 ReiserFS3 - particular files cannot be recovered from disk backups located on Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node ReiserFS4 - volume recovery without the volume resize capability; particular files cannot be recovered from disk backups located on Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node XFS - volume recovery without the volume resize capability; particular files cannot be recovered from disk backups located on Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node JFS - particular files cannot be recovered from disk backups located on Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node Linux SWAP
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 can back up and recover corrupted or non-supported file systems using the sector-by-sector approach.
1.5
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server and Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node
* Windows 2000 Professional SP4/XP Professional SP2+ Windows 2000 Server/2000 Advanced Server/Server 2003/Server 2008* Windows SBS 2003/SBS 2008* Windows XP Professional x64 Edition, Windows Server 2003/2008* x64 Editions Windows Vista - all editions except for Vista Home Basic and Vista Home Premium Windows 7 - all editions except for the Starter and Home editions* Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node handles tape libraries and autoloaders by using Removable Storage Management (RSM). Since Windows Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7 do not support RSM, a storage node installed in these operating systems does not support tape libraries and autoloaders.
Remote connection to the agen t installed on the Sta rter and Ho me editions is not possible.
1.6
System requirements
Memory (above the OS and running applications) 300 MB Disk space required Disk space occupied Additional during installation or by the component(s) update 2.7 GB 1.7 GB including SQL Express Server
Complete installation
120 MB 80 MB 30 MB
260 MB 300 MB 450 MB CD-RW or DVDRW drive Screen resolution 1024*768 pixels or higher
Management Server
40 MB
Wake-on-LAN Proxy
Negligible
30 MB
22
Storage Node
100 MB
150 MB
150 MB When using a tape library, space required for tapes database: approx. 1 MB per 10 archives
Negligible 5 MB
25 MB 80 MB
25 MB 15 MB
Network interface card or virtual network adapter is a common requirement for all the components.
Bootable media
Media type Based on Windows PE Linux-based Memory 512 MB 256 MB ISO image size 300 MB 130 MB Additional
1.7
Technical support
As part of a purchased annual Support charge you are entitled to Technical Support as follows: to the extent that electronic services are available, you may electronically access at no additional charge, Support services for the Software, which Acronis shall endeavor to make available twenty four (24) hours a day, seven (7) days per week. Such electronic services may include, but are not limited to: user forums; software-specific information; hints and tips; bug fix retrieval via the internet; software maintenance and demonstration code retrieval via a WAN-accessible FTP server; and access to a problem resolution database via Acronis customer support system. Support shall consist of supplying telephone or other electronic support to you in order to help you locate and, on its own, correct problems with the Software and supplying patches, updates and other changes that Acronis, at its sole discretion, makes or adds to the Software and which Acronis makes generally available, without additional charge, to other licensees of the Software that are enrolled in Support. Upon mutual agreement by both parties, Acronis shall: (i) supply code corrections to you to correct Software malfunctions in order to bring such Software into substantial conformity with the published operating specifications for the most current version of the Software unless your unauthorized modifications prohibit or hamper such corrections or cause the malfunction; or (ii) supply code corrections to correct insubstantial problems at the next general release of the Software. More information about contacting Acronis Technical Support is available at the following link: http://www.acronis.com/enterprise/support/
23
2.1
Basic concepts
Please familiarize yourself with the basic notions used in the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 graphical user interface and documentation. Advanced users are welcome to use this section as a step-by-step quick start guide. The details can be found in the context help.
24
The following diagram illustrates the notions discussed above. For more definitions please refer to the Glossary.
25
You also specify the destination where to recover the data. You can customize the recovery operation using recovery options, such as pre/post recovery commands, error handling or notification options.
26
The following diagram illustrates data recovery under the operating system (online). No backup can proceed on the machine while the recovery operation is taking place. If required, you can connect the console to another machine and configure a recovery operation on that machine. This ability (remote parallel recovery) first appeared in Acronis Backup & Recovery 10; the previous Acronis products do not provide it.
27
If the machine fails to boot or you need to recover data to bare metal, you boot the machine using the bootable media and configure the recovery operation in the same way as the recovery task. The following diagram illustrates the recovery using the bootable media.
2.2
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 provides the capability to use popular backup schemes, such as Grandfather-Father-Son and Tower of Hanoi, as well as to create custom backup schemes. All backup schemes are based on full, incremental and differential backup methods. The term "scheme" in fact denotes the algorithm of applying these methods plus the algorithm of the archive cleanup. Comparing backup methods with each other does not make much sense because the methods work as a team in a backup scheme. Each method should play its specific role according to its advantages. A competent backup scheme will benefit from the advantages of all backup methods and lessen the influence of all the methods shortcomings. For example, weekly differential backup facilitates archive cleanup because it can be easily deleted along with the weekly set of daily incremental backups depending on it. Backing up with the full, incremental or differential backup method results in a backup (p. 347) of the corresponding type.
Full backup
A full backup stores all data selected for backup. A full backup underlies any archive and forms the base for incremental and differential backups. An archive can contain multiple full backups or consist of only full backups. A full backup is self-sufficient - you do not need access to any other backup to recover data from a full backup.
28
It is widely accepted that a full backup is the slowest to do but the fastest to restore. With Acronis technologies, recovery from an incremental backup may be not slower than recovery from a full one. A full backup is most useful when:
you need to roll back the system to its initial state this initial state does not change often, so there is no need for regular backup.
Example: An Internet cafe, school or university lab where the administrator often undoes changes made by the students or guests but rarely updates the reference backup (in fact, after installing software updates only). The backup time is not crucial in this case and the recovery time will be minimal when recovering the systems from the full backup. The administrator can have several copies of the full backup for additional reliability.
Incremental backup
An incremental backup stores changes to the data against the latest backup. You need access to other backups from the same archive to recover data from an incremental backup. An incremental backup is most useful when:
you need the possibility to roll back to any one of multiple saved states the data changes tend to be small as compared to the total data size.
It is widely accepted that incremental backups are less reliable than full ones because if one backup in the "chain" is corrupted, the next ones can no longer be used. However, storing multiple full backups is not an option when you need multiple prior versions of your data, because reliability of an oversized archive is even more questionable. Example: Backing up a database transaction log.
Differential backup
A differential backup stores changes to the data against the latest full backup. You need access to the corresponding full backup to recover the data from a differential backup. A differential backup is most useful when:
you are interested in saving only the most recent data state the data changes tend to be small as compared to the total data size.
The typical conclusion is: "differential backups take longer to do and are faster to restore, while incremental ones are quicker to do and take longer to restore." In fact, there is no physical difference between an incremental backup appended to a full backup and a differential backup appended to the same full backup at the same point of time. The above mentioned difference implies creating a differential backup after (or instead of) creating multiple incremental backups.
An incremental o r differential ba ckup created after disk defragmentation might be considerably la rger than usual because defragmen tation changes file loca tions on the disk and th e backup reflects these changes. It is reco mmended that you re-create a full ba ckup after disk defragmen tation.
The following table summarizes the advantages and shortcomings of each backup type as they appear based on common knowledge. In real life, these parameters depend on numerous factors such as the amount, speed and pattern of data changes; the nature of the data, the physical specifications of the devices, the backup/recovery options you set, to name a few. Practice is the best guide to selecting the optimal backup scheme.
Parameter Full backup Differential backup Incremental backup
29
2.3
When managing a machine running Windows, the scope of a user's management rights depends on the user's privileges on the machine. Regular users A regular user, such as a member of the Users group, has the following management rights:
Perform file-level backup and recovery of the files that the user has permissions to accessbut without using a file-level backup snapshot. Create backup plans and tasks and manage them. Viewbut not managebackup plans and tasks created by other users. View the local event log.
Administrative users A user who has administrative privileges on the machine, such as a member of the Administrators or Backup Operators group, additionally has the following management rights:
Back up and recover the entire machine or any data on the machine, with or without using a disk snapshot. View and manage backup plans and tasks owned by any user on the machine.
2.4
This section explains the concept of owner and the meaning of a backup plan's (or task's) credentials.
Click Cancel and create your own plan or task. The original task will remain intact. Continue editing. You will have to enter all credentials required for the plan or task execution.
Archive owner
An archive owner is the user who saved the archive to the destination. To be more precise, this is the user whose account was specified when creating the backup plan in the Where to back up step. By default, the plan's credentials are used.
2.5
This section covers implementation of the Grandfather-Father-Son (GFS) backup scheme in Acronis Backup & Recovery 10. With this backup scheme you are not allowed to back up more often than once a day. The scheme enables you to mark out the daily, weekly and monthly cycles in your daily backup schedule and set the retention periods for the daily, monthly and weekly backups. The daily backups are referred to as sons; weekly backups are referred to as fathers; the longest lived monthly backups are called grandfathers.
31
how many tapes you need to enable recovery with the desired resolution (time interval between recovery points) and roll-back period which tapes you should overwrite with the forthcoming backup.
Tape rotation schemes enable you to get by with the minimal number of cartridges and not to be buried in used tapes. A lot of Internet sources describe varieties of the GFS tape rotation scheme. You are free to use any of the varieties when backing up to a locally attached tape device.
GFS by Acronis
With Acronis Backup & Recovery 10, you can easily set up a backup plan that will regularly back up data and clean up the resulting archive according to the GFS scheme. Create the backup plan as usual. For the backup destination, choose any storage device where automatic cleanup can be performed, such as an HDD-based storage device or robotic tape library. (Since the space freed on the tape after cleanup cannot be reused until all the tape becomes free, take into account additional considerations when using GFS on a tape library (p. 133).) The following is an explanation of the settings that are specific for the GFS backup scheme.
Weekly/Monthly This step forms the daily, weekly and monthly cycles in the schedule. Select a day of the week from the days selected in the previous step. Each 1st, 2nd and 3rd backup created on this day of the week will be considered as a weekly backup. Each 4th backup created on this day of the week will be considered as a monthly backup. Backups created on the other days will be considered as daily backups. Assume you select Friday for Weekly/Monthly backup. Here is the total schedule marked out according to the selection. D stands for the backup that is considered Daily. W stands for the backup that is considered Weekly. M stands for the backup that is considered Monthly.
The schedule marked out according to the GFS scheme. Schedule: Workdays at 8:00 PM Weekly/Monthly: Friday
32
Acronis uses incremental and differential backups that help save storage space and optimize the cleanup so that consolidation is not needed. In terms of backup methods, weekly backup is differential (Dif), monthly backup is full (F) and daily backup is incremental (I). The first backup is always full. The Weekly/Monthly parameter splits the total schedule into daily, weekly and monthly schedules. Assume you select Friday for Weekly/Monthly backup. Here is the real schedule of the backup tasks that will be created.
Backup t asks created according to the GFS scheme by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10. Schedule: Workdays at 8:00 PM Weekly/Monthly: Friday
Keep backups: Daily This step defines the retention rule for daily backups. The cleanup task will run after each daily backup and delete all daily backups that are older than you specify. Keep backups: Weekly This step defines the retention rule for weekly backups. The cleanup task will run after each weekly backup and delete all weekly backups that are older than you specify. The weekly backups' retention period cannot be less than the daily backups' retention period. It is usually set several times longer. Keep backups: Monthly This step defines the retention rule for monthly backups. The cleanup task will run after each monthly backup and delete all monthly backups that are older than you specify. The monthly backups retention period cannot be less than the weekly backups retention period. It is usually set several times longer. You have the option to keep the monthly backups infinitely.
33
An ideal archive created according to the GFS scheme. Schedule: Workdays at 8:00 PM Weekly/Monthly: Friday Keep daily backups: 7 days Keep weekly backups: 2 weeks Keep monthly backups: 6 months
Starting from the third week, weekly backups will be regularly deleted. After 6 months, monthly backups will start to be deleted. The diagram for weekly and monthly backups will look similar to the week-based timescale.
34
An archive created according to the GFS scheme by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10. Schedule: Workdays at 8:00 PM Weekly/Monthly: Friday Keep daily backups: 7 days Keep weekly backups: 2 weeks Keep monthly backups: 6 months
2.6
The need to have frequent backups always conflicts with the cost of keeping such backups for a long time. The Tower of Hanoi (ToH) backup scheme is a useful compromise.
35
For example, if there are five rings labeled A, B, C, D, and E in the puzzle, the solution gives the following order of moves:
The Tower of Hanoi backup scheme is based on the same patterns. It operates with Sessions instead of Moves and with Backup levels instead of Rings. Commonly an N-level scheme pattern contains (Nth power of two) sessions. So, the five-level Tower of Hanoi backup scheme cycles the pattern that consists of 16 sessions (moves from 1 to 16 in the above figure). The table shows the pattern for the five-level backup scheme. The pattern consists of 16 sessions.
The Tower of Hanoi backup scheme implies keeping only one backup per level. All the outdated backups have to be deleted. So the scheme allows for efficient data storage: more backups accumulate toward the present time. Having four backups, you can recover data as of today, yesterday, half a week ago, or a week ago. For the five-level scheme you can also recover data backed up two weeks ago. So every additional backup level doubles the maximal roll-back period for your data.
36
up to 16 backup levels incremental backups on first level (A) - to gain time and storage savings for the most frequent backup operations; but data recovery from such backups takes longer because it generally requires access to three backups full backups on the last level (E for five-level pattern) - the rarest backups in the scheme, take more time and occupy more space in storage differential backups on all intermediate levels (B, C and D for five-level pattern) the pattern starts with a full backup since the very first backup cannot be incremental
the scheme forces every backup level to keep only the most recent backup, other backups from the level have to be deleted; however backup deletion is postponed in cases where the backup is a base for another incremental or differential one an old backup on a level is kept until a new backup has been successfully created on the level.
The table shows the pattern for the five-level backup scheme. The pattern consists of 16 sessions.
As a result of using incremental and differential backups the situation may arise when an old backup deletion must be postponed as it still is a base for other backups. The table below indicates the case when deletion of full backup (E) created at session 1 is postponed at session 17 until session 25 because the differential backup (D) created at session 9 is still actual. In the table all cells with deleted backups are grayed out:
Differential backup (D) created at session 9 will be deleted at session 25 after creation of a new differential backup is completed. This way, a backup archive created in accordance with the Tower of Hanoi scheme by Acronis sometimes includes up to two additional backups over the classical implementation of the scheme. For information about using Tower of Hanoi for tape libraries, see Using the Tower of Hanoi tape rotation scheme (p. 139).
2.7
Retention rules
The backups produced by a backup plan make an archive. The two retention rules described in this section enable you to limit the archive size and set the lifetime (retention period) of the backups. The retention rules are effective if the archive contains more than one backup. This means that the last backup in the archive will be kept, even if a retention rule violation is detected. Please do not try to delete the only backup you have by applying the retention rules before backup. This will not work. Use the alternative setting Clean up archive > When there is insufficient space while backing up (p. 195) if you accept the risk of losing the last backup.
to this interval and deletes all backups created before that moment. None of the backups created after this moment will be deleted.
There is a certain risk that all but one backup will be deleted if the maximum archive size is set improperly (too small) or a regular backup turns out to be too large. To protect the recent backups from deletion, select the Never delete backups younger than check box and specify the maximum age of backups that must be retained. The diagram below illustrates the resulting rule.
38
Example Delete backups older than = 3 Months Keep the archive size within = 200GB Never delete backups younger than = 10 Days
Every time the retention rules are applied, the program will delete all backups created more than 3 months (or more exactly, 90 days) ago. If after the deletion the archive size is more than 200GB, and the oldest backup is older than 10 days, the program will delete that backup. Then, if necessary, the next old backup will be deleted, until the archive size decreases to the preset limit or the oldest backup age reaches 10 days.
Retain the backup until all dependent backups become subject to deletion The outdated backup will be kept until all backups that depend on it also become outdated. Then all the chain will be deleted at once during the regular cleanup. This mode helps to avoid the potentially time-consuming consolidation but requires extra space for storing backups whose deletion is postponed. The archive size and/or the backup age can exceed the values you specify. Consolidate the backup The program will consolidate the backup that is subject to deletion with the next dependent backup. For example, the retention rules require to delete a full backup but retain the next incremental one. The backups will be combined into a single full backup which will be dated the incremental backup date. When an incremental or differential backup from the middle of the chain is deleted, the resulting backup type will be incremental. This mode ensures that after each cleanup the archive size and the backups age are within the bounds you specify. The consolidation, however, may take a lot of time and system resources. And you still need some extra space in the vault for temporary files created during consolidation. What you need to know about consolidation
39
Please be aware that consolidation is just a method of deletion but not an alternative to deletion. The resulting backup will not contain data that was present in the deleted backup and was absent from the retained incremental or differential backup. Backups resulting from consolidation always have maximum compression. This means that all backups in an archive may acquire the maximum compression as a result of repeated cleanup with consolidation.
Best practices
Maintain the balance between the storage device capacity, the restrictive parameters you set and the cleanup frequency. The retention rules logic assumes that the storage device capacity is much more than the average backup size and the maximum archive size does not come close to the physical storage capacity, but leaves a reasonable reserve. Due to this, exceeding the archive size that may occur between the cleanup task runs will not be critical for the business process. The rarer the cleanup runs, the more space you need to store backups that outlive their lifetime. The Vaults (p. 115) page provides you with information about free space available in each vault. Check this page from time to time. If the free space (which in fact is the storage device free space) approaches zero, you might need to toughen the restrictions for some or all archives residing in this vault.
2.8
This section explains in brief how to back up and recover dynamic volumes (p. 354) using Acronis Backup & Recovery 10. Basic disks that use the GUID Partition Table (GPT) are also discussed. Dynamic volume is a volume located on dynamic disks (p. 352), or more exactly, on a disk group (p. 352). Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 supports the following dynamic volume types/RAID levels:
simple/spanned striped (RAID 0) mirrored (RAID 1) a mirror of stripes (RAID 0+1) RAID 5.
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 can back up and recover dynamic volumes and, with minor limitations, basic GPT volumes.
This will back up DYN1 and DYN2 volumes to the Acronis Secure Zone.
trueimagecmd /create /harddisk:DYN /asz
This will back up all dynamic volumes in the system to the Acronis Secure Zone. The boot code on basic GPT volumes is not backed up or recovered.
40
over any type of existing volume to unallocated space of a disk group to unallocated space of a basic disk. When a dynamic volume is recovered over an existing volume, either basic or dynamic, the target volumes data is overwritten with the backup content. The type of target volume (basic, simple/spanned, striped, mirrored, RAID 0+1, RAID 5) will not change. The target volume size has to be enough to accommodate the backup content.
Recovery to disk group unallocated space When a dynamic volume is recovered to disk group unallocated space, both the type and the content of the resulting volume are recovered. The unallocated space size has to be enough to accommodate the backup content. The way unallocated space is distributed among the disks is also important. Example Striped volumes consume equal portions of space on each disk. Assume you are going to recover a 30GB striped volume to a disk group consisting of two disks. Each disk has volumes and a certain amount of unallocated space. The total size of unallocated space is 40GB. The recovery will always result in a striped volume if the unallocated space is distributed evenly among the disks (20GB and 20GB). If one of the disks has 10GB and the other has 30GB of unallocated space, then the recovery result depends on the size of the data being recovered.
If the data size is less than 20GB, then one disk can hold, say, 10GB; the other will hold the remaining 10GB. This way, a striped volume will be created on both disks and 20GB on the second disk will remain unallocated. If the data size is more than 20GB, the data cannot be distributed evenly between the two disks, but can fit into a single simple volume. A simple volume accommodating all the data will be created on the second disk. The first disk will remain untouched.
Backed up (source):
Dynamic volume Dynamic volume Type as of the target Dynamic volume Type as of the source Basic MBR volume Basic GPT volume Basic MBR volume
Basic MBR volume Dynamic volume Type as of the target Dynamic volume Simple Basic MBR volume Basic GPT volume Basic MBR volume
Basic MBR volume Basic GPT volume Unallocated space (basic MBR disk)
41
Moving and resizing volumes during recovery You can resize the resulting basic volume, both MBR and GPT, during recovery, or change the volume's location on the disk. A resulting dynamic volume cannot be moved or resized.
2.9
Tape support
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 supports tape libraries, autoloaders, SCSI and USB tape drives as storage devices. A tape device can be locally attached to a managed machine (in this case, the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent writes and reads the tapes) or accessed through the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node (p. 18). Storage nodes ensure fully automatic operation of tape libraries and autoloaders (p. 123). Backup archives created using different ways of access to tape have different formats. A tape written by a storage node cannot be read by an agent. Linux-based and PE-based bootable media allow for backup and recovery using both local access and access through the storage node. Backups created using the bootable media can be recovered with the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent running in the operating system.
2.9.1
The following table summarizes the readability of tapes written by Acronis True Image Echo and Acronis True Image 9.1 product families in Acronis Backup & Recovery 10. The table also illustrates the compatibility of tapes written by various components of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10.
...is readable on a tape device attached to a machine with... ABR10 Bootable Media + + + + + ABR10 Agent for Windows + + + + + ABR10 Agent for Linux + + + + + ABR10 Storage Node + + + + +
Bootable Media
Agent for
42
library) by...
Windows
Backup Server
Storage Node
ATIE 9.5 ATIE 9.7 ABR10 ATIE 9.1 ATIE 9.5 ATIE 9.7 ABR10 ATIE 9.1 ATIE 9.5 ATIE 9.7 ABR10
+ + + + + + -
+ + + + + + -
+ + + + + + -
+ + + + + + + + + + +
2.9.2
A tape drive that is locally attached to a managed machine can be used by local backup plans as a storage device. The functionality of a locally attached autoloader or tape library is limited to the ordinary tape drive. This means that the program can only work with the currently mounted tape and you have to mount tapes manually.
43
2.10.1
Acronis Secure Zone is a secure partition that enables keeping backup archives on a managed machine disk space and therefore recovery of a disk to the same disk where the backup resides. Certain Windows applications, such as Acronis disk management tools, can access the zone. Should the disk experience a physical failure, the zone and the archives located there will be lost. That's why Acronis Secure Zone should not be the only location where a backup is stored. In enterprise environments, Acronis Secure Zone can be thought of as an intermediate location used for backup when an ordinary location is temporarily unavailable or connected through a slow or busy channel.
Advantages
Acronis Secure Zone:
Enables recovery of a disk to the same disk where the disk's backup resides. Offers a cost-effective and handy method for protecting data from software malfunction, virus attack, operator error. Being an internal archive storage, eliminates the need for a separate media or network connection to back up or recover the data. This is especially useful for mobile users. Can serve as a primary destination when using dual destination (p. 101) backup.
Limitation
The zone cannot be organized on a dynamic disk or a disk using the GPT partitioning style.
44
list archives located in the zone and backups contained in each archive examine a backup's content
mount a disk backup to copy files from the backup to a physical disk safely delete archives and backups from the archives.
For more information about operations available in Acronis Secure Zone, see the Personal vaults (p. 145) section.
2.10.2
A modification of the bootable agent (p. 349) can be placed on a system disk and configured to start at boot time when F11 is pressed. This eliminates the need for rescue media or network connection to start the bootable rescue utility. This feature has the trade name "Acronis Startup Recovery Manager". Acronis Startup Recovery Manager is especially useful for mobile users. If a failure occurs, the user reboots the machine, hits F11 on prompt "Press F11 for Acronis Startup Recovery Manager" and performs data recovery in the same way as with ordinary bootable media. The user can also back up using Acronis Startup Recovery Manager, while on the move. On machines with the GRUB boot loader installed, the user selects the Acronis Startup Recovery Manager from the boot menu instead of pressing F11.
Limitation
Acronis Startup Recovery Manager requires re-activation of third-party loaders after activation.
2.10.3
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Universal Restore is the Acronis proprietary technology that helps recover and boot up Windows on dissimilar hardware or a virtual machine. The Universal Restore handles differences in devices that are critical for the operating system start-up, such as storage controllers, motherboard or chipset.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 45
2. Manual selection of the mass storage device driver. If the target hardware has a specific mass storage controller (such as a SCSI, RAID, or Fibre Channel adapter) for the hard disk, you can install the appropriate driver manually, bypassing the automatic driver search-and-install procedure. 3. Installing drivers for Plug and Play devices. Universal Restore relies on the built-in Plug and Play discovery and configuration process to handle hardware differences in devices that are not critical for the system start, such as video, audio and USB. Windows takes control over this process during the logon phase, and if some of the new hardware is not detected, you will have a chance to install drivers for it later manually.
46
profiles. If you are going to change the above settings on a recovered system, you can prepare the system with Sysprep, image it and recover, if need be, using the Universal Restore.
Limitations
Universal Restore is not available:
when a computer is booted with Acronis Startup Recovery Manager (using F11) or the backup image is located in the Acronis Secure Zone or when using Acronis Active Restore,
because these features are primarily meant for instant data recovery on the same machine. Universal Restore is not available when recovering Linux.
2.10.4
Active Restore is the Acronis proprietary technology that brings a system online immediately after the system recovery is started. Customers familiar with Acronis Recovery for Microsoft Exchange can note that this product uses Active Restore to achieve immediate availability of an Exchange information store after starting the recovery. While based on the same technology, recovery of the Information Store proceeds in quite a different way than the operating system recovery described in this section.
Limitation
The only supported archive location is a local drive, or more precisely, any device available through the machines BIOS. This may be Acronis Secure Zone, a USB hard drive, a flash drive or any internal hard drive.
How it works
When configuring a recovery operation, you select disks or volumes to recover from a backup. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 scans the selected disks or volumes in the backup. If this scan finds a supported operating system, the Acronis Active Restore option becomes available. If you do not enable the option, the system recovery will proceed in the usual way and the machine will become operational after the recovery is completed. If you enable the option, the sequence of actions will be set as follows. Once the system recovery is started, the operating system boots from the backup. The machine becomes operational and ready to provide necessary services. The data required to serve incoming requests is recovered with the highest priority; everything else is recovered in the background.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 47
Because serving requests is performed simultaneously with recovery, the system operation can slow down even if recovery priority in the recovery options is set to Low. This way, the system downtime is reduced to a minimum at the cost of a temporary performance downgrade.
Usage scenarios
1. The system uptime is one of the efficiency criteria. Examples: Client-oriented online services, Web-retailers, polling stations. 2. The system/storage space ratio is heavily biased toward storage. Some machines are being used as storage facilities, where the operating system claims a small space segment and all other disk space is committed to storage, such as movies, sounds or other multimedia files. Some of these storage volumes can be extremely large as compared to the system and so practically all the recovery time will be dedicated to recovering the files, which might be used much later on, if in any near future at all. If you opt for Acronis Active Restore, the system will be operational in a short time. Users will be able to open the necessary files from the storage and use them while the rest of the files, which are not immediately necessary, are being recovered in the background. Examples: movie collection storage, music collection storage, multimedia storage.
How to use
1. Back up the system disk or volume to a location accessible through the systems BIOS. This may be Acronis Secure Zone, a USB hard drive, a flash drive or any internal hard drive.
If your opera ting system and its loader resid e on different volumes, always include both volu mes in the backup. The volumes must also be recovered together; o therwise there is a high risk that the operating system will no t sta rt.
2. Create bootable media. 3. If a system failure occurs, boot the machine using the bootable media. Start the console and connect to the bootable agent. 4. Configure the system recovery: select the system disk or volume and select the Use Acronis Active Restore check box.
Acronis Active Resto re will choose for th e boot-up and subsequent recovery the first operating system found during the backup scan. Do not try to recover more than one opera ting system using Active Resto re if you want the result to be p redictable. When recovering a multi-boo t system, choose only one system volume and boot volume at a time.
5. Once the system recovery is started, the operating system boots from the backup. The Acronis Active Restore icon appears in the system tray. The machine becomes operational and ready to provide necessary services. The immediate user sees the drive tree and icons and can open files or launch applications even though they were not yet recovered. The Acronis Active Restore drivers intercept system queries and set the immediate priority for recovery of the files that are necessary to serve the incoming requests. While this on-the-fly recovery proceeds, the continuing recovery process is transferred to the background.
If you try to log off, shut down o r hibernate th e ma chine using the Start Menu commands, the end of the current session will be auto matically postponed until th e recovery is completed. Should you decide to switch off the ma chine with the Po wer button though, all the changes made to the system sin ce th e last boot up would be lost, the system will not be recovered, not even partially, and the only possible solu tion in this case will be to start th e recovery pro cess anew, from a bootable media .
6. The background recovery continues until all the selected volumes are recovered, the log entry is made and the Acronis Active Restore icon disappears from the system tray.
48
2.11.1
Basic concepts
backup traffic and saving storage space. The storage node also undertakes operations with archives (such as validation and cleanup), which otherwise are performed by the agent, and thus relieves the managed machines from unnecessary computing load. Last but not least, Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node enables using a tape library as a centralized vault for storing backup archives. More than one storage node, each managing a number of vaults, can be set up and controlled centrally from the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server. For more detailed information about storage nodes please refer to Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node (p. 18).
2.11.2
Assume that the network infrastructure includes servers (1, 2, 9) and workstations (3, 5-8) running Windows and Linux. You also have a VMware ESX server (4) that hosts two guest systems. You have to protect each server as a whole, the users' data on the workstations, and the virtual machines. You want to be able to track the health of the data protection, be sure that the backup archives do not store duplicated information and that the obsolete backups are deleted from the storage in a timely manner. These goals can be achieved by regular backup of the desired data items to a centralized vault with deduplication.
50
3. Install Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent on each of the machines to back up the machine's disks, volumes or files. Agent (L) - Agent for Linux. When installing the agents, register each of the machines on the management server. To do so, enter the server's name or IP address and the server's administrator credentials in the appropriate window of the installation wizard. Or, alternatively, add the machines to the management server later using their names or IP addresses. 4. Install Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for ESX/ESXi [Agent (ESX)] on the ESX server (4) to back up the virtual machines from the host. The agent is delivered as a virtual appliance. 5. Install Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node [ASN] on one of the Windows servers (9). The storage node enables you to organize the infrastructure for storing backup archives and to use the deduplication functionality. The node can be installed together with the management server if the host is capable enough. When installing the storage node, register it on the management server in the same way as you register the agents. Installation tips
Both AMS and ASN can be installed on a workstation operating system as well. There can be multiple storage nodes on the network. Each of the nodes can manage up to 20 local or remote vaults. Multiple Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components can be installed on a machine with a single installation procedure. In an Active Directory domain, you can deploy the components using the Group Policy.
If the node is included in an Active Directory domain, all the domain users will be able to back up to the node; and all the domain administrators will become node administrators.
In a workgroup, create a local user account for each user that will back up to the node. Members of the Administrators group become node administrators. You can add more accounts later as required. 1. Run the console, connect to the management server. 2. Create a managed vault as described in Operations with centralized vaults (p. 118). Enable deduplication when creating a managed vault.
51
before relocation, etc. In our example, there is no need to back up entire servers on a regular basis. You can manually delete old backups since they are not numerous. 1. Create a policy that backs up [All Volumes] to the managed vault on the storage node. Choose Back up later, manual start and Full backup type. 2. Create a static group named, say, S_1. Add all the servers to this group. (A storage node can be added in case the managed vault is not on the local node's drives. Otherwise the archive storage will be backed up to itself). 3. Apply the policy to the S_1 group. Make sure that the policy has been successfully deployed to each of the servers. The policy deployment state has to change from Deploying to Deployed and its status has to be OK. To see the resulting backup plans on each of the servers: a. navigate to the All machines group or the S_1 group b. select the server c. select the Backup plans and tasks tab on the Information pane. When you need and have the opportunity to back up any of the servers, navigate to the backup plan as described above, select the plan and run it.
Connect the console to the virtual appliance (Agent for ESX/ESXi) and create a backup plan that will back up all or some of the virtual machines. Connect the console to the virtual appliance (Agent for ESX/ESXi) and create an individual backup plan for each machine. The plan will back up the volumes you specify. Register the virtual appliance (Agent for ESX/ESXi) on the management server. All virtual machines, except for the virtual appliance, will appear in the All virtual machines group. You can group these machines and apply any policy that backs up disks or volumes to them. Install Agent for Windows or Agent for Linux on each virtual machine. Register the machines on the management server. The machines will be considered as physical machines. You can apply a backup policy to these machines or create a backup plan on each machine separately. If any of the machines meets membership criteria set for a dynamic group of physical machines, the machine will be protected by the policy applied to this group.
Advanced product editions other than Virtual Edition (Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Advanced Server, Advanced Server SBS Edition and Advanced Workstation) allow using only the last of the above methods.
2.11.3
As soon as a machine is registered (p. 357) on the management server, the machine appears in the All machines built-in group (p. 349). By applying a backup policy to this group, you protect all the registered machines. The thing is that a single policy may not be satisfactory because of the different roles of the machines. The backed up data is specific for each department; some data has to be backed up frequently, other - twice a year; so you may want to create various policies applicable to different sets of machines. In this case consider creating custom groups.
2.11.4
This section helps you understand the automatic deployment and revoking policies performed by the management server when a policy or a number of policies are applied to machines and nested groups of machines in various combinations; when a policy is revoked from machines and groups; when a machine or a group is moved from one group to another. Operations with groups to which backup policies are applied will result in changing the policies on the member machines. On any hierarchy change, that is, when moving, removing, creating groups; adding machines to static groups; or when machines enter a group based on dynamic criteria, a huge number of inheritance changes may occur. Please familiarize yourself with this section to be sure that your actions yield the desired result and to understand the result of the automated Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server operations.
53
Revoking a policy is the reverse action to the aggregate of applying and deploying. Revoking removes the correspondence between the policy and one or more machines and then removes the tasks from the machines. If a machine is not available or not reachable at the moment, the change will be propagated on the machine when it becomes available. This means that deploying a policy to multiple machines is not a momentary action. The same is true for revoking. These two processes may be durable and so the management server tracks and displays personal statuses for each machine that it works with, as well as the policy's cumulative status.
Policy on a machine
Policy on a group
1. 2. 3. 4.
A policy can be applied to a group. A policy can be revoked from a group. A policy applied to a group cannot be revoked from a machine. To revoke the policy from the machine, remove the machine from the group.
1. The same policy can be applied to a group and to a machine. Nothing changes on the machine at the second application of the same policy, but the server remembers that the policy has been applied twice.
54
2. A policy, revoked from the group, remains on the machine. 3. A policy, revoked from the machine, remains on the group and therefore on the machine. 4. To completely revoke the policy from the machine, revoke it from both the group and the machine.
55
Inheritance of policies
Policy inheritance can be easily understood if we assume that a machine can be a member of only one group besides the All machines group. Let's start from this simplified approach. In the diagram below, the container stands for a group; the two-color circle stands for a machine with two applied policies; the three-color circle stands for a machine with three applied policies and so on.
56
Besides the All machines group, we have the custom G1 group in the root and the custom G2 group, which is G1's child. The "green" policy, applied to the All machines group, is inherited by all machines. The "orange" policy, applied to G1, is inherited by the G1 members and all its child groups, both immediate and indirect. The "blue" policy, applied to G2, is inherited only by the G2 members since G2 does not have child groups. The "violet" policy is applied straight to machine #4. It will exist on machine #4 irrespectively of this machine's membership in any group. Let's assume we create the G3 group in the root. If no policies are applied to the group, all its members are supposed to be "green". But if we add, say, the #1 machine to G3, the machine will bear both "orange" and "green" policies, in spite of the fact that G3 has nothing to do with the "orange" policy. That's why it is difficult to track the policies' inheritance from the top of the hierarchy if the same machine is included in multiple groups. In real life, it's much easier to view the inheritance from the machine's side. To do so, navigate to any group that contains the machine, select the machine and then select the Backup policies tab on the Information pane. The Inheritance column shows whether a policy is inherited or applied directly to the machine. Click Explore inheritance to view the inheritance order of the policy. In our example, the policy names, the Inheritance column and the inheritance order will be as follows: For machine #1 or #2 or #3 Name of the policy "green" "orange" #4 "green" "orange" "blue" "violet" Inheritance Inherited Inherited Inherited Inherited Inherited Applied directly Inheritance order All machines -> #1 or #2 or #3 G1 -> #1 or #2 or #3 All machines -> #4 G1 -> G2 -> #4 G2 -> #4
57
#5 or #6
2.11.5
Centralized management presumes that the administrator can monitor the health of the entire product infrastructure using a few easily understandable parameters. The state and status of a backup policy are included in such parameters. Issues, if any, arise from the very bottom of the infrastructure (tasks on managed machines) to the cumulative policy status. The administrator checks the status at a glance. If the status is not OK, the administrator can navigate down to the issue details in a few clicks. This section helps you understand the policies' states and statuses displayed by the management server.
58
59
/dev/sda1 volume (since the [System] volume is not found). The policy will get the Error status on Linux machines that do not have a SCSI device. The following table provides details.
State Deploying Status Error Warning OK Deployed Error Warning OK Updating Error Warning OK Revoking Error Warning OK Description The deployment log has errors, for example, disk space runs out The deployment log has warnings: the machine went offline during the deployment; cannot connect for N days The deployment log does not have errors and warnings The status of the corresponding backup plan is Error The status of the corresponding backup plan is Warning The status of the corresponding backup plan is OK The updating log has errors: cannot delete the locked task, the Acronis service is stopped The updating log has warnings The updating log does not have errors and warnings The revoking log has errors The revoking log has warnings The revoking log does not have errors and warnings
In addition to the deployment state and status as related to a specific machine, the backup policy has the deployment state and status on a group of machines and the cumulative deployment state and status of the policy.
60
2.11.6
Deduplication
This section describes deduplication, a mechanism designed to eliminate data repetition by storing identical data in archives only once.
Overview
Deduplication is the process of minimizing storage space taken by the data by detecting data repetition and storing the identical data only once. For example, if a managed vault where deduplication is enabled contains two copies of the same filewhether in the same archive or in different archivesthe file is stored only once, and a link to that file is stored instead of the second file. Deduplication may also reduce network load: if, during a backup, a file or a disk block is found to be a duplicate of an already stored one, its content is not transferred over the network. Deduplication is performed on disk blocks (block-level deduplication) and on files (file-level deduplication), for disk-level and file-level backups respectively. In Acronis Backup & Recovery 10, deduplication consists of two steps: Deduplication at source Performed on a managed machine during backup. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent uses the storage node to determine what data can be deduplicated, and does not transfer the data whose duplicates are already present in the vault. Deduplication at target
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 61
Performed in the vault after a backup is completed. The storage node analyses the vault's archives and deduplicates data in the vault. When creating a backup plan, you have the option to turn off deduplication at source for that plan. This may lead to faster backups but a greater load on the network and storage node. Deduplicating vault A managed centralized vault where deduplication is enabled is called a deduplicating vault. When you create a managed centralized vault, you can specify whether to enable deduplication in it. A deduplicating vault cannot be created on a tape device.
Deduplication database
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node managing a deduplicating vault, maintains the deduplication database, which contains the hash values of all items stored in the vaultexcept for those that cannot be deduplicated, such as encrypted files. The deduplication database is stored in the folder which is specified by the Database path in the Create centralized vault view when creating the vault. Deduplication database can be created in a local folder only. The size of the deduplication database is about one percent of the total size of archives in the vault. In other words, each terabyte of new (non-duplicate) data adds about 10 GB to the database. In case the database is corrupted or the storage node is lost, while the vault retains archives and the service folder containing metadata, the new storage node rescans the vault and re-creates the database.
Deduplication at target
The storage node performs deduplication at target in a managed vault by running two tasks: the indexing task and the compacting task.
Indexing task
After backup to a deduplicating vault is completed, the storage node runs the indexing task to deduplicate data in the vault as follows:
62
1. It moves the items (disk blocks or files) from the archives to a special folder within the vault, storing duplicate items there only once. This folder is called the deduplication data store. Items that cannot be deduplicated remain in the archives. 2. In the archives, it replaces the moved items with the corresponding references to them. As a result, the vault contains a number of unique, deduplicated items, with each item having one or more references to it from the vault's archives. The indexing task may take considerable time to complete. You can see this task's state in the Tasks view on the management server.
Compacting task
After one or more backups or archives have been deleted from the vaulteither manually or during cleanupthe vault may contain items which are no longer referred to from any archive. Such items are deleted by the compacting task, which is a scheduled task performed by the storage node. By default, the compacting task runs every Sunday night at 03:00. You can re-schedule the task as described in Operations with storage nodes (p. 297), under "Change the compacting task schedule". You can also manually start or stop the task from the Tasks view.
When backing up in the full backup mode similar data from different sources. Such is the case when you back up operating systems and applications deployed from a single source over the network. When performing incremental backups of similar data from different sources, provided that the changes to the data are also similar. Such is the case when you deploy updates to these systems and apply the incremental backup. Again, it is recommended that you first back up one machine and then the others, all at once or one by one. When performing incremental backups of data that does not change itself, but changes its location. Such is the case when multiple pieces of data circulate over the network or within one system. Each time a piece of data moves, it is included in the incremental backup which becomes sizeable while it does not contain new data. Deduplication helps to solve the problem: each time an item appears in a new place, a reference to the item is saved instead of the item itself.
The deduplicated items that have not changed are not included in the incremental backup. The deduplicated items that have changed are not identical anymore and therefore will not be deduplicated.
When creating a deduplicating vault, place the vault and its deduplication database on different disks. This will make deduplication faster, because deduplication involves extensive simultaneous use of both the vault and the database.
63
Indexing of a backup requires that the vault have free space with a minimum size of 1.1 multiplied by the size of the archive the backup belongs to. If there is not enough free space in the vault, the indexing task will fail and start again after 510 minutes, on the assumption that some space has been freed up as a result of cleanup or of other indexing tasks. The more free space there is in the vault, the faster your archives will reduce to the minimum possible size. When backing up multiple systems with similar content, back up one of the similar systems first, so that Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node indexes all the system's files as potential deduplication items. This will lead to faster backup processes and less network traffic (because of effective deduplication at source), regardless of whether the backups are performed simultaneously or not. Before starting the subsequent backups, make sure that the indexing task has finished deduplication of the first backup and is now idle. You can view the state of the indexing task in the list of tasks on Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server.
Deduplication ratio
The deduplication ratio shows the size of archives in a deduplicating vault in relation to the size they would occupy in a non-deduplicating vault. For example, suppose that you are backing up two files with identical content from two machines. If the size of each file is one gigabyte, then the size of the backups in a non-deduplicating vault will be approximately 2 GB, but this size will be just about 1 GB in a deduplicating vault. This gives a deduplication ratio of 2:1, or 50%. Conversely, if the two files had different content, the backup sizes in non-deduplicating and duplicating vaults would be the same (2 GB), and the deduplication ratio would be 1:1, or 100%.
Deduplication restrictions
Block-level deduplication restrictions
During a disk backup to an archive in a deduplicating vault, deduplication of a volume's disk blocks is not performed in the following cases:
64 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
If the volume is a compressed volume If the volume's allocation unit sizealso known as cluster size or block sizeis not divisible by 4 KB
Tip: The allo cation unit size on most NTFS and ext3 volumes is 4 KB and so allows fo r block-level deduplication. Other exa mples of alloca tion unit sizes allowing for blo ck-level deduplica tion include 8 KB, 16 KB, and 64 KB.
Disk blocks that were not deduplicated are stored in the archive as they would be in a nondeduplicating vault.
If the file is encrypted and the In archives, store encrypted files in decrypted state check box in the backup options is cleared (it is cleared by default) If the file is less than 4 KB in size If you protected the archive with a password
Files that were not deduplicated are stored in the archive as they would be in a non-deduplicating vault. Deduplication and NTFS data streams In the NTFS file system, a file may have one or more additional sets of data associated with itoften called alternate data streams. When such file is backed up, so are all its alternate data streams. However, these streams are never deduplicatedeven when the file itself is.
2.11.7
This section describes the users' privileges that are required to manage a machine locally and remotely, to manage a machine registered on Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server, and to access and manage Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node.
Local connection
The local connection is established between Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console on a machine and Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent on the same machine.
To establish a local connection On the toolbar, click Connect, then point to New connection, and then click This machine.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 65
Remote connection
A remote connection is established between Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console on one machine and Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent on another machine. You might need to specify logon credentials to establish a remote connection.
For information about Acronis security groups and their default members, see Acronis security groups (p. 66).
66
A user who is a member of this group can manage the machine remotely by using Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console, according to the management rights described in Users' privileges on a managed machine (p. 30). By default, this group includes all members of the Administrators group.
On a domain controller
If a machine is a domain controller in an Active Directory domain, the names and default contents of Acronis security groups are different:
Instead of Acronis Remote Users and Acronis Centralized Admins, the groups are named DCNAME $ Acronis Remote Users and DCNAME $ Acronis Centralized Admins respectively; here, DCNAME stands for the NetBIOS name of the domain controller. Each dollar sign is surrounded by a single space on either side. Instead of explicitly including the names of all members of the Administrators group, the Administrators group itself is included.
Tip: To ensu re p roper g roup names, you should install A cronis components in a domain controller after you have set up the do main controller itself. If th e componen ts were installed before you set up the domain controller, crea te the groups DCNAME $ Acronis Remote Users and DCNAME $ Acronis Centralized Admins manually, and then include the memb ers of A cronis Remo te Users and Acronis Centralized Admins in the newly crea ted groups.
67
View and manage archives owned by the user View and manage any archive in any centralized vault managed by the storage node Create centralized vaults to be managed by the storage nodeprovided that the user is also an Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server administrator Re-schedule the compacting task, as described in Operations with storage nodes (p. 297), under "Change the compacting task schedule"
A user who is a member of the Administrators group on the storage node can additionally:
Users with these additional privileges are also called storage node administrators.
For users whom you want to act as storage node administrators, add their accounts to the Administrators group. For other users, add their user accounts to the Users group.
68
Alternatively, when creating a backup policy, the management server administrator has the option to explicitly specify a user account under which the centralized backup plans will run on the registered machines. In this case, the user account must exist on all the machines to which the centralized policy will be deployed. This is not always efficient. To be a management server administrator, the user must be a member of the Acronis Centralized Admins group on the machine where the management server is installed.
For the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows service, Acronis Agent User For the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server service, AMS User For the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node service, ASN User All three accounts are assigned the Log on as a service user right. The Acronis Agent User user account is assigned the Adjust memory quotas for a process and Replace a process level token user rights. The Acronis Agent User and ASN User user accounts are included in the Backup Operators group.
The setup program will assign the above listed user rights to any existing account you specify for a corresponding service. If you choose to specify an existing user account for the agent service or the storage node service, make sure that this account is a member of the Backup Operators group, before proceeding with the installation. If the machine is part of an Active Directory domain, make sure that the domain's security policies do not prevent the accounts described in this section (whether existing or newly created) from having the above listed user rights.
Important: After the installation, do not specify a differen t user account for a component's service. Otherwise, the co mponent may stop wo rking.
The newly created user accounts are also granted access to the registry key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Acronis (called Acronis registry key) with the following rights: Query Value, Set Value, Create Subkey, Enumerate Subkeys, Notify, Delete, and Read Control. In addition, there are two Acronis services which run under a system account:
The Acronis Scheduler2 Service provides scheduling for Acronis components' tasks. It runs under the Local System account and cannot run under a different account.
69
The Acronis Remote Agent Service provides connectivity among Acronis components. It runs under the Network Service account and cannot run under a different account.
2.11.8
This section describes how Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components communicate with each other using secure authentication and encryption. This section also provides information on configuring communication settings, selecting a network port for communication, and managing security certificates.
Secure communication
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 provides the capability to secure the data transferred between its components within a local area network and through a perimeter network (also known as demilitarized zone, DMZ). There are two mechanisms which ensure secure communication between Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components:
Secure authentication provides secure transfer of certificates needed to establish a connection, by using the Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) protocol. Encrypted communication provides secure transfer of information between any two componentsfor example, between Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent and Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Nodeby encrypting the data being transferred.
For instructions on how to set up secure authentication and data encryption settings, see Configuring communication options (p. 71). For instructions on how to manage SSL certificates used for secure authentication, see SSL certificates (p. 74).
Note: The componen ts of ea rlier Acronis p roducts, including those of the A cronis Tru e Imag e Echo family, cannot connect to the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 co mponents, regardless of the secu re authen tica tion and data encryp tion settings.
Client application, or client, is an application that tries to establish connection. Server application, or server, is an application to which the client tries to connect.
For example, if Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console is connecting to Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent on a remote machine, the former is the client and the latter is the server. An Acronis component can act as a client application, a server application, or both, as shown in the following table.
Component name Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console Can be client Yes Can be server No
70
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server
Yes Yes
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Yes Node Acronis PXE Server Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Bootable Agent No Yes
If Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console is running, close it and start it again. If other Acronis components, such as Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows or Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server are running, restart their correspondent services from the Services snap-in in Windows.
71
The component will use the specified port; type the port number in the Server TCP Port box. Disabled The same as Not configured. For details about the network port and instructions on how to specify it in Linux and a bootable environment, see Network port configuration (p. 73).
72
The default port (9876) The currently used port New port (enter the port number)
If a port has not been pre-configured, the agent uses the default port number.
SSL certificates
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components use Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) certificates for secure authentication. SSL certificates for the components can be one of the two types:
Self-signed certificates, such as certificates automatically generated during the installation of an Acronis component. Non-self-signed certificates, such as certificates issued by a third-party Certificate Authority (CA)for example, by a public CA such as VeriSign or Thawteor by your organization's CA.
Certificate path
All Acronis components installed on a machine, when acting as a server application, use an SSL certificate called the server certificate. In Windows, the certificate path and the server certificate's file name are specified in the registry key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Acronis\Encryption\Server. The default path is %SystemDrive%\Program Files\Common Files\Acronis\Agent. To ensure reliability, the certificate is stored in Windows Certificate Store at the following location: Certificates (Local Computer)\Acronis Trusted Certificates Cache. For self-signed certificates, the certificate thumbprint (also known as fingerprint or hash) is used for future host identification: if a client has previously connected to a server by using a self-signed certificate and tries to establish connection again, the server checks whether the certificate's thumbprint is the same as the one used before. In case the list of certificates for the local machine is not displayed in the Certificates console, you can use the following procedure.
3. 4. 5. 6.
In the Add/Remove Snap-in dialog box, click Add. In the Add Standalone Snap-in dialog box, double-click Certificates. Click Computer account, and then click Next. Click Local computer, and then click Finish.
Tip: Alternatively, you can manage the list of certifica tes of a remo te machine. To do this, click Another comput er and then type the remo te machine's name.
7. Click Close to close the Add Standalone Snap-in dialog box, and then click OK to close the Add/Remove Snap-in dialog box.
Self-signed certificates
On machines running Windows, if the certificate location contains no server certificate, a self-signed server certificate is automatically generated and installed during the installation of any Acronis component except Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console. If the machine is renamed after its self-signed certificate was generated, the certificate cannot be used and you will need to generate a new one.
Non-self-signed certificates
You have the option to use trusted third-party certificates or certificates created by your organization's CA as an alternative to self-signed certificates, by using Acronis Certificate Commandline Utility.
75
3 Options
This section covers Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 options that can be configured using Graphical User Interface. The content of this section is applicable to both stand-alone and advanced editions of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10.
3.1
Console options
The console options define the way information is represented in the Graphical User Interface of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10. To access the console options, select Options > Console options from the top menu.
3.1.1
Startup page
This option defines whether to show the Welcome screen or the Dashboard upon connection of the console to a managed machine or to the management server. The preset is: the Welcome screen. To make a selection, select or clear the check box for Show the Dashboard view upon connection of the console to a machine. This option can also be set on the Welcome screen. If you select the check box for At startup, show the Dashboard instead of the current view on the Welcome screen, the setting mentioned above will be updated accordingly.
3.1.2
Pop-up messages
76
The preset is: Enabled for all results. To make a setting for each result (successful completion, failure or success with warnings) individually, select or clear the respective check box.
3.1.3
Last backup
Time-based alerts
This option is effective when the console is connected to a managed machine (p. 355) or to the management server (p. 356). The option defines whether to alert if no backup was performed on a given machine for a period of time. You can configure the time period that is considered critical for your business. The preset is: alert if the last successful backup on a machine was completed more than 5 days ago. The alert is displayed in the Alerts section of the Dashboard. When the console is connected to the management server, this setting will also control the color scheme of the Last backup column's value for each machine.
Last connection
This option is effective when the console is connected to the management server or to a registered machine (p. 357). The option defines whether to alert if no connection was established between a registered machine and the management server for a period of time so indicating that the machine might not be centrally managed (for instance in the case of network connection failure to that machine). You can configure the length of time that is considered critical. The preset is: alert if the machine's last connection to the management server was more than 5 days ago. The alert is displayed in the Alerts section of the Dashboard. When the console is connected to the management server, this setting will also control the color scheme of the Last connect column's value for each machine.
3.1.4
Number of tasks
This option is effective only when the console is connected to the management server. The option defines how many tasks will be displayed at a time in the Tasks view. You can also use filters available in the Tasks view to limit the number of displayed tasks. The preset is: 400. The adjustment range is: 20 to 500. To make a selection, choose the desired value from the Number of tasks drop-down menu.
3.1.5
Fonts
This option is effective when the console is connected to a managed machine or to the management server.
77
The option defines the fonts to be used in the Graphical User Interface of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10. The Menu setting affects the drop-down and context menus. The Application setting affects the other GUI elements. The preset is: System Default font for both the menus and the application interface items. To make a selection, choose the font from the respective combo-box and set the font's properties. You can preview the font's appearance by clicking the button to the right.
3.2
The management server options enable you to adjust the behavior of the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server. To access the management server options, connect the console to the management server and then select Options > Management server options from the top menu.
3.2.1
Logging level
This option defines whether the management server has to collect log events from the registered machines to the centralized log that is stored in a dedicated database and is available in the Log view. You can set the option for all the events at once or select the event types to be collected. If you completely disable collection of the log events, the centralized log will contain only the management server's own log. The preset is: Collect logs for All events. Use the Types of events to log combo-box to specify the types of events that will be collected:
All events - all events (information, warnings and errors) occurred on all the machines registered on the management server will be recorded to the centralized log Errors and warnings - warnings and errors will be recorded to the centralized log Errors only - only errors will be recorded to the centralized log.
To disable collection of the log events, clear the Collect logs check box.
3.2.2
This option specifies how to clean up the centralized event log stored in the management server's reporting database. This option defines the maximum size of the reporting database. The preset is: Maximum log size: 1 GB. On cleanup, keep 95% of the maximum log size. When the option is enabled, the program compares the actual log size with the maximum size after every 100 log entries. Once the maximum log size is exceeded, the program deletes the oldest log entries. You can select the amount of log entries to retain. The default 95% setting will keep most of the log. With the minimum 1% setting, the log will be nearly cleared.
Even if you remove the log size limit, logging even ts to an SQL Server Express database will stop after the log size reaches 4 GB, b ecause SQL Express Edition has the 4 GB p er database limit. Set th e maximum log size to approximately 3.8 GB if you want to use the maximum capacity of the SQL Express database.
This parameter can also be set by using Acronis Administrative Template (p. 314).
78 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
3.2.3
Event tracing
You can configure the management server to log events in the Application Event Log of Windows, besides the management server's own log. You can configure the management server to send Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) objects to a specified SNMP manager.
All events - all events (information, warnings and errors) Errors and warnings Errors only.
SNMP notifications
This option defines whether the management server has to send its own log events to the specified Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) managers. You can choose the types of events to be sent. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 provides the following Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) objects to SNMP management applications: 1.3.6.1.4.1.24769.100.200.1.0 - string identifying the type of event (Information, Warning, Error) 1.3.6.1.4.1.24769.100.200.2.0 - string containing the text description of the event (it looks identical to messages published by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 in its log). The preset is: Disabled.
Types of events to send choose the types of events: All events, Errors and warnings, or Errors only. Server name/IP type the name or IP address of the host running the SNMP management application, the messages will be sent to. Community type the name of the SNMP community to which both the host running SNMP management application and the sending machine belong. The typical community is "public".
To disable sending SNMP messages, clear the Send messages to SNMP server check box. The messages are sent over UDP.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 79
3.2.4
This option determines the user name and password that the management server will use to access the domain. The preset is: No credentials The management server needs domain access credentials when working with a dynamic group that is based on the Organizational unit criterion (p. 288). When you are creating such group and no credentials are given by this option, the program will ask you for credentials and save them in this option. It is sufficient to specify the credentials of a user who is a member of the Domain Users group on the domain.
3.2.5
This option works in combination with the Use Wake-On-LAN (p. 159) advanced scheduling setting. Use this option if the management server has to wake up for backup machines located in another subnet. When the scheduled operation is about to start, the management server sends out magic packets to wake up the appropriate machines. (A magic packet is a packet that contains 16 contiguous copies of the receiving NIC's MAC address). The Acronis WOL Proxy, installed in the other subnet, transfers the packets to machines located in that subnet. The preset is: Disabled.
3.2.6
VM protection options
These options define the management server behavior as related to backup and recovery of virtual machines hosted on virtualization servers.
80
3.3
Machine options
The machine options define the general behavior of all Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agents operating on the managed machine, and so the options are considered machine-specific.
81
To access the machine options, connect the console to the managed machine and then select Options > Machine options from the top menu.
3.3.1
Machine management
This option defines whether the machine has to be managed centrally by the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server. To be able to use this option, you must be logged on as a member of the Administrators group on the machine. You have the opportunity to register the machine on the management server when installing an Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent. If the machine is not registered, selecting Centralized management here will initiate the registration (p. 357). Or you can add the machine to the management server on the server side. Any of the three registration methods require the server administrator privileges. Selecting Stand-alone management on a registered machine will result in the machine stopping communication with the server. On the management server, the machine appears as Withdrawn. The management server administrator can delete the machine from the server or register the machine once again. The preset is: Stand-alone management.
3.3.2
Event tracing
It is possible to duplicate log events generated by the agent(s), operating on the managed machine, in the Application Event Log of Windows; or send the events to the specified SNMP managers. If you do not modify the event tracing options anywhere except for here, your settings will be effective for each local backup plan and each task created on the machine. You can override the settings set here, exclusively for the events occurred during backup or during recovery (see Default backup and recovery options (p. 85).) In this case, the settings set here will be effective for operations other than backup and recovery, such as archive validation or cleanup. You can further override the settings set in the default backup and recovery options, when creating a backup plan or a recovery task. The settings you obtain in this case will be plan-specific or taskspecific.
This option defines whether the agent(s) operating on the managed machine have to log events in the Application Event Log of Windows (to see this log, run eventvwr.exe or select Control Panel > Administrative tools > Event Viewer). You can filter the events to be logged. You can override the settings set here, exclusively for the events that occur during backup or during recovery, in the Default backup and recovery options (p. 85). In this case, the settings set here will be effective for operations other than backup and recovery, such as archive validation or cleanup. You can further override the settings set in the default backup and recovery options, when creating a backup plan or a recovery task. The settings you obtain in this case will be plan-specific or taskspecific. The preset is: Disabled. To enable this option, select the Log events check box. Use the Types of events to log check box to filter the events to be logged in the Application Event Log of Windows:
All events - all events (information, warnings and errors) Errors and warnings Errors only.
SNMP notifications
This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems. This option is not available when operating under the bootable media. The option defines whether the agent(s) operating on the managed machine have to send the log events to the specified Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) managers. You can choose the types of events to be sent. You can override the settings set here, exclusively for the events that occur during backup or during recovery, in the Default backup and recovery options (p. 85). In this case, the settings set here will be effective for operations other than backup and recovery, such as archive validation or cleanup. You can further override the settings set in the default backup and recovery options, when creating a backup plan or a recovery task. The settings you obtain in this case will be plan-specific or taskspecific. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 provides the following Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) objects to SNMP management applications: 1.3.6.1.4.1.24769.100.200.1.0 - string identifying the type of event (Information, Warning, Error) 1.3.6.1.4.1.24769.100.200.2.0 - string containing the text description of the event (it looks identical to messages published by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 in its log). The preset is: Disabled.
83
Types of events to send choose the types of events: All events, Errors and warnings, or Errors only. Server name/IP type the name or IP address of the host running the SNMP management application, the messages will be sent to. Community type the name of the SNMP community to which both the host running SNMP management application and the sending machine belong. The typical community is "public".
To disable sending SNMP messages, clear the Send messages to SNMP server check box. The messages are sent over UDP. The next section contains additional information about Setting up SNMP services on the receiving machine (p. 84).
You might be asked for lmmib2.dll that can be found on the installation disc of your operating system.
Linux
To receive SNMP messages on a machine running Linux, the net-snmp (for RHEL and SUSE) or the snmpd (for Debian) package has to be installed. SNMP can be configured using the snmpconf command. The default configuration files are located in the /etc/snmp directory:
/etc/snmp/snmpd.conf - configuration file for the Net-SNMP SNMP agent /etc/snmp/snmptrapd.conf - configuration file for the Net-SNMP trap daemon.
3.3.3
This option specifies how to clean up the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent log. This option defines the maximum size of the agent log folder (in Windows XP/2003 Server, %ALLUSERSPROFILE%\Application Data\Acronis\BackupAndRecovery\MMS\LogEvents). The preset is: Maximum log size: 1 GB. On cleanup, keep 95% of the maximum log size. When the option is enabled, the program compares the actual log size with the maximum size after every 100 log entries. Once the maximum log size is exceeded, the program deletes the oldest log entries. You can select the amount of log entries to retain. The default 95% setting will keep most of the log. With the minimum 1% setting, the log will be nearly cleared. This parameter can also be set by using Acronis Administrative Template (p. 319).
84
3.3.4
This option defines whether the machine will participate in the Acronis Customer Experience Program (ACEP). If you choose Yes, I want to participate in the ACEP, information about the hardware configuration, the most and least used features and about any problems will be automatically collected from the machine and sent to Acronis on a regular basis. The end results are intended to provide software improvements and enhanced functionality to better meet the needs of Acronis customers. Acronis does not collect any personal data. To learn more about the ACEP, read the terms of participation on the Acronis Web site or in the product GUI. Initially the option is configured during the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent installation. This setting can be changed at any time using the product GUI (Options > Machine options > Customer Experience Program). The option can also be configured using the Group Policy infrastructure (p. 322). A setting defined by a Group Policy cannot be changed using the product GUI unless the Group Policy is disabled on the machine.
3.4
3.4.1
Each Acronis agent has its own default backup options. Once an agent is installed, the default options have pre-defined values, which are referred to as presets in the documentation. When creating a backup plan, you can either use a default option, or override the default option with the custom value that will be specific for this plan only. You can also customize a default option itself by changing its value against the pre-defined one. The new value will be used by default in all backup plans you will create later on this machine. To view and change the default backup options, connect the console to the managed machine and then select Options > Default backup and recovery options > Default backup options from the top menu.
The environment the agent operates in (Windows, bootable media) The type of the data being backed up (disk, file) The backup destination (networked location or local disk) The backup scheme (Back up now or using the scheduler)
File backup +
Disk backup +
File backup +
Source files exclusion (p. 88) Pre/Post backup commands (p. 89) Pre/Post data capture commands (p. 90) Multi-volume snapshot (p. 92) File-level backup snapshot (p. 92) Use VSS (p. 93) Compression level (p. 93) Backup performance: Backup priority (p. 94) HDD writing speed (p. 94) Network connection speed (p. 95) Fast incremental/differential backup (p. 98) Backup splitting (p. 98) File-level security (p. 99): Preserve files security settings in archives In archives, store encrypted files in decrypted state Media components (p. 100)
+ + + + + +
+ + + + + + +
+ PE only +
+ PE only +
Error handling (p. 100): Do not show messages and dialogs while processing (silent mode) Re-attempt if an error occurs Ignore bad sectors Dual destination (p. 101) Task start conditions (p. 102) Task failure handling (p. 103) Tape support (p. 103) + +
86
Overwrite data on a tape without prompting user for confirmation Dismount media after backup is finished Ask for first media while creating backup archives on removable media Validate backup after creation Reset archive bit Reboot after the backup Notifications: E-mail (p. 95) Win Pop-up (p. 96) Event tracing: Windows events log (p. 97) SNMP (p. 97)
Dest: Tape
Dest: Tape
Dest: Tape
Dest: Tape
+ +
+ +
+ +
+ +
Archive protection
This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media. This option is effective for both disk-level and file-level backup. The preset is: Disabled.
Do not encrypt the archive will be protected with the password only AES 128 the archive will be encrypted using the Advanced Standard Encryption (AES) algorithm with a 128-bit key AES 192 the archive will be encrypted using the AES algorithm with a 192-bit key
AES 256 the archive will be encrypted using the AES algorithm with a 256-bit key. 5. Click OK. The AES cryptographic algorithm operates in the Cipher-block chaining (CBC) mode and uses a randomly generated key with a user-defined size of 128, 192 or 256 bits. The larger the key size, the longer it will take for the program to encrypt the archive and the more secure your data will be. The encryption key is then encrypted with AES-256 using a SHA-256 hash of the password as a key. The password itself is not stored anywhere on the disk or in the backup file; the password hash is used for verification purposes. With this two-level security, the backup data is protected from any unauthorized access, but recovering a lost password is not possible.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 87
Exclude all hidden files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the Hidden attribute. If a folder is Hidden, all of its contents including files that are not Hidden will be excluded. Exclude all system files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the System attribute. If a folder is System, all of its contents including files that are not System will be excluded.
You can view file or folder a ttributes in the file/folder properties or by using th e attrib command. For more information, refer to the Help and Support Cen ter in Windows.
Exclude files matching the following criteria Select this check box to skip files whose names match any of the criteria called file masks in the list; use the Add, Edit, Remove and Remove All buttons to create the list of file masks. You can use one or more wildcard characters * and ? in a file mask: The asterisk (*) substitutes for zero or more characters in a file name; for example, the file mask Doc*.txt yields files such as Doc.txt and Document.txt The question mark (?) substitutes for exactly one character in a file name; for example, the file mask Doc?.txt yields files such as Doc1.txt and Docs.txt but not the files Doc.txt or Doc11.txt
Example File1.log C:\Finance\test.log *.log my???.log Description Excludes all files named File1.log. Excludes the file named test.log located in the folder C:\Finance Excludes all files with the .log extension. Excludes all .log files with names consisting of five symbols and starting with my.
Exclusion examples
Criterion By name By path Mask (*) Mask (?)
The above settings a re not effective fo r th e files o r folders that were explicitly selected for ba ckup. For example, assume that you selected the fold er MyFolder and th e file MyFile.tmp outside that folder, and selected to skip all .tmp files. In this case, all .tmp files in the folder MyFolder will be skipped during the ba ckup process, but the file MyFile.tmp will not be skipped .
88
Pre/Post commands
This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and PE-based bootable media. The option enables you to define the commands to be automatically executed before and after the backup procedure. The following scheme illustrates when pre/post commands are executed.
Pre-backup command Backup Post-backup command
delete some temporary files from the disk before starting backup configure a third-party antivirus product to be started each time before the backup starts copy an archive to another location after the backup ends.
The program does not support interactive commands, i.e. commands that require user input (for example, "pause").
Pre-backup command
To specify a command/batch file to be executed before the backup process starts
1. In the Command field, type a command or browse to a batch file. The program does not support interactive commands, i.e. commands that require user input (for example, "pause".) 2. In the Working directory field, specify a path to a directory where the command/batch file will be executed. 3. In the Arguments field specify the commands execution arguments, if required. 4. Depending on the result you want to obtain, select the appropriate options as described in the table below. 5. Click Test command to check if the command is correct.
Check box Fail the task if the command execution fails Do not back up until the command exe cution is complete Selected Selected
Result Preset Perform the backup after the N/A Perform the backup concurrently with
89
Perform the backup only after the command is successfully executed. Fail the task if the command execution fails.
Post-backup command
To specify a command/executable file to be executed after the backup is completed
1. In the Command field, type a command or browse to a batch file. 2. In the Working directory field, specify a path to a directory where the command/batch file will be executed. 3. In the Arguments field, specify the command execution arguments, if required. 4. If successful execution of the command is critical for your backup strategy, select the Fail the task if the command execution fails check box. In case the command execution fails, the program will remove the resulting TIB file and temporary files if possible, and the task will fail. When the check box is not selected, the command execution result does not affect the task execution failure or success. You can track the command execution result by exploring the log or the errors and warnings displayed on the Dashboard. 5. Click Test Command to check if the command is correct.
If the Volume Shadow Copy Service (p. 93) option is enabled, the commands' execution and the Microsoft VSS actions will be sequenced as follows: "Before data capture commands -> VSS Suspend -> Data capture -> VSS Resume -> "After data capture" commands. Using the pre/post data capture commands, you can suspend and resume a database or application that is not compatible with VSS. As opposed to the Pre/Post commands (p. 89), the pre/post data capture commands will be executed before and after the data capture process, which takes seconds, while the entire backup procedure may take much longer, depending on the amount of data to be backed up. Therefore, the database or application idle time will be minimal.
90
Execute after the data capture 2. Do any of the following: Click Edit to specify a new command or a batch file Select the existing command or the batch file from the drop-down list 3. Click OK.
Result Preset Perform the data capture after the Perform the data command is capture only after the executed despite command is execution failure successfully executed. or success. Fail the task if the command execution fails. N/A Perform the data capture concurrently with the command and irrespective of the command execution result.
91
Selected
Selected
Cleared
Cleared
Result Preset Continue the backup only after the command is successfully executed. Delete the TIB file and temporary files and fail the task if the command execution fails. Continue the backup after the command is executed despite command execution failure or success. N/A Continue the backup concurrently with the command execution and irrespective of the command execution result.
The preset is: Create snapshot if it is possible. Select one of the following:
Always create a snapshot The snapshot enables backing up of all files including files opened for exclusive access. The files will be backed up at the same point in time. Choose this setting only if these factors are critical, that is, backing up files without a snapshot does not make sense. To use a snapshot, the backup plan has to run under the account with the Administrator or Backup Operator privileges. If a snapshot cannot be taken, the backup will fail. Create a snapshot if it is possible Back up files directly if taking a snapshot is not possible. Do not create a snapshot Always back up files directly. Administrator or Backup Operator privileges are not required. Trying to back up files that are opened for exclusive access will result in a read error. Files in the backup may be not time-consistent.
Multi-volume snapshot
This option is effective only for Windows operating systems. This option applies to disk-level backup. This option also applies to file-level backup when the filelevel backup is performed by taking a snapshot. (The File-level backup snapshot (p. 92) option determines whether a snapshot will be taken during file-level backup). The option determines whether to take snapshots of multiple volumes at the same time or one by one. The preset is: Enable.
92 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
When this option is set to Enable, snapshots of all volumes being backed up will be created simultaneously. Use this option to create a time-consistent backup of data spanned across multiple volumes, for instance for an Oracle database. When this option is set to Disable, the volumes' snapshots will be taken one after the other. As a result, if the data spans across several volumes, the resulting backup may be not consistent.
Compression level
This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media. The option defines the level of compression applied to the data being backed up. The preset is: Normal. The optimal data compression level depends on the type of data being backed up. For example, even maximum compression will not significantly reduce the archive size if the archive contains essentially
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 93
compressed files, such as .jpg, .pdf or .mp3. However, formats such as .doc or .xls will be compressed well.
None the data will be copied as is, without any compression. The resulting backup size will be maximal. Normal recommended in most cases. High the resulting backup size will typically be less than for the Normal level. Maximum the data will be compressed as much as possible. The backup duration will be maximal. You may want to select maximum compression when backing up to removable media to reduce the number of blank disks required.
Backup performance
Use this group of options to specify the amount of network and system resources to allocate to the backup process. Backup performance options might have a more or less noticeable effect on the speed of the backup process. This depends on the overall system configuration and the physical characteristics of devices the backup is being performed from or to.
Backup priority
This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems. The priority of a process running in a system determines the amount of CPU and system resources allocated to that process. Decreasing the backup priority will free more resources for other applications. Increasing the backup priority might speed up the backup process by requesting the operating system to allocate more resources like the CPU to the backup application. However, the resulting effect will depend on the overall CPU usage and other factors like disk in/out speed or network traffic. The preset is: Low.
Low to minimize resources taken by the backup process, leaving more resources to other processes running on the machine Normal to run the backup process with normal speed, allocating resources on a par with other processes High to maximize the backup process speed by taking resources from other processes.
94
Backing up to a fixed hard disk (for example, to Acronis Secure Zone) may slow performance of the operating system and applications because of the large amounts of data that needs to be written to the disk. You can limit the hard disk usage by the backup process to the desired level. The preset is: Maximum.
Click Writing speed stated as a percentage of the maximum speed of the destination hard disk, and then drag the slider or select a percentage in the box Click Writing speed stated in kilobytes per second, and then enter the writing speed in kilobytes per second.
Click Transferring speed stated as a percentage of the estimated maximum speed of the network connection, and then drag the slider or type a percentage in the box Click Transferring speed stated in kilobytes per second, and then enter the bandwidth limit for transferring backup data in kilobytes per second.
Notifications
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 provides the ability of notifying users about backup completion through e-mail or the messaging service.
E-mail
This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems. This option is not available when operating under the bootable media. The option enables you to receive e-mail notifications about the backup task's successful completion, failure or need for interaction along with the full log of the task. The preset is: Disabled.
2. In the E-mail addresses field, type the e-mail address to which notifications will be sent. You can enter several addresses separated by semicolons. 3. Under Send notifications, select the appropriate check boxes as follows: When backup completes successfully to send a notification when the backup task has completed successfully When backup fails to send a notification when the backup task has failed The When user interaction is required check box is always selected. 4. For the e-mail message to include the log entries related to the backup, select the Add full log to the notification check box. 5. Click Additional e-mail parameters, to configure additional e-mail parameters as follows, then click OK:
From - type the e-mail address of the user from whom the message will be sent. If you leave this field empty, messages will be constructed as if they are from the destination address. Use encryption you can opt for encrypted connection to the mail server. SSL and TLS encryption types are available for selection. Some Internet service providers require authentication on the incoming mail server before being allowed to send something. If this is your case, select the Log on to incoming mail server check box to enable a POP server and to set up its settings:
Incoming mail server (POP) enter the name of the POP server. Port set the port of the POP server. By default, the port is set to 110.
User name enter the user name Password enter the password. Select the Use the specified outgoing mail server check box to enable an SMTP server and to set up its settings:
Port set the port of the SMTP server. By default, the port is set to 25. User name enter the user name. Password enter the password. 6. Click Send test e-mail message to check if the settings are correct.
Outgoing mail server (SMTP) enter the name of the SMTP server.
2. In the Machine name field, enter the name of the machine to which notifications will be sent. Multiple names are not supported. Under Send notifications, select the appropriate check boxes as follows: When backup completes successfully to send notification when the backup operation is completed successfully When backup fails to send notification when the backup operation is failed The When user interaction is required check box to send notification during the operation when user interaction is required is always selected. Click Send test WinPopup message to check if the settings are correct.
Event tracing
It is possible to duplicate log events of the backup operations, performed on the managed machine, in the Application Event Log of Windows; or send the events to the specified SNMP managers.
To select whether to log the backup operations events in the Application Event Log of Windows:
Choose one of the following:
Use the setting set in the Machine options to use the setting specified for the machine. For more information refer to Machine options (p. 81). Log the following event types to log events of the backup operations in the Application Event Log. Specify the types of events to be logged:
Errors and warnings Errors only Do not log - to disable logging events of the backup operations in the Application Event Log.
SNMP notifications
This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems. This option is not available when operating under the bootable media. The option defines whether the agent(s) operating on the managed machine have to send the log events of the backup operations to the specified Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) managers. You can choose the types of events to be sent.
97
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 provides the following Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) objects to SNMP management applications: 1.3.6.1.4.1.24769.100.200.1.0 - string identifying the type of event (Information, Warning, Error) 1.3.6.1.4.1.24769.100.200.2.0 - string containing the text description of the event (it looks identical to messages published by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 in its log). The preset is: Use the setting set in the Machine options.
To select whether to send the backup operations events to the SNMP managers:
Choose one of the following:
Use the setting set in the Machine options to use the setting specified for the machine. For more information refer to Machine options (p. 81). Send SNMP notifications individually for backup operation events to send the events of the backup operations to the specified SNMP managers.
Types of events to send choose the types of events to be sent: All events, Errors and warnings, or Errors only. Server name/IP type the name or IP address of the host running the SNMP management application, the messages will be sent to.
Community type the name of the SNMP community to which both the host running the SNMP management application and the sending machine belong. The typical community is "public". Click Send test message to check if the settings are correct.
Do not send SNMP notifications to disable sending the log events of the backup operations to SNMP managers.
Backup splitting
This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media. The option defines how a backup can be split. The preset is: Automatic. The following settings are available.
98
Automatic
With this setting, Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 will act as follows.
When backing up to a hard disk: A single backup file will be created if the destination disk's file system allows the estimated file size. The backup will automatically be split into several files if the destination disk's file system does not allow the estimated file size. Such might be the case when the backup is placed on FAT16 and FAT32 file systems that have a 4GB file size limit. If the destination disk runs out of free space while creating the backup, the task enters the Need interaction state. You have the ability to free additional space and retry the operation. If you do so, the resulting backup will be split into the parts created before and after the retry. When backing up to removable media (CD, DVD or a tape device locally attached to the managed machine): The task will enter the Need interaction state and ask for a new media when the previous one is full.
Fixed size
Enter the desired file size or select it from the drop-down list. The backup will then be split into multiple files of the specified size. This comes in handy when creating a backup that you plan to burn to multiple CDs or DVDs later on. You might also want to split the backup destined to an FTP server, since data recovery directly from an FTP server requires the backup to be split into files no more than 2GB in size.
File-level security
These options are effective only for file-level backup in Windows operating systems.
99
To completely eliminate this kind of problem, disable preserving file security settings in archives. The recovered files and folders will always inherit the permissions from the folder to which they are recovered or from the disk, if recovered to the root. Alternatively, you can disable recovery (p. 110) of the security settings, even if they are available in the archive. The result will be the same - the files will inherit the permissions from the parent folder.
To access file or folder NTFS permissions, select Properties > Security.
Media components
This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems, when the backup destination is removable media. When backing up to removable media, you can make this media work as regular Linux-based bootable media (p. 349) by writing additional components to it. As a result, you will not need a separate rescue disc. The preset is: None selected. Select the check boxes for the components you want to put on the bootable media:
One-Click Restore is the minimal addition to a disk backup stored on removable media, allowing for easy recovery from this backup. If you boot a machine from the media and click Run Acronis One-click Restore, the disk will be immediately recovered from the backup contained on the same media.
Caution: Because the one-click approa ch does not presume user selections, su ch as selecting volumes to recover, Acronis One-Click Resto re always recovers the en tire disk. If your disk contains several volumes and you are planning to use Acronis One-Click Resto re, include all the volumes in the ba ckup. Any volumes missing fro m th e backup will b e lost.
Bootable agent is a bootable rescue utility (based on Linux kernel) that includes most of the functionality of the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent. Put this component on the media if you want more functionality during recovery. You will be able to configure the recovery operation in the same way as under regular bootable media; use Active Restore or Universal Restore. If the media is being created in Windows, the disk management functionality will also be available.
Error handling
These options are effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media. These options enable you to specify how to handle errors that might occur during backup.
100
When a recoverable error occurs, the program re-attempts to perform the unsuccessful operation. You can set the time interval and the number of attempts. The attempts will be stopped as soon as the operation succeeds OR the specified number of attempts is performed, depending on which comes first. For example, if the backup destination on the network becomes unavailable or not reachable, the program will attempt to reach the destination every 30 seconds, but no more than 5 times. The attempts will be stopped as soon as the connection is resumed OR the specified number of attempts is performed, depending on which comes first.
Dual destination
This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems, when the primary backup destination is a local folder or Acronis Secure Zone and the secondary destination is another local folder or network share. Managed vaults and FTP servers are not supported as secondary destinations. The preset is: Disabled. When dual destination is enabled, the agent will automatically copy each backup being created locally to the secondary destination such as a network share. Once the backup to the primary destination is completed, the agent compares the updated archive contents to the secondary archive contents, and copies to the secondary destination all backups that are missing there along with the new backup. This option enables quick machine backup to the internal drive as an intermediate step before saving the ready backup on the network. This comes in handy in cases of slow or busy networks and timeconsuming backup procedures. Disconnection during the copy transfer will not affect the backup operation as opposed to backing up directly to the remote location. Other advantages:
Replication enhances the archive reliability. Roaming users can back up their portable computers to Acronis Secure Zone while on the road. When the portable computer is connected to the corporate network, all changes made to the archive will be transferred to its stationary copy after the first backup operation.
If you select the password-pro tected A cronis Secure Zone as the primary d estina tion, keep in mind that the archive in the secondary destination will not be pro tected with a password .
101
You might have to provide the access credentials for the secondary destination. Enter the credentials on prompt.
102
If the task fails because of a mistake in the backup plan, you can edit th e plan while the task is in the Idle state. While the task is running, you have to stop it p rior to editing th e backup plan.
Tape support
These options are effective when the backup destination is a managed vault located on a tape library. Tape support options enable you to specify how the backup tasks will distribute backups among the tapes.
Some co mbinations of tape op tions might d egrade usage efficiency of both the whole tape lib rary and each tape. If you a re not fo rced to modify these op tions by some sp ecific needs, leave them unchanged.
An archive can occupy several tapes. In such cases a so-called tape set is used for keeping the data backups. Tape set is a logical group of one or more tapes which contain backups of the specific protected data. A tape set can contain backups of other data as well.
103
Separate tape set is a tape set which contains only backups of the specific protected data. Other backups cannot be written to a separate tape set.
Ask for user interaction - the backup task will enter the Need Interaction state and wait for the tape, with the required label, to be loaded into the tape library device. Use a free tape - the backup will be written onto a free tape, so the operation will be paused only if there is no free tape in the library.
The preset is: Disabled. When this option is enabled, each full backup will be written onto a free tape. The tape will be loaded to a drive especially for this operation. If the Use a separate tape set option is enabled, only incremental and differential backups of the same data will be appended to the tape.
The preset is: Disabled. When this option is enabled, each differential backup will be written onto a free tape. This option is available only when using free tape for each full backup is selected.
The preset is: Disabled. When this option is enabled, each incremental backup will be written onto a free tape. This option is available only when using free tape for each full and differential backup is selected.
104 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
Additional settings
Specify the additional settings for the backup operation by selecting or clearing the following check boxes.
105
Deduplicate backup only after transferring it to the vault (do not deduplicate at source)
This option is available only in advanced editions of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10. This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media, when the backup destination is a deduplicating vault. The preset is: Disabled. Enabling this option turns off deduplicating backups at source, meaning that deduplication will be performed by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node after the backup is saved to the vault (this is called deduplication at target). Turning off deduplication at source may lead to faster backup processes but greater network traffic and heavier load of the storage node. The eventual size of the backup in the vault is independent of whether deduplication at source is turned on. Deduplication at source and deduplication at target are described in Deduplication overview (p. 61).
106
3.4.2
Each Acronis agent has its own default recovery options. Once an agent is installed, the default options have pre-defined values, which are referred to as presets in the documentation. When creating a recovery task, you can either use a default option, or override the default option with the custom value that will be specific for this task only. You can also customize a default option itself by changing its value against the pre-defined one. The new value will be used by default in all recovery tasks you will create later on this machine. To view and change the default recovery options, connect the console to the managed machine and then select Options > Default backup and recovery options > Default recovery options from the top menu.
The environment the agent operates in (Windows, bootable media) The type of data being recovered (disk, file) The operating system being recovered from the disk backup
Agent for Windows Bootable media (Linux-based or PE-based) Disk recovery + + File recovery (also from a disk backup) + + Disk recovery PE only File recovery (also from a disk backup) PE only -
Pre/Post recovery commands (p. 108) Recovery priority (p. 109) File-level security (p. 110): Recover files with their security settings Error handling (p. 113): Do not show messages and dialogs while processing (silent mode) Re-attempt if an error occurs Additional settings (p. 113): Set current date and time for recovered files Validate backup archive before recovery
107
Check file system after recovery Reboot machine automatically if it is required for recovery Change SID after recovery Notifications: E-mail (p. 110) Win Pop-up (p. 111) Event tracing: Windows events log (p. 112) SNMP (p. 112)
Windows recovery
Windows recovery
+ +
+ +
+ +
+ +
Pre/Post commands
This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and PE-based bootable media. The option enables you to define the commands to be automatically executed before and after the data recovery. Example of how you can use the pre/post commands:
launch the Checkdisk command in order to find and fix logical file system errors, physical errors or bad sectors to be started before the recovery starts or after the recovery ends.
The program does not support interactive commands, i.e. commands that require user input (for example, "pause".) A post-recovery command will not be executed if the recovery proceeds with reboot.
Pre-recovery command
To specify a command/batch file to be executed before the recovery process starts
1. In the Command field, type a command or browse to a batch file. The program does not support interactive commands, i.e. commands that require user input (for example, "pause".) 2. In the Working directory field, specify a path to a directory where the command/batch file will be executed. 3. In the Arguments field specify the commands execution arguments, if required.
108 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
4. Depending on the result you want to obtain, select the appropriate options as described in the table below. 5. Click Test command to check if the command is correct.
Check box Fail the task if the command execution fails Do not recover until the command exe cution is complete Selected Selected Selection Cleared Selected Selected Cleared Cleared Cleared
Result Preset Perform the recovery after the Perform the recovery command is only after the executed despite command is execution failure successfully executed. or success. Fail the task if the command execution failed. N/A Perform the recovery concurrently with the command execution and irrespective of the command execution result.
Post-recovery command
To specify a command/executable file to be executed after the recovery is completed
1. In the Command field, type a command or browse to a batch file. 2. In the Working directory field, specify a path to a directory where the command/batch file will be executed. 3. In the Arguments field, specify the command execution arguments, if required. 4. If successful execution of the command is critical for you, select the Fail the task if the command execution fails check box. In case the command execution fails, the task run result will be set to Failed. When the check box is not selected, the command execution result does not affect the task execution failure or success. You can track the command execution result by exploring the log or the errors and warnings displayed on the Dashboard. 5. Click Test command to check if the command is correct.
A post-recovery command will not b e executed if the recovery p roceeds with reboot.
Recovery priority
This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems. This option is not available when operating under the bootable media. The priority of a process running in a system determines the amount of CPU and system resources allocated to that process. Decreasing the recovery priority will free more resources for other applications. Increasing the recovery priority might speed up the recovery process by requesting the operating system to allocate more resources to the application that will perform the recovery. However, the resulting effect will depend on the overall CPU usage and other factors like disk I/O speed or network traffic. The preset is: Normal.
109
Low to minimize resources taken by the recovery process, leaving more resources to other processes running on the machine Normal to run the recovery process with normal speed, allocating resources on a par with other processes High to maximize the recovery process speed by taking resources from the other processes.
File-level security
This option is effective only for recovery from file-level backup of Windows files. This option defines whether to recover NTFS permissions for files along with the files. The preset is: Recover files with their security settings. If the file NTFS permissions were preserved during backup (p. 99), you can choose whether to recover the permissions or let the files inherit the NTFS permissions from the folder to which they are recovered.
Notifications
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 provides the ability of notifying users about recovery completion through e-mail or the messaging service.
E-mail
This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems. This option is not available when operating under the bootable media. The option enables you to receive e-mail notifications about the recovery task's successful completion, failure or need for interaction along with the full log of the task. The preset is: Disabled.
When backup completes successfully to send a notification when the backup task has completed successfully
When backup fails to send a notification when the backup task has failed The When user interaction is required check box is always selected. 4. For the e-mail message to include the log entries related to the backup, select the Add full log to the notification check box. 5. Click Additional e-mail parameters, to configure additional e-mail parameters as follows, then click OK:
From - type the e-mail address of the user from whom the message will be sent. If you leave this field empty, messages will be constructed as if they are from the destination address.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
110
Use encryption you can opt for encrypted connection to the mail server. SSL and TLS encryption types are available for selection. Some Internet service providers require authentication on the incoming mail server before being allowed to send something. If this is your case, select the Log on to incoming mail server check box to enable a POP server and to set up its settings:
Incoming mail server (POP) enter the name of the POP server. Port set the port of the POP server. By default, the port is set to 110.
User name enter the user name Password enter the password. Select the Use the specified outgoing mail server check box to enable an SMTP server and to set up its settings:
Outgoing mail server (SMTP) enter the name of the SMTP server. Port set the port of the SMTP server. By default, the port is set to 25. User name enter the user name. Password enter the password.
Click Send test e-mail message to check if the settings are correct.
When recovery completes successfully to send notification when the recovery task has completed successfully
When recovery fails to send notification when the recovery task has failed. The When user interaction is required check box to send notification during the operation when user interaction is required is always selected. 4. Click Send Test WinPopup Message to check if the settings are correct.
Event tracing
It is possible to duplicate log events of the recovery operations, performed on the managed machine, in the Application Event Log of Windows; or send the events to the specified SNMP managers.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 111
To select whether to log the recovery operations events in the Application Event Log of Windows:
Select one of the following:
Use the setting set in the Machine options to use the setting specified for the machine. For more information refer to Machine options (p. 81). Log the following event types to log events of the recovery operations in the Application Event Log. Specify the types of events to be logged:
Errors and warnings Errors only Do not log - to disable logging events of the recovery operations in the Application Event Log.
SNMP notifications
This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems. This option is not available when operating under the bootable media. The option defines whether the agent(s) operating on the managed machine have to send the log events of the recovery operations to the specified Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) managers. You can choose the types of events to be sent. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 provides the following Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) objects to SNMP management applications: 1.3.6.1.4.1.24769.100.200.1.0 - string identifying the type of event (Information, Warning, Error) 1.3.6.1.4.1.24769.100.200.2.0 - string containing the text description of the event (it looks identical to messages published by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 in its log). The preset is: Use the setting set in the Machine options.
To select whether to send the recovery operations events to the SNMP managers:
Choose one of the following:
Use the setting set in the Machine options to use the setting specified for the machine. For more information refer to Machine options (p. 81). Send SNMP notifications individually for recovery operation events to send the events of the recovery operations to the specified SNMP managers.
112
Types of events to send choose the types of events to be sent: All events, Errors and warnings, or Errors only. Server name/IP type the name or IP address of the host running the SNMP management application, the messages will be sent to.
Community type the name of SNMP community to which both the host running SNMP management application and the sending machine belong. The typical community is "public". Click Send test message to check if the settings are correct. Do not send SNMP notifications to disable sending the log events of the recovery operations to SNMP managers.
Error handling
These options are effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media. These options enable you to specify how to handle errors that might occur during recovery.
Additional settings
Specify the additional settings for the recovery operation by selecting or clearing the following check boxes.
113
This option defines whether to validate a backup to ensure that the backup is not corrupted, before data is recovered from it.
114
4 Vaults
A vault is a location for storing backup archives. For ease of use and administration, a vault is associated with the archives' metadata. Referring to this metadata makes for fast and convenient operations with archives and backups stored in the vault. A vault can be organized on a local or networked drive, detachable media or a tape device attached to the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node. There are no settings for limiting a vault size or number of backups in a vault. You can limit the size of each archive using cleanup, but the total size of archives stored in the vault is limited by the storage size only. Why create vaults? We recommend that you create a vault in each destination where you are going to store backup archives. This will ease your work as follows. Quick access to the vault You will not have to remember paths to the folders where the archives are stored. When creating a backup plan or a task that requires selection of an archive or an archive destination place, the list of vaults will be available for quick access without drilling down through the folders tree. Easy archive management A vault is available for access from the Navigation pane. Having selected the vault, you can browse the archives stored there and perform the following archive management operations:
get a list of backups included in each archive recover data from a backup examine backup content validate all archives in the vault or individual archives or backups mount a volume backup to copy files from the backup to a physical disk safely delete archives and backups from the archives.
Creating vaults is highly recommended but is not obligatory. You may choose not to use the shortcuts and always specify the full path to the archive vault. All of the above operations except for archive and backup deletion can be performed without creating vaults. The operation of creating a vault results in adding the vault name to the Vaults section of the Navigation pane.
115
4.1
Centralized vaults
A centralized vault is a networked location allotted by the management server administrator to serve as storage for the backup archives. A centralized vault can be managed by a storage node or be unmanaged. The total number and size of archives stored in a centralized vault is limited by the storage size only. As soon as the management server administrator commits to creating a centralized vault, the vault path and name are distributed to all machines registered on the server. The shortcut to the vault appears on the machines in the Vaults > Centralized group. Any backup plan existing on the machines, including local plans, can use the centralized vault. On a machine that is not registered on the management server, a user having the privilege to back up to the centralized vault can do so by specifying the full path to the vault. If the vault is managed, the user's archives, as well as other archives stored in the vault, will be managed by the storage node.
Managed vaults
The managed vault is a centralized vault managed by a storage node. The storage node performs storage node-side cleanup (p. 357) and storage node-side validation (p. 358) for each archive stored in the managed vault. When creating a managed vault, an administrator can specify additional operations that the storage node will perform (deduplication (p. 61), encryption). Management operations cannot be canceled or disabled. They will be performed for all archives stored in the vault unless the vault is deleted. Any managed vault is self-contained, that is, contains all metadata the storage node needs to manage the vault. In case the storage node is lost or its database is corrupted, the new storage node retrieves the metadata and re-creates the database. When the vault is attached to another storage node, the same procedure takes place. Accessing managed vaults To be able to back up to a managed vault, a user must have an account on the machine where the storage node is installed. The scope of a user's privileges in a vault depends on the user's rights on the storage node. A user who is a member of the Users group can view and manage his/her own archives. Members of the Administrators group can view and manage any archive stored on the storage node. A user who is a member of the Administrators group on a managed machine can view and manage archives created by any user of this machine.
116
To learn more about privileges depending on the user rights, see the User privileges on a storage node (p. 67) section.
Unmanaged vaults
An unmanaged vault is a centralized vault that is not managed by a storage node. To access an unmanaged vault, a user has to have access privileges for the location from the network. Any user that has permission to read/write files in an unmanaged vault can:
back up data to the unmanaged vault recover data from any backup located in the unmanaged vault. view and manage all the archives located in the unmanaged vault.
4.1.1
This section briefly describes the main elements of the Centralized vault view, and suggests ways to work with them.
Vault toolbar
The toolbar contains operational buttons that let you perform operations with the selected centralized vault. See the Actions on centralized vaults (p. 118) section for details.
[for managed vaults only] the name of the storage node that manages the vault full path to the vault total number of archives and backups stored in the vault the ratio of the occupied space to the original data size [for managed vaults only] deduplication (p. 61) state (On, Off) [for managed vaults only] encryption state (Yes, No)
Vault content
The Vault content section contains the archives table and toolbar. The archives table displays archives and backups that are stored in the vault. Use the archives toolbar to perform actions on the selected archives and backups. The list of backups is expanded by clicking the "plus" sign to the left of the archive's name. All the archives are grouped by type on the following tabs:
The Disk archives tab lists all the archives that contain disk or volume backups (images). The File archives tab lists all the archives that contain file backups.
117
Operations with backups (p. 149) Filtering and sorting archives (p. 150)
4.1.2
All the operations described here are performed by clicking the corresponding buttons on the vaults toolbar. These operations can be also accessed from the [Vault name] actions bar (on the Actions and tools pane) and from the [Vault name] actions item of the main menu. The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with centralized vaults.
To Create a managed or an unmanaged vault Do 1. Click Create.
2. In the Type field, select the vault type: Managed or Unmanaged The procedure of creating centralized vaults is described in-depth in the following sections:
Create a managed centralized vault (p. 119) Create an unmanaged centralized vault (p. 121)
Edit a managed or an unmanaged vault 1. Select the vault. 2. Click Edit.
Depending on the vault you select (managed or unmanaged), the respective Edit page will be opened:
The Edit managed vault page lets you change the vault's name, encryption
password (if the vault is encrypted) and information in the Comments field.
The Edit unmanaged vault page lets you edit the vault's name and information in
the Comments field. Validate a vault 1. Select the vault. 2. Click Validate.
You will be taken to the Validation (p. 217) page with an already pre-selected vault as a source. The vault validation checks all the archives in this vault. Delete a vault 1. Select the vault. 2. Click Delete.
You'll be asked whether to keep the archives stored in the vault, or delete the vault along with all the archives. The plans and tasks that use this vault will fail. If you choose to keep the archives for a managed vault, the vault will be detached from the storage node. Later on, you'll be able to attach this vault to the same or to
118
The vault will be available for examination with the standard file manager program. Attach the managed vault that was deleted without removing its content. Change user credentials for accessing a vault Refresh a vault's information Click Attach.
The procedure of attaching a managed vault to a storage node is described in-depth in the Attaching a managed vault (p. 122) section. Click Change user. Changing user credentials is available for vaults that reside on shared storages only. Click Refresh.
While you are reviewing the vault content, archives can be added to the vault, deleted or modified. Click Refresh to update the vault information with the most recent changes.
Actions on a tape library on a managed vault Define tape labels and perform inventorying of a tape library on a managed vault Rescan tapes in a managed vaults Click Manage tapes.
In the Tape Management window, define labels for tapes and refresh the inventory. For more details, see the Managing tape library (p. 128) section. Click Rescan tapes.
Rescan reads information about the content of user-selected tapes and updates the storage node database. This operation is described in-depth in the Rescan (p. 129) section.
Vault
Name Specify a unique name for the vault. Creation of two centralized vaults with the same name is prohibited. Comments [Optional] Enter the distinctive description of the vault being created. Type Select the Managed type. Storage node Select the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node that will manage the vault. You may need to enter access credentials for the storage node.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 119
Path (p. 120) Specify where the vault will be created. Managed centralized vaults can reside on a network share, SAN, NAS, or on a hard drive local to the storage node. Database path (p. 120) Specify a local folder on the storage server to create a vault-specific database. This database will store the metadata required for cataloguing the archives and performing deduplication. Deduplication [Optional] Select whether to enable archive deduplication in the vault. Deduplication minimizes storage space taken by the archives and backup traffic. It reduces the size of archives in the vault by eliminating redundant data such as duplicate files or disk blocks. Deduplication is not possible on tape devices. To learn more about how deduplication works, see the Deduplication (p. 61) section. Compression [Optional] Select whether to compress the deduplication data store. This setting is available only if deduplication is enabled. Encryption (p. 121) [Optional] Select whether to protect the vault with encryption. Anything written to the vault will be encrypted and anything read from it will be decrypted transparently by the storage node, using a vault-specific encryption key stored on the storage node. After you have performed all the required steps, click OK to commit creating the managed vault.
Vault path
To specify the path where the managed vault will be created
1. Enter the full path to the folder in the Path field or select the desired folder in the folders tree. Managed vaults can be organized:
on the hard drives local to the storage node on a network share on a Storage Area Network (SAN) on a Network Attached Storage (NAS) on a tape library locally attached to the storage node. Create folder.
To create a new folder for the vault in the selected location, click 2. Click OK.
A vault can be created in an empty folder only.
We do not recommend crea ting a deduplicating managed vault on a FAT32 volume. Th e rea son is that su ch vault stores all deduplica ted items in two potentially la rge files. Because the maximu m file size in th e FAT file systems is limited to 4 GB, the sto rage node may stop working when this limit is reach ed. The folder permissions must allo w the u ser a ccount under which th e sto rage node's service is running (by default, ASN User) to write to th e folder. When assigning permissions, specify the u ser a ccount explicitly (not just Everyone).
Create folder.
When choosing a folder for the vault's database, follow these considerations:
The folder size may become largeone estimate is 200 GB per 8 TB of used space, or about 2.5 percent. The folder permissions must allow the user account under which the storage node's service is running (by default, ASN User) to write to the folder. When assigning permissions, specify the user account explicitly (not just Everyone).
Vault encryption
If you protect a vault with encryption, anything written to the vault will be encrypted and anything read from it will be decrypted transparently by the storage node, using a vault-specific encryption key stored on the node. In case the storage medium is stolen or accessed by an unauthorized person, the malefactor will not be able to decrypt the vault contents without access to the storage node. This encryption has nothing to do with the archive encryption specified by the backup plan and performed by an agent. If the archive is already encrypted, the storage node-side encryption is applied over the encryption performed by the agent.
AES 128 the vault contents will be encrypted using the Advanced Standard Encryption (AES) algorithm with a 128-bit key AES 192 the vault contents will be encrypted using the AES algorithm with a 192-bit key
AES 256 the vault contents will be encrypted using the AES algorithm with a 256-bit key. 5. Click OK. The AES cryptographic algorithm operates in the Cipher-block chaining (CBC) mode and uses a randomly generated key with a user-defined size of 128, 192 or 256 bits. The larger the key size, the longer it will take for the program to encrypt the archives stored in the vault and the more secure the archives will be. The encryption key is then encrypted with AES-256 using a SHA-256 hash of the password as a key. The password itself is not stored anywhere on the disk; the password hash is used for verification purposes. With this two-level security, the archives are protected from any unauthorized access, but recovering a lost password is not possible.
Vault
Name Specify a unique name for the vault. The creation of two centralized vaults with the same name is prohibited. Comments
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 121
Enter the distinctive description of the vault. Type Select the Unmanaged type. Path (p. 122) Specify where the vault will be created. After you have performed all the required steps, click OK to commit creating the unmanaged centralized vault.
Vault path
To specify the path where the unmanaged vault will be created
1. Enter the full path to the folder in the Path field or select the desired folder in the folders tree. Unmanaged vaults can be organized:
on a network share on a Storage Area Network (SAN) on a Network Attached Storage (NAS) on FTP and SFTP servers.
According to the original FTP specifica tion, cred entials required for a ccess to FTP servers are transferred through a netwo rk as plaintext. This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer.
Create folder.
2. Click OK.
Vault
Storage node Select the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node that will manage the vault. Path Specify the path to the location where the archives are stored. Database path Specify a local folder on the storage server to create a vault-specific database. This database will store the metadata required for cataloguing the archives and performing deduplication. Password
122 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
For the vault that was encrypted, provide the encryption password. After you have performed all the required steps, click OK to commit to attaching the vault. This procedure may last for quite a while since the storage node has to scan the archives, write the metadata in the database, and deduplicate the archives if the vault was originally deduplicating.
4.1.3
Tape libraries
This section describes in detail how to use robotic tape devices as vaults for storing backup archives. A tape library (robotic library) is a high-capacity storage device that contains the following:
one or more tape drives multiple (up to several thousand) slots to hold tape cartridges one or more loaders (robotic mechanisms) intended for relocating the tape cartridges between the slots and the tape drives barcode readers (optional).
Overview
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 provides full support of a tape library through Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node. The storage node should be installed on the machine a tape library is attached to. Storage node can simultaneously use more than one tape library for keeping archives. To manage a tape library media, the storage node uses the Windows Removable Storage Manager (RSM). See the RSM Media Pools (p. 124) section for more information. A dedicated database of the storage node keeps information of the backup content written onto the tapes. So some operations (for example, Cleanup (p. 350)) can be performed quite fast without accessing the media. It is possible to view the content of a backup archive located on a tape through the console, even if a tape library is turned off, due to content information stored in the database. To create an incremental or differential backup of data, the program uses the database instead of loading, mounting, rewinding and reading a tape with the full data backup. However, a tape should be read, for example, to validate (p. 359) a backup or to recover data from a backup. A tape library can be locally attached to a machine the agent is installed on, but only in the case the library is considered as a single tape drive. The agent can use such device to write and read data backups, but the backups format differs from the format of the backups on the tapes written through the storage node. To get information about the readability of the archives on tapes, written by different components of other versions of the product by means of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10, see the Tape compatibility table (p. 42) section. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 enables you to set up distribution of backups by media. For example, a separate tape set can be used to back up some specific data, and the backups of all other data will be written onto any currently mounted tape, which does not belong to the tape set. See the Tape support (p. 103) section for more information. The backup schemes (Grandfather-Father-Son (p. 31), Tower of Hanoi (p. 35)) considerably assist you with creating effective schedule and retention rules for backups on a tape library. In combination with the tape options, the backup schemes enable you to reuse, in automatic mode, the tapes that are considered as free after backup deletion. See the Tape rotation (p. 131) section for more information.
123
Hardware
A tape library (robotic library) is a high-capacity storage device that contains the following:
one or more tape drives multiple (up to several thousand) slots to hold tape cartridges one or more loaders (robotic mechanisms) intended for relocating the tape cartridges between the slots and the tape drives barcode readers (optional). a barcode to scan by a special reader that is usually mounted on a loader a readable barcode digital value.
Each tape may have a special label attached to the side of a cartridge and comprise of:
Such labels are used for tape identification in a tape library or especially in off-site storage. If all cartridges in a tape library have barcodes, the library is ready to be automatically managed by software. Tape libraries are a cost-effective solution for data storages with huge capacity. Moreover, tape is perfect for archiving because cartridges can be stored off-site for enhanced data security. However reading even a small amount of data from a tape library takes much more time (from several seconds to several minutes) than from other types of data storages. The best practice of tape usage is "LESS requests to write/read LARGER amount of data". So systematic access to very large quantities of data is more suitable for a tape library than random access to small portions of data.
Limitations
Limitations of tape library usage are the following: 1. The consolidation (p. 351) operation is not possible for archives located on tapes. Deletion of a single separate backup is impossible from a tape. It is possible to delete all the backups stored on a tape. However, after this operation all the incremental and differential backups, stored on other tapes and based on the deleted backups, cannot be used for data recovery. In a Custom backup plan's retention rules the If deletion of a backup affects other backups > Consolidate the backup option is disabled. Only the Postpone the deletion option is available. 2. Deduplication (p. 351) is not available for archives located on tape storage devices. 3. File recovery from a disk backup stored on tape is possible, but can take a very long time. 4. A tape with backups written by the storage node cannot be read on a tape device, locally attached to a machine, the agent is installed on, because of a difference in tape format. To get information about the readability of the archives on tapes, written by different components of other versions of the product by means of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10, see the Tape compatibility table (p. 42) section. 5. Barcode printers are not used.
System media pools include Free pool, Import pool and Unrecognized pool. The System pools hold media that are not currently used by applications. The Free pool holds media that are considered as free and can be used by applications. The Import and Unrecognized pools are temporary pools for media that are new in certain library. Through RSM an application can get its own pools with proper names, move media from the Free pool into its own pools, use its own pools media for correct purpose, return media to the Free pool, etc. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node manages the tapes belonging to the Acronis pool. If you fill tape library slots with unused tapes, all the tapes will be included into the Free pool automatically. If a tape was used previously, the RSM tries to detect the registered application the tape is concerned to. If the application is not found, the RSM will move the tape into the Unrecognized pool. If the application is not found, but the RSM database has no information about the tape, it will be moved into the Import pool. If the RSM database has the information, the tape moves into its own pool of the application. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node provides the RSM to detect the tapes written by Acronis True Image Echo, Acronis True Image 9.1 product families and by components of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10. The storage node will locate all tapes written in Acronis format into the Acronis pool at the Inventory (p. 128) operation. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components dont use the Unrecognized pool. To utilize a tape from this pool forcibly, move the tape to the Free pool using the Removable storage snap-in (Control panel > Administrative tools > Computer management > Removable storage > Media pools).
If a tape has moved into the Fr ee pool, it is considered as free and will b e accessible to write by any application. So the tape data will be lost.
If all the backups are deleted from a tape, it will not return to the Free pool. It remains in the Acronis pool as a free tape to be reused. So if a storage node needs a new tape, it finds a free tape first in the Acronis pool, then in the Free pool. Thereinafter Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node deals only with the tapes belonging to the Acronis pool.
Prerequisites
A tape library device has to be installed on a machine running Windows in accordance with the device manufacturers installation instructions. If Removable Storage Manager (RSM) is present in your version of Windows, it must be activated. In Microsoft Windows XP and Microsoft Windows Server 2003:
Removable Storage Manager is part of the operating system and is activated initially.
1. Click Administrative Tools > Server Manager > Features > Add Feature. 2. Select the Removable Storage Manager check box. To activate Removable Storage Manager in Microsoft Windows Vista: 1. Click Control Panel > Programs > Programs and Features > Turn Windows features on or off. 2. Select the Removable Storage Management check box.
Fill the library slots with tape cartridges. If a tape does not get a barcode or its barcode is corrupted, you can define the tape label for identification purposes later. You should have Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server and Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console installed on local or remote machines, as well as Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node, installed on the machine with the tape library device, and registered in the management server.
Manage tapes displays the Tape Management window allowing you to refresh information on the library slots, inventory tapes in the slots, and define labels for the tapes. If you have a new label assigned to the tape, the action enables you to eject the tape temporarily to make the same label outside the cartridge. Rescan tapes displays the Tape Rescanning window, which is useful for selecting slots and launching the Rescan (p. 129) procedure to read some special information on the content of the specified tapes.
Also the Edit, Delete, Validate, and Refresh functions are allowed on a tape library vault.
126 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
It should be noted, these functions have some specific features for a tape library. So the Edit operation enables you to substitute a tape library device without the Rescan operation. The Delete operation clears all the information on the selected tape library vault from the storage node database, i.e. the operation deletes the content data of all the tapes, when ever the data is used by the storage node on the tape library device.
At the Delete operation, th e vault con tent will be d eleted fro m the sto rage node database without accessing the tapes. Th e plans and tasks that u se this vault will fail. The backup archives, belonging to a deleting cen tralized vault on a tape lib rary, will be d eleted as well, but these a rchives might be recovered by any sto rage node th rough the Rescan operation.
number of tapes currently used by the backup operation labels of the tapes used by the task up to the current time in case of backup splitting label of the tape that is currently written.
127
When recovering, you start creating a recovery task, select the tape device vault, and select the archive and the backup to recover data from. At task creation, the program uses the storage node database instead of accessing tapes. However, selection of data to recover (e.g. some files or specific volumes) requires reading of one or more tapes, so it might be durational. The program finds the tapes and inserts them automatically in the right order. The Task Need Interaction window comes up if a required tape is not found. Keep in mind that a data recovery operation may require access to a number of tapes. For example, data recovery from an incremental backup commonly might require loading, mounting, rewinding and reading of the following tapes containing the data backups:
tapes storing the incremental backup selected to recover the data tapes storing the last full backup created before the selected incremental one tapes storing the last differential backup created after the last full backup but before the selected incremental one if necessary tapes containing all incremental backups created after the last full or differential backups before the selected incremental one if necessary.
While a recovery task is running, the following tape-specific information is accessible from the management console:
labels of all the tapes that may be required for the operation label of the tape that is currently being read labels of the tapes that have already been read labels of tapes that are still waiting to be read with information of their current availability (loaded or not).
Any user with access to a managed vault on a tape library is able to perform these operations. However two or more users cannot manage a tape library drive simultaneously, because some operations can take minutes, hours or even days. For example, if a user launches a tape library Rescan task, all other users' requests to perform the same task will be canceled automatically, as it is already running on the vault.
Inventory
A storage node needs information about a tape in its own database to be able to operate with the tape. So after the vault is created, generally the next step is to inventory tapes. Inventorying is a procedure that allows the storage node recognize tapes that are currently loaded into the tape library slots. It is relatively fast and normally requires reading the cartridge barcodes without reading the tape data. If a barcode cannot be read, the tape will be mounted to read its GUID identifier only. The Inventory procedure can be run manually by a user or automatically, when access to recently added tapes is required.
128 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
To launch the procedure select the tape library vault in the Navigation pane of the console, click Manage tapes and then click Start inventory on the Tape Management window. When inventorying is completed a user has the list of tapes currently loaded into the library. Perform the procedure every time you load new tapes into tape library slots.
Rescan
As stated above the storage node keeps information about tapes and their contents in a dedicated database. The Rescan task reads information about the content of user-selected tapes and updates the database. The task can take a long-time so it is only initiated manually. You should select each slot with a tape you want to rescan before the task launch. Run the Rescan task:
for tapes that are unknown for the storage node if the storage node database is lost or damaged for tapes whose content is out of date (for example, a tape content was modified through another storage node or manually).
Bear in mind, a tape might keep some backups that were deleted before the tape rescanning. So after the task is completed, all such backups will be recovered in the storage node database and become accessible for data recovery. At rescanning a tape label should be saved in the storage node database. If a slot, selected for the procedure, contains a tape that still does not have a label, the Rescan task for the tape is paused to perform the Labeling (p. 129) procedure.
Labeling
When a tape required for data recovery is not found, the Task Need Interaction window will ask the user to bring the tape and insert it into a tape library slot. So, all the tape cartridges need a barcode or other readable labels. If a tape does not get a label, you should define it before the tape will be used. If you need to apply a specific label for a tape (for example, MyWork label for a tape dedicated to back up files from the folder C:\work) instead of a barcode label, use the Labeling procedure as well. To launch the procedure, select the tape library vault in the Navigation pane of the console, and click Manage tapes on the toolbar. Then the Tape Management window will show a list of the library slots that contain tapes. For every tape belonging to the Free pool or to the Acronis pool, the slot data field indicates the tape label. Labels are also displayed for tapes that are in the Imported pool and contain backups written by Acronis (such might be the case when you bring a tape from another tape library). By default, an unused tape with a barcode gets a label that is equal to the barcode. If a barcode is absent or corrupted, the label name will be created automatically. You can accept proposed labels or provide your own label as a plain text. Tapes from the Free or the Imported pool can be renamed on condition that the user account used to run the storage node service (ASN User) has write permissions for these pools. These permissions are not assigned to ASN User during installation, so you might need to add them manually.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 129
To define your own label for a tape, select a related data field, type in a new label, click Eject tape, write the same label on the tape cartridge (to make association with the label) and insert it back into the same slot. Once all the required tape labels are specified press Set labels to store labels in the storage node database.
Tape support
These options are effective when the backup destination is a managed vault located on a tape library. Tape support options enable you to specify how the backup tasks will distribute backups among the tapes.
Some co mbinations of tape op tions might d egrade usage efficiency of both the whole tape lib rary and each tape. If you a re not fo rced to modify these op tions by some sp ecific needs, leave them unchanged.
An archive can occupy several tapes. In such cases a so-called tape set is used for keeping the data backups. Tape set is a logical group of one or more tapes which contain backups of the specific protected data. A tape set can contain backups of other data as well. Separate tape set is a tape set which contains only backups of the specific protected data. Other backups cannot be written to a separate tape set.
Ask for user interaction - the backup task will enter the Need Interaction state and wait for the tape, with the required label, to be loaded into the tape library device. Use a free tape - the backup will be written onto a free tape, so the operation will be paused only if there is no free tape in the library.
130
The preset is: Disabled. When this option is enabled, each full backup will be written onto a free tape. The tape will be loaded to a drive especially for this operation. If the Use a separate tape set option is enabled, only incremental and differential backups of the same data will be appended to the tape.
The preset is: Disabled. When this option is enabled, each differential backup will be written onto a free tape. This option is available only when using free tape for each full backup is selected.
The preset is: Disabled. When this option is enabled, each incremental backup will be written onto a free tape. This option is available only when using free tape for each full and differential backup is selected.
Tape rotation
If all backups are deleted from a tape, i.e. if information about the last backup on the tape is deleted from the storage node database, the tape is considered as empty and can be reused during a backup cycle. The same tape rotation enables you to get by with the minimum number of cartridges and not to be buried in used tapes. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 enables you to achieve full automation of tape rotation while backing up onto tape libraries. This section provides you with useful information to choose a backup scheme and tape options for tape rotation. To calculate the number of tapes required for tape rotation schemes, you can use the method described in the Tape planning (p. 142) section.
If your backup archive must provide recovery with daily resolution for the last several days, weekly resolution for the last several weeks and monthly resolution for any time in the past, the most preferred scheme for you is the Grandfather-Father-Son scheme. If the main goal is to provide data protection for the longest period with the minimal number of used tapes permanently loaded into a small tape library (e.g. autoloader), the best solution is to probably choose the Tower of Hanoi scheme. The Custom backup scheme enables you to specify a backup schedule and retention rules to define a desired tape rotation. Use this scheme, when the Grandfather-Father-Son and the Tower of Hanoi schemes usage is not enough. For example, if the full size of protected data is considerably less than the size of a tape, the best choice is to use the Custom backup scheme with regular daily/weekly/monthly full backups, some simple retention rules, and tape options by default.
full size of the data to protect approximate size of the daily changes of data approximate size of the weekly changes of data requirements for the backup scheme (frequency, performance and duration of backup operations) requirements for keeping backups (minimal/maximal period of backup keeping; need to store tape cartridges off-site) capability of the tape library (number of drives, loaders, slots and available tapes; capacity of tapes) requirements for performing data recovery (maximal duration)
You need to analyze every argument that is relevant for your case and select the main criteria for the choice. Then choose a backup scheme and specify the tape options. Note, that any backup scheme in combination with different tape options will have quite different results for efficient use of both tapes and devices.
Case to analyze
Suppose you need to automate a tape rotation for the case if:
the full size of the data to protect is approximately 320 GB the approximate size of daily changes of data is about 16 GB the approximate size of weekly changes of data is no more than 40 GB tape capacity is 400 GB.
Lets analyze the results of a combination of GFS and ToH schemes with different tape options for the case. All the below analyzed examples are a simplistic approach to a real case, but provide you with a general conception of backup distribution onto tapes.
Weekly/differential backups (40 GB) are displayed as a blue rectangle: Any full monthly backup (320 GB) is drawn in orange: . A whole tape (400 GB) is drawn as a gray rectangle: .
Start backup at: 11:00:00 PM Back up on: Workdays Weekly/Monthly: Friday Keep backups: Daily: 2 weeks; Weekly: 2 months; Monthly: 1 year.
The main goal is to achieve full automation of tape rotation for these settings. Keep in mind that a monthly backup is full, a weekly backup is differential, and a daily backup is incremental in this implementation of the GFS scheme. The first backup is always full. So if the backup policy/plan starts on Wednesday and full backups should be created on every fourth Friday, on Wednesday the first backup will be full instead of an incremental one. There are analyzed examples showing how the GFS scheme can be combined with different tape options in the following sections:
GFS Example 1 (p. 133). The Use a separate tape set option is selected. All the Always use a free tape options are cleared. It requires 25 tapes in rotation. GFS Example 2 (p. 136). The Use a separate tape set option is selected. The Always use a free tape: For each full backup option is selected. Other Always use a free tape options are cleared. It requires 16 tapes in rotation. GFS Example 3 (p. 138). The Use a separate tape set option is selected. All the Always use a free tape options are selected. It requires 28 tapes in rotation.
These examples demonstrate how the number of tapes required for automated rotation depends on the tape options. If a tape library does not have enough tapes for automated rotation, the Tasks Need Interaction window will sometimes ask you to load a free tape into the library.
GFS Example 1
Suppose, the backup plan has the following tape options:
the Use a separate tape set option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each full backup option is cleared the Always use a free tape: For each incremental backup option is cleared the Always use a free tape: For each differential backup option is cleared.
Imagine the first backup operation is scheduled on Friday 1st of January. On that day at 11:00 PM the first full backup (320 Gb on the tape whose size is 400 Gb) is created. As the Use a separate tape set option is selected, the currently mounted tape is ejected (if it is not a free tape). Then a free tape is
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 133
loaded especially for backing up the data. The tape is marked with number 01 in the figure below. In accordance with the legend described in the Case to analyze (p. 132) section, the full data backup is displayed as an orange rectangle in the figure. The specified GFS backup scheme settings force the data to be backed up on Workdays only, so the next backup is created at the same time (11:00 PM) on Monday 4th of January. This backup is an incremental one (16 Gb) that is written onto the same tape 01, because the Always use a free tape: For each incremental backup option is cleared. The backup is drawn as a green rectangle in the figure.
The next three incremental backups are written onto tape 01 on 5th, 6th and 7th of January. As a result the free space on the tape is only 16 Gb at the moment. On 8th of January the data differential backup (40 Gb) is recorded onto the same tape 01, as the Always use a free tape: For each differential backup option is cleared. However the tape reached the end after the first 16 Gb of the backup is written. Then the tape is dismounted and ejected from the drive into a slot by the loader. Further, a free tape is loaded into the same drive and mounted, and then the backup (last 24 Gb) is continued onto the beginning of the new tape. The next figure demonstrates the data backup archive at the moment. The differential backup is drawn as a blue rectangle in the figure. Number 1 in the green rectangle marks the incremental backup created on Monday of the 1st week of the year.
four incremental and one differential backup on the second week four incremental and one differential backup on the third week four incremental backups on the 4th week.
The next full backup (320 Gb) should be written on Friday of the 4th week. However tape 02 has only 104 Gb of free space at the moment. So after the tape reaches the end, the recording continues from the beginning of free tape 03.
Keep in mind, that the Cleanup task is launched after each backup operation for the GFS scheme. This task deletes all the outdated backups. The next figure shows dark-gray rectangles instead of the backups deleted up to the current time.
Physically the deleted backups are still on the tapes; however information about the backups is deleted from the storage node database.
134
Below, the figure shows the deleted backups as actual, but demonstrates tape usage during the whole year for the GFS backup scheme in combination with the specified tape options. A number in the green rectangle marks an incremental backup created on Monday of the corresponding week of the year.
The next figure shows the actual usage of the tapes with free space instead of the deleted backups on the first Friday of the following year. At the time the differential backup (blue rectangle) is written onto tape 24.
135
The full backup stored on tape 01 is deleted after the next full backup is created onto both tapes 23 and 24 on Friday of the 52nd week. As all backups of tape 01 have been deleted, the tape is considered as free and can be reused. Further analysis of the example proves that the maximal number of tapes required to store the data backups is 25 tapes. This maximum occurs on the 16th week of the following year. The above mentioned figures show that a data recovery requires one or two tapes for a full backup, two or three tapes for a differential backup, and one, two or three tapes for an incremental backup. For example, if we need to recover data from a backup created on Monday of the 52nd week, the task will require the following tapes:
Tape 23 with an incremental backup (marked with "52") and a differential backup created on Friday of the 51st week Tape 21 and Tape 22 that contain a full backup created on Friday of the 48th week.
The example reveals the following shortcomings of the scheme combination with the specified tape options:
commonly any data recovery is a long process that requires loading, mounting, rewinding and reading of one (3% - for backups displayed in the "Tape usage during the first year" figure), two (65%) or three (32%) tapes 22 tapes are used to store 13 monthly full backups when the monthly backup size is less than the size of a tape, so keeping data is more expensive 25 tapes are required for full year rotation of the data backups.
GFS Example 2
Suppose, the backup plan has the following tape options: the Use a separate tape set option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each full backup option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each incremental backup option is cleared the Always use a free tape: For each differential backup option is cleared.
The example has only one difference from the previous one. That is selection of the Always use a free tape: For each full backup option. Below, the figure shows the deleted backups as actual, but demonstrates tape usage during the whole year for the GFS backup scheme in combination with the specified tape options. A number in the green rectangle marks an incremental backup created on Monday of the corresponding week of the year.
136
If all the backups have to be kept during the year, the archive will require 28 tapes.
As the GFS backup scheme forces automatic deletion of the outdated backups, on the first Friday of the second year the tapes keep only the backups displayed in the next figure.
137
This figure demonstrates that the GFS Example 2 tape rotation scheme is more suitable for the case than GFS Example 1. The advantages of the GFS Example 2 tape rotation scheme for the analyzed case are the following:
it uses 16 tapes instead of 25 a data recovery task requires one (25%) or two (75%) tapes data recovery from a full backup requires only one tape that makes the data recovery from an incremental or differential backup faster.
GFS Example 3
Imagine the backup plan has the following tape options:
the Use a separate tape set option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each full backup option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each incremental backup option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each differential backup option is selected.
These options define the tape rotation scheme that is classical for GFS. The figure shows the beginning of the rotation scheme that uses 8 tapes for daily backups, 6 tapes for weekly backups and 13 tapes for monthly backups (since there are 13 four-week cycles in a year) for the analyzed case. And one tape is required for the next backup. In total this rotation scheme, combined with the options requires 28 tapes.
To recover the data only one tape is required for a full backup, two tapes for a differential backup, and two or three tapes for an incremental backup. This scheme has the following advantages:
138
access to any full backup requires only one tape backup deletion frees a tape so it can be reused.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
The main drawback is the large number of required tapes that is used 5-10%. If we have to keep a daily backup for a week (4 backups) and a weekly backup for a month (4 backups), the total number of required tapes will be equal to 4+4+13+1 = 22.
Schedule: Start the task every 1 day at 11:00 PM. Repeat once. Number of levels: 5
The Tower of Hanoi scheme with five levels ensures that the roll-back period is 8 days. Lets designate the backups of the levels with numbers from 1 to 5 by letters A, B, C, D, and E respectively. Then the rotation template for the backup sequence in the archive is the following: E-A-B-A-C-A-B-AD-A-B-A-C-A-B-A. In the five-level ToH scheme all the backups on the 1st level (A) are incremental, on the 5th level (E) full, and other backups on levels 2, 3, and 4 (B, C, and D) are differential. Tape rotation for the ToH scheme substantially depends on the tape options, whose default settings do not always provide optimal usage of tapes and the whole tape library. The goal is to choose the tape options requiring the minimal number of tapes in the rotation. There are analyzed examples showing how the ToH scheme can be combined with different tape options in the following sections:
ToH Example 1 (p. 139). The Use a separate tape set option is selected. All the Always use a free tape options are cleared. It requires 5 tapes in rotation. ToH Example 2 (p. 140). The Use a separate tape set option is selected. The Always use a free tape: For each full backup option is selected. The other Always use a free tape options are cleared. It requires 4 tapes in rotation. ToH Example 3 (p. 141). The Use a separate tape set option is selected. All the Always use a free tape options are selected. It requires 7 tapes in rotation.
ToH Example 2 requires 4 tapes, which is the minimum for the case. So its tape options settings are the best in comparison with options for other examples.
ToH Example 1
Suppose, the backup plan has the following tape options:
139
the Use a separate tape set option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each full backup option is cleared the Always use a free tape: For each incremental backup option is cleared the Always use a free tape: For each differential backup option is cleared.
The figure below shows the tapes usage for the ToH scheme combined with the above mentioned tape options. The recurring part of the scheme contains sixteen backup sessions. The figure displays the backup archive state at the moment when the 17th session is finished.
As the Tower of Hanoi backup scheme forces presence of only one backup on each level, all the outdated backups are deleted automatically. In the next figure the deleted backups are drawn as dark-gray rectangles. Actually the deleted backup is still stored on the tapes, but the information about it is deleted from the storage node database.
The figure shows the full backup kept on tape 01 at the moment, which cannot be deleted as it is a base for actual differential (D, C, B) and incremental (A) backups stored on tape 02. The full backup deletion is postponed until all the above mentioned four backups will be deleted. The next figure demonstrates the tapes content at the moment before creation of the new backup on level D:
At the moment the data archive occupies four tapes, and the total size of the backups written up to the current time is maximal for the example. However, if in the future a full backup will be written at the end of a tape, the archive will occupy five tapes. After the next backup is created on level D, tape 01 is freed and can be reused. It is noticed that the ToH scheme combined with the specified options has the following properties for the analyzed case:
the last figure shows that the data recovery requires loading and mounting of up to three tapes (one tape - 16%, two tapes - 72%, three tapes - 12%) as well as rewinding and reading of one (6%), two (50%) or three (44%) backups five-level scheme requires up to five tapes for this case.
ToH Example 2
Suppose, the backup plan has the following tape options:
140
the Use a separate tape set option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each full backup option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each incremental backup option is cleared the Always use a free tape: For each differential backup option is cleared.
The only difference between ToH Example 2 and ToH Example 1 is that the Always use a free tape: For each full backup option is selected. The first figure shows the tapes usage for the ToH scheme combined with the above mentioned tape options. The recurring part of the scheme contains sixteen backup sessions. The figure displays the backup archive state at the moment when the 17th session is finished.
In the figure below the backups deleted at the moment are drawn as dark-gray rectangles.
The figure indicates that there are two full backups on level E because at the moment the first full backup is a base for differential backups D, C and B are a base for incremental backup A. So the full backup deletion is postponed until all the D, C, B and A backups will be deleted. The next figure shows the tape usage at the moment before creating a new backup on level D:
At the moment the backup archive occupies four tapes. It is the maximal number of tapes required in the example. After the next backup on level D is created, both tapes 01 and 02 are freed and can be reused. It is noticed that the ToH scheme combined with the specified options has the following properties for the analyzed case:
the data recovery requires access to the backups kept on one (25%) or two tapes (75%) five-level scheme can require up to four tapes.
So in this specific case the selection of the Always use a free tape: For each full backup option considerably increases the usage efficiency of the tapes in the library.
ToH Example 3
Imagine the backup plan has the following tape options:
141
the Always use a free tape: For each full backup option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each incremental backup option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each differential backup option is selected.
The figure shows tape rotation for the ToH scheme with these options.
Maximal number of tapes used in the rotation is seven that is more than in classical five-level ToH scheme. Two additional tapes used for: 1. keeping an old full backup (postponed deletion) as it is a base for other level backups 2. keeping an old backup on a level until a new backup has been successfully created on the level. The example demonstrates that the tapes usage efficiency is reduced. Moreover, the data recovery requires access to the backups kept on one (full backups, 6%), two (differential backups, 44%) or three (incremental backups, 50%) tapes. So on average the operation takes more time than in the previous examples.
Tape planning
Once you have specified the backup scheme and tape options, you should determine the minimal number of tapes necessary to achieve full automation of tape rotation. To simplify the tape planning lets discard the possibility that the calculated tapes might contain backups of other data. It is implied that the Use a separate tape set option is enabled. To calculate the number of tapes you should take into account the following considerations:
142
full backup size average size of incremental backups average size of differential backups
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
compression level specified for backing up the data tape rotation scheme ( frequency of backups, retention rules) tape-append options requirements to support off-site tape cartridge archives.
There is no common formula to calculate a number of tapes required in all possible combinations of above listed considerations. But the general way to get a number of tapes for a case includes the following steps: 1. 2. 3. 4. Draw (or write) a chain of backups until the first backup can be deleted Take into account the tape-append options, the chain might be sectioned onto tape sets Calculate the number of tapes in each tape set The sum of the calculated values gives the total number of tapes required for the case.
full backup size is F_GB average size of incremental backups is I_GB average size of differential backups is D_GB compression level provides CL average reduction coefficient selected tape rotation scheme is Tower of Hanoi with four levels tape options are the following: the Use a separate tape set option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each full backup option is cleared
the Always use a free tape: For each incremental backup option is cleared the Always use a free tape: For each differential backup option is cleared tape size is T_GB.
The Tower of Hanoi scheme with four levels (A, B, C, and D) specifies the following line of backups on the tapes before the first backup will be deleted: D (full), A, B, A, C, A, B, A, D, A, B, A, C. The specified tape options do not require using a free tape for any backup, so the backup line will be automatically split and continued on a new tape when the end of the current tape is reached. There is one tape set to calculate. Total number of required tapes = round up ((2*F_GB + 6*I_GB + 5*D_GB) * CL / T_GB) + 1. The above described ToH Example 1 (p. 139) is based on the five-level Tower of Hanoi backup scheme with the same tape options. Its backup line was the following: E (full), A, B, A, C, A, B, A, D, A, B, A, C, A, B, A, E, A, B, A, C, A, B, A, D. Total number of required tapes = round up ((2*F_GB + 12*I_GB + 11*D_GB) * CL / T_GB) + 1 = round up ( (2*320 + 12*16 + 11*40) * 1 / 400 ) + 1 = round up ( 3.18 ) + 1 = 5 (tapes).
full backup size is F_GB average size of incremental backups is I_GB average size of differential backups is D_GB
143
compression level provides CL average reduction coefficient selected tape rotation scheme is Custom with the following settings: full backup - every 10 days differential backup - every 2 days
incremental backup - every 1 day, every 6 hours retention rules: delete backups older than 5 days tape options are the following: the Use a separate tape set option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each full backup option is selected the Always use a free tape: For each incremental backup option is cleared
the Always use a free tape: For each differential backup option is cleared tape size is T_GB.
The case defines the line of backups that consists of two sections. The figure below shows the sections at the moment before the first backup will be deleted. In the figure the full, differential and incremental backups are designated as orange, blue and green rectangles respectively.
At the moment some backups are deleted by the Cleanup task. Deletion of the outdated backups painted in dark colors is postponed, as these backups are basic for the actual backups.
As an exact correlation between the tape size and backup's size is unknown, it is impossible to determine number of the tapes that will be free after the deletion. So the calculation ignores this probability. Tape set 01 should contain (round up (( F_GB + 4*D_GB + 5*7*I_GB) * CL / T_GB)) tapes to store the backups. Tape set 02 needs (round up (( F_GB + 1*D_GB + 7*I_GB) * CL / T_GB)) tapes. The sum of the calculated values gives the total number of tapes required for the case.
What if
What if I have to move tapes with backups from one tape library to another? 1. If both tape libraries are attached to the same machine with Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node installed (i.e. the libraries are managed by the same storage node), the storage node database has all the required information about the content of the moved tapes. So all you need to do is to perform the inventory (p. 128) procedure for the managed vault on the library where the tapes were placed to. 2. If you move tapes to a tape library managed by another storage node, you should rescan (p. 129) each relocated tape to provide the storage node with information about backups contained on the tape. What if I need to use a tape from the tape library in the local tape device and vice versa? Acronis agents create backups on tapes in a format that differs from the format used by the storage node. It is the reason why it is impossible to interchange tapes between tape devices attached to a storage node and attached to a managed machine: a tape written by a storage
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
144
node cannot be read by an agent in a locally attached tape device. However the storage node can read tapes written by an agent. Please refer to the tape compatibility table (p. 42) to get comprehensive information about the compatibility of tape formats in Acronis Backup & Recovery 10.
What if I have to reinstall the storage node or attach the tape library to another machine? Install a storage node on the machine the tape library is attached to, create a centralized vault on the tape library, and then rescan each tape containing backups. What if I have lost my storage node and need to recover data from a tape? If you know which tape has the data to recover, and you have a tape device with vault managed by a storage node, insert the tape cartridge into the device, go to the Centralized vaults view of the console, select the vault, rescan the tape, select the archive and the backup to recover data from, and create the recovery task. If you don't know which tape has the data to recover, you have to rescan each tape until the data is found. Generally all the steps you need to do are the same as mentioned above, except the rescan has to be applied to a number of tapes instead one tape. What if I need to recover data from an Echo tape? Use the table from the Tape compatibility table (p. 42) section to find out which Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components can read data from your tape.
4.2
Personal vaults
A vault is called personal if it was created using direct connection of the console to a managed machine. Personal vaults are specific for each managed machine. Personal vaults are visible to any user that can log on to the system. A user's right to back up to a personal vault is defined by the user's permission for the folder or device where the vault is located. A personal vault can be organized on detachable or removable media. Acronis Secure Zone is considered as a personal vault available to all users that can log on the system. Personal vaults can be used by local backup plans or local tasks. Centralized backup plans cannot use personal vaults except for Acronis Secure Zone.
Metadata
The .meta folder is created during backup in every personal vault. This folder contains additional information about archives and backups stored in the vault, such as archive owners or the machine name. If you accidentally delete the .meta folder, it will be automatically recreated next time you access the vault. But some information like owner names and machine names may be lost.
4.2.1
This section briefly describes the main elements of the Personal vault view, and suggests the ways to work with them.
145
Vault toolbar
The toolbar contains operational buttons that let you perform operations with the selected personal vault. See the Actions on personal vaults (p. 146) section for details.
full path to the vault total number of archives and backups stored in the vault the ratio of the occupied space to the original data size.
Vault content
The Vault content section contains the archives table and toolbar. The archives table displays archives and backups that are stored in the vault. Use the archives toolbar to perform actions on the selected archives and backups. The list of backups is expanded by clicking the "plus" sign to the left of the archive's name. All the archives are grouped by type on the following tabs:
The Disk archives tab lists all the archives that contain disk or volume backups (images). The File archives tab lists all the archives that contain file backups.
Related sections: Operations with archives stored in a vault (p. 148) Operations with backups (p. 149) Filtering and sorting archives (p. 150)
4.2.2
To perform any operation (except for creation) with a vault, you must select it first. All the operations described below are performed by clicking the corresponding buttons on the toolbar. These operations can be also accessed from the [Vault name] actions bar (on the Actions and Tools pane) and from the [Vault name] actions item of the main menu respectively.
146
The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with personal vaults.
To Do Create. Create a personal vault Click
The procedure of creating personal vaults is described in-depth in the Creating a personal vault (p. 147) section. Edit a vault 1. Select the vault. 2. Click Edit.
The Edit personal vault page lets you edit the vault's name and information in the Comments field. Change user account for accessing a vault Click Change user. In the appearing dialog box, provide the credentials required for accessing the vault. Click Create Acronis Secure Zone.
The procedure of creating the Acronis Secure Zone is described in-depth in the Creating Acronis Secure Zone (p. 231) section. Click Explore.
In the appearing Explorer window, examine the selected vault's content. Click Validate.
You will be taken to the Validation (p. 217) page, where this vault is already preselected as a source. The vault validation checks all the archives stored in the vault. Delete a vault Click Delete.
The deleting operation actually removes only a shortcut to the folder from the Vaults view. The folder itself remains untouched. You have the option to keep or delete archives contained in the folder. Refresh vault table information Click Refresh.
While you are reviewing the vault content, archives can be added to the vault, deleted or modified. Click Refresh to update the vault information with the most recent changes.
147
4.3
4.3.1
Common operations
Operations with archives stored in a vault
To perform any operation with an archive, you have to select it first. If the archive is protected with a password, you will be asked to provide it. All the operations described below are performed by clicking the corresponding buttons on the toolbar. These operations can be also accessed from the [Archive name] actions bar (on the Actions and tools pane) and from the [Archive name] actions item of the main menu respectively. The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with archives stored in a vault.
To Validate an archive Do Click Validate.
The V alidation (p. 217) page will be opened with the pre-selected archive as a source. Validation of an archive will check all the archive's backups. Export an archive Click Export.
The Export (p. 224) page will be opened with the pre-selected archive as a source. The export of an archive creates a duplicate of the archive with all its backups in the location you specify. Delete a single archive 1. Select the archive or one of the archives you want to delete.
148
or multiple archives
2. Click
Delete.
The program duplicates your selection in the Backups deletion (p. 150) window that has check boxes for each archive and each backup. Review the selection and correct if need be (select the check boxes for the desired archives), then confirm the deletion. Delete all archives in the Please be aware that if filters have been applied to the vaults list, you see only a part vault of the vault content. Be sure that the vault does not contain archives you need to retain before starting the operation. Click Delete all.
The program duplicates your selection in the new window that has check boxes for each archive and each backup. Review the selection and correct if need be, then confirm the deletion.
4.3.2
To perform any operation with a backup, you have to select it first. To select a backup, expand the archive, then click the backup. If the archive is protected with a password, you will be asked to provide it. All the operations described below are performed by clicking the corresponding buttons on the toolbar. These operations can be also accessed from the '[Backup name]' actions bar (on the Actions and tools pane) and from the '[Backup name]' actions item of the main menu. The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with backups.
To View backup content in a separate window Recover Do Click View content.
In the Backup Content window, examine the backup content. Click Recover.
The Recover data (p. 199) page will be opened with the pre-selected backup as a source. Recover a disk/volume as a virtual machine Right-click the disk backup, then select Recover as virtual m achine. The Recover data (p. 199) page will be opened with the pre-selected backup as a source. Select the location and the type of new virtual machine and then proceed as with regular disk or volume recovery. Click Validate.
Validate a backup
The V alidation (p. 217) page will be opened with the pre-selected backup as a source. Validation of a file backup imitates recovering of all files from the backup to a dummy destination. Validation of a disk backup calculates a checksum for every data block saved in the backup. Export a backup Click Export.
The Export (p. 224) page will be opened with the pre-selected backup as a source. The export of a backup creates a new archive with a self-sufficient copy of the backup in the location you specify. Delete a single or multiple backups Select one of the backups you want to delete, then click Delete.
The program duplicates your selection in the Backups deletion (p. 150) window that has check boxes for each archive and each backup. Review the selection and correct
149
if need be (select the check boxes for the desired backups), then confirm the deletion. Delete all archives and backups in the vault Please be aware that if filters have been applied to the vaults list, you see only a part of the vault content. Be sure that the vault does not contain archives you need to retain before starting the operation. Click Delete all.
The program duplicates your selection in the Backups deletion (p. 150) window that has check boxes for each archive and each backup. Review the selection and correct if need be, then confirm the deletion.
4.3.3
The Backups deletion window displays the same tab as for the vaults view, but with check boxes for each archive and backup. The archive or backup you have chosen to delete has the check mark. Review the archive or backup that you have selected to delete. If you need to delete other archives and backups select the respective check boxes, then click Delete selected and confirm the deletion. The filters in this window are from the archives list of the vault view. Thus, if some filters have been applied to the archives list, only the archives and backups corresponding to these filters are displayed here. To see all content, clean all the filter fields.
4.3.4
To
The following is a guideline for you to filter and sort archives in the archives table.
Sort backup archives by any column Filter archives by name, owner, or machine.
150
151
5 Scheduling
Acronis scheduler helps the administrator adapt backup plans to the companys daily routine and each employees work style. The plans tasks will be launched systematically keeping the critical data safely protected. The scheduler uses local time of the machine the backup plan exists on. Before creating a schedule, be sure the machines date and time settings are correct.
Schedule
To define when a task has to be executed, you need to specify an event or multiple events. The task will be launched as soon as any of the events occurs. The table below lists the events available under Windows operating systems.
Event Time: Daily, Weekly, Monthly Time passed since the last successful backup has completed (specify the length of time) User logon (any user, current user, specify the users account) User logoff (any user, current user, specify the users account) System startup Free space change (specify the amount of free space change on any volume selected for backup or containing data selected for backup) An event in Windows event log (specify the parameters of the event)
Condition
For backup operations only, you can specify a condition or multiple conditions in addition to the events. Once any of the events occurs, the scheduler checks the condition and runs the task if the condition is met. With multiple conditions, all of them must be met simultaneously to enable task execution. The table below lists the conditions available under Windows operating systems.
Condition: run the task only if User is idle (a screen saver is running or the machine is locked) Location's host is available The task run time is within the specified time interval All users are logged off The specified period of time has passed since the last successful backup completed
The scheduler behavior, in case the event occurs but the condition (or any of multiple conditions) is not met is defined by the Task start conditions (p. 102) backup option.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 152
What-ifs
What if an event occurs (and a condition, if any, is met) while the previous task run has not completed? The event will be ignored. What if an event occurs while the scheduler is waiting for the condition required by the previous event? The event will be ignored. What if the condition is not met for a very long time? If delaying a backup is getting risky, you can force the condition (tell the users to log off) or run the task manually. To automatically handle this situation, you can set the time interval after which the task will run regardless of the condition.
5.1
Daily schedule
In the During the day execute the task... area, select one of the following:
Once at: <...> Every: <...> From: <...> Until: <...> Set up the time at which the task will be run once. Set up how many times the task will be restarted during the specified time interval. For example, setting the task frequency to Every 1 hour From 10:00:00 AM until 10:00:00 PM allows the task to run 12 times: from 10 AM to 10 PM during one day.
To: <...>
Advanced scheduling settings (p. 159) are available only for machines registered on Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server. To specify these settings, click Change in the Advanced settings area. All the settings you made are displayed in the Result field at the bottom of the window.
Examples
"Simple" daily schedule Run the task every day at 6PM. The schedule's parameters are thus set up as follows. 1. Every: 1 day(s). 2. Once at: 06:00:00 PM.
153
3. Effective: From: not set. The task will be started on the current day, if it has been created before 6PM. If you have created the task after 6 PM, the task will be started for the first time on the next day at 6 PM. To: not set. The task will be performed for an indefinite number of days. "Three-hour time interval lasting for three months" schedule Run the task every three hours. The task starts on a certain date (say, September 15, 2009), and ends after three months. The schedule's parameters are thus set up as follows. 1. Every: 1 day(s). 2. Every: 3 hours From: 12:00:00 AM (midnight) Until: 09:00:00 PM - thus, the task will be performed 8 times a day with a 3 hour time interval. After the last daily recurrence at 9 PM, the next day comes and the task starts over again from midnight. 3. Effective: From: 09/15/2009. If September 15, 2009 is the current date of the task's creation and, say, 01:15 PM is the task's creation time, the task will be started when the nearest time interval comes: at 03:00 PM in our example. To: 12/15/2009. On this date the task will be performed for the last time, but the task itself is still available in the Tasks view. Several daily schedules for one task There are some cases when you might need the task to be run several times a day, or even several times a day with different time intervals. For such cases, consider adding several schedules to a single task. For example, suppose that the task has to be run every 3rd day, starting from 09/20/2009, five times a day:
The obvious way is to add five simple schedules. If you spend one minute for examination, you can think out a more optimal way. As you can see, the time interval between the first and the second task's recurrences is 4 hours, and between the third, fourth and fifth is 2 hours. In this case, the optimal way is to add two schedules to the task. First daily schedule 1. Every: 3 day(s). 2. Every: 4 hours. From: 08:00:00 AM Until: 12:00:00 PM. 3. Effective: From: 09/20/2009. To: not set.
154 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
Second daily schedule 1. Every: 3 day(s). 2. Every: 2 hour(s). From: 03:00:00 PM Until: 07:00:00 PM. 3. Effective: From: 09/20/2009. To: not set.
5.2
Weekly schedule
In the During the day execute the task... area, select one of the following: Once at: <...> Every: <...> From: <...> Until: <...> Set up the time at which the task will be run once. Set up how many times the task will be run during the specified time interval. For example, setting the task frequency to Every 1 hour From 10:00:00 AM until 10:00:00 PM allows the task to be run 12 times from 10 AM to 10 PM during one day.
To: <...>
Advanced scheduling settings (p. 159) are available only for machines registered on Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server. To specify these settings, click Change in the Advanced settings area. All the settings you made are displayed in the Result field at the bottom of the window.
Examples
"One day in the week" schedule Run the task every Friday at 10PM, starting from a certain date (say 05/14/2009) and ending after six months. The schedule's parameters are thus set up as follows. 1. Every: 1 week(s) on: Fri. 2. Once at: 10:00:00 PM. 3. Effective: From: 05/13/2009. The task will be started on the nearest Friday at 10 PM.
155
To: 11/13/2009. The task will be performed for the last time on this date, but the task itself will still be available in the Tasks view after this date. (If this date were not a Friday, the task would be last performed on the last Friday preceding this date.) This schedule is widely used when creating a custom backup scheme. The "One day in the week"-like schedule is added to the full backups, while the incremental backups are scheduled to be performed on workdays. For more details, see the Full and incremental backups plus cleanup example in the Custom backup scheme (p. 195) section. "Workdays" schedule Run the task every week on workdays: from Monday through Friday. During a workday, the task starts only once at 9 PM. The schedule's parameters are thus set up as follows. 1. Every: 1 week(s) on: <Workdays> - selecting the <Workdays> check box automatically selects the corresponding check boxes (Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, and Fri), and leaves the remaining ones unchanged. 2. Once at: 09:00:00 PM. 3. Effective: From: empty. If you have created the task, say on Monday at 11:30 AM, the task will be started on the same day at 9 PM. If the task was created, say on Friday after 9 PM, then it will be started for the first time on the nearest workday (Monday in our example) at 9 PM. End date: empty. The task will be restarted for an indefinite number of weeks. This schedule is widely used when creating a custom backup scheme. The "Workdays"-like schedule is added to the incremental backups, while the full backup is scheduled to be performed one day in the week. For more details, see the Full and incremental backups plus cleanup example in the Custom backup scheme (p. 195) section. Several weekly schedules for one task In the case when the task needs to be run on different days of the weeks with different time intervals, consider adding a dedicated schedule to every desired day of the week, or to several days. For example, you need the task to be run with the following schedule:
Monday: twice at 12 PM (noon) and 9 PM Tuesday: every 3 hours from 9 AM till 9 PM Wednesday: every 3 hours from 9 AM till 9 PM Thursday: every 3 hours from 9 AM till 9 PM Friday: twice at 12 PM and 9 PM (i.e. same as on Monday) Saturday: once at 9 PM Sunday: once at 9 PM
Combining the identical times, the following three schedules can be added to the task: First schedule 1. Every: 1 week(s) on: Mon, Fri. 2. Every: 9 hours From: 12:00:00 PM Until: 09:00:00 PM. 3. Effective:
156 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
From: not set. To: not set. Second schedule 1. Every 1 week(s) on: Tue, Wed, Thu. 2. Every 3 hours From 09:00:00 AM until 09:00:00 PM. 3. Effective: From: not set. To: not set. Third schedule 1. Every: 1 week(s) on: Sat, Sun. 2. Once at: 09:00:00 PM. 3. Effective: From: not set. To: not set.
5.3
Monthly schedule
In the During the day execute the task... area, select one of the following: Once at: <...> Every: <...> From: <...> Until: <...> Set up the time at which the task will be run once. Set up how many times the task will be run during the specified time interval. For example, setting the task frequency to Every 1 hour From 10:00:00 AM until 10:00:00 PM allows the task to be run 12 times from 10 AM to 10 PM during one day.
To: <...>
Advanced scheduling settings (p. 159) are available only for machines registered on Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server. To specify these settings, click Change in the Advanced settings area. All the settings you made are displayed in the Result field at the bottom of the window.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 157
Examples
"Last day of every month" schedule Run the task once at 10 PM on the last day of every month. The schedule's parameters are set up as follows. 1. 2. 3. 4. Months: <All months>. Days: Last. The task will run on the last day of every month despite its actual date. Once at: 10:00:00 PM. Effective: From: empty. To: empty.
This schedule is widely used when creating a custom backup scheme. The "Last day of every month" schedule is added to the full backups, while the differential backups are scheduled to be performed once a week and incremental on workdays. For more details, see the Monthly full, weekly differential, and daily incremental backups plus cleanup example in the Custom backup scheme (p. 195) section. "Season" schedule Run the task on all workdays during the northern autumn seasons of 2009 and 2010. During a workday, the task is performed every 6 hours from 12 AM (midnight) till 6 PM. The schedule's parameters are set up as follows. 1. Months: September, October, November. 2. On: <all> <workdays>. 3. Every: 6 hours. From: 12:00:00 AM Until: 06:00:00 PM. 4. Effective: From: 08/30/2009. Actually the task will be started on the first workday of September. By setting up this date we just define that the task must be started in 2009. To: 12/01/2010. Actually the task will end on the last workday of November. By setting up this date we just define that the task must be discontinued in 2010, after autumn ends in the northern hemisphere. Several monthly schedules for one task In the case when the task needs to be run on different days or weeks with different time intervals depending on the month, consider adding a dedicated schedule to every desired month or several months. Suppose that the task goes into effect on 11/01/2009.
During northern winter, the task runs once at 10PM on every workday. During northern spring and autumn, the task runs every 12 hours on all workdays. During northern summer, the task runs every first and fifteenth of every month at 10 PM.
Thus, the following three schedules are added to the task. First schedule 1. Months: December, January, February.
158 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
2. On: <All> <All workdays> 3. Once at: 10:00:00 PM. 4. Effective: From: 11/01/2009. To: not set. Second schedule 1. Months: March, April, May, September, October, November. 2. On: <All> <All workdays>. 3. Every: 12 hours From: 12:00:00 AM Until: 12:00:00 PM. 4. Effective: From: 11/01/2009. To: not set. Third schedule 1. 2. 3. 4. Months: June, July, August. Days: 1, 15. Once at: 10:00:00 PM. Effective: From: 11/01/2009. To: not set.
5.4
The following advanced settings are available when setting up a daily, weekly, or monthly schedule in a backup policy.
Use Wake-On-LAN
When this setting is enabled, Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server will use the WakeOn-LAN (WOL) functionality to wake up turned-off registered machines when a backup, cleanup or validation is scheduled to start. If the backup task on each machine starts with a delay (see the next setting), the management server will wake up the machines according to those delays. Before using this setting, make sure that you have enabled Wake-on-LAN on the registered machines. The machine's basic input/output system (BIOS) configuration, network adapter configuration, and the operating system configuration must allow waking up the machine from the powered-off statealso known as the S5 or G2 power state.
The delay value for each machine is determined when the policy is deployed to the machine, and remains the same until you edit the policy and change the maximum delay value. The conditions, if any, will be checked at the task's actual start time on each machine. The following examples illustrate this setting. Example 1 Suppose that you are deploying a backup policy with the following schedule to three machines: Run the task: Daily Once at: 09:00:00 AM Distribute start time within the time window Maximum delay: 1 Hour(s) Distribution method: Random Then the task's start time on each machine may be any time between 09:00:00 AM and 09:59:59 AMfor instance: First machine: Every day at 09:30:03 AM Second machine: Every day at 09:00:00 AM Third machine: Every day at 09:59:59 AM Example 2 Suppose that you are deploying a backup policy with the following schedule to three machines: Run the task: Daily Every: 2 Hour(s) From: 09:00:00 AM Until: 11:00:00 AM Distribute start time within the time window Maximum delay: 1 Hour(s) Distribution method: Random Then the time of the task's first run on each machine may be any time between 09:00:00 AM and 09:59:59 AM; the interval between the first and the second run is exactly two hoursfor instance: First machine: Every day at 09:30:03 AM and 11:30:03 AM Second machine: Every day at 09:00:00 AM and 11:00:00 AM Third machine: Every day at 09:59:59 AM and 11:59:59 AM
5.5
160
You can schedule a backup task to start when a certain Windows event has been recorded in one of the event logs such as the Application, Security, or System log. For example, you may want to set up a backup plan that will automatically perform an emergency full backup of your data as soon as Windows discovers that your hard disk drive is about to fail.
Parameters
Log name Specifies the name of the log. Select the name of a standard log (Application, Security, or System) from the list, or type a log namefor example: Microsoft Office Sessions Event source Specifies the event source, which typically indicates the program or the system component that caused the eventfor example: disk Event type Specifies the event type: Error, Warning, Information, Audit success, or Audit failure. Event ID Specifies the event number, which typically identifies the particular kind of events among events from the same source. For example, an Error event with Event source disk and Event ID 7 occurs when Windows discovers a bad block on a disk, whereas an Error event with Event source disk and Event ID 15 occurs when a disk is not ready for access yet.
Examples
"Bad block" emergency backup One or more bad blocks that have suddenly appeared on a hard disk usually indicate that the hard disk drive will soon fail. Suppose that you want to create a backup plan that will back up hard disk data as soon as such a situation occurs. When Windows detects a bad block on a hard disk, it records an event with the event source disk and the event number 7 into the System log; the type of this event is Error. When creating the plan, type or select the following in the Schedule area:
Log name: System Event source: disk Event type: Error Event ID: 7
Important: To ensure that such a task will complete despite the presen ce of bad blocks, you must make the task ignore bad blocks. To do this, in Backup options, go to Error handling, and then select the Ignore bad sectors check box.
Pre-update backup in Vista Suppose that you want to create a backup plan that will automatically perform a backup of the systemfor example, by backing up the volume where Windows is installedevery time that Windows is about to install updates. Having downloaded one or more updates and scheduled their installation, the Microsoft Windows Vista operating system records an event with the event source Microsoft-WindowsCopyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 161
WindowsUpdateClient and event number 18 into the System log; the type of this event is Information. When creating the plan, type or select the following in the Schedule area:
Log name: System Event source: Microsoft-Windows-WindowsUpdateClient Event type: Information Event ID: 18
Tip: To set up a similar backup plan for machines running Microsoft Windows XP, replace the text in Event source with Windows Update Agent and leave the remaining fields the same.
To view properties of an event, including the event source and event number
1. In Event Viewer, click the name of a log that you want to viewfor example, Application.
Note: To be able to open the security log (Security), you must be a member of th e Administrato rs group.
2. In the list of events in the right pane, double-click the name of an event whose properties you want to view. 3. In the Event Properties dialog box, view the event's properties such as the event source, shown in the Source field; and the event number, shown in the Event ID field. When you are finished, click OK to close the Event Properties dialog box.
5.6
Conditions
Conditions add more flexibility to the scheduler, enabling to execute backup tasks with respect to certain conditions. Once a specified event occurs (see the Scheduling section for the list of available events), the scheduler checks the specified condition and executes the task if the condition is met. The scheduler behavior in case the event occurs but the condition (or any of multiple conditions) is not met, is defined by the Task start conditions (p. 102) backup option. There, you can specify how important the conditions are for the backup strategy:
conditions are obligatory - put the backup task run on hold until all the conditions are met. conditions are preferable, but a backup task run has higher priority - put the task on hold for the specified time interval. If the time interval lapses and the conditions are still not met, run the task anyway. With this setting, the program will automatically handle the situation when the conditions are not met for too long and further delaying the backup is undesirable. backup task start time matters - skip the backup task if the conditions are not met at the time when the task should be started. Skipping the task run makes sense when you need to back up data strictly at the specified time, especially if the events are relatively often.
Example: It is required to run the backup task after free space on the managed machine is changed by at least 1 GB, but only if all users are logged off and more than 12 hours have passed since the last backup. Set the schedule, conditions and the Task start conditions backup option as follows:
Schedule: When free space changed; Value: Run task if free space has changed by at least: 1 GB. Condition: User logged off; Value: Run the task on schedule only if all users are logged off. Condition: Time since last backup; Value: Time since the last backup: 12 hour(s). Task start conditions: Wait until the conditions are met.
If the free space changes by more than 1 GB, the scheduler will wait until both conditions are met at the same time and then run the backup task.
5.6.1
User is idle
"User is idle" means that a screen saver is running on the managed machine or the machine is locked.
Example:
Run the backup task on the managed machine every day at 9PM, preferably when the user is idle. If the user is still active by 11PM, run the task anyway.
Event: Daily, every 1 day(s); Once at: 09:00:00 PM. Condition: User is idle. Task start conditions: Wait until the conditions are met, Run the task anyway after 2 hour(s).
As a result, (1) If the user becomes idle before 9PM, the backup task will start at 9PM. (2) If the user becomes idle between 9PM and 11PM, the backup task will start immediately after the user becomes idle. (3) If the user is still active at 11PM, the backup task starts anyway.
5.6.2
"Location's host is available" means that the machine hosting the destination for storing archives on a networked drive is available.
Example:
Backing up data to the networked location is performed on workdays at 9:00 PM. If the location's host is not available at that moment (for instance, due to maintenance work), skip the backup and wait for the next workday to start the task. It is assumed that the backup task should not be started at all rather than failed.
Event: Weekly, Every 1 week(s) on <workdays>; Once at 09:00:00 PM. Condition: Location's host is available Task start conditions: Skip the task execution.
163
As a result, (1) If 9:00 PM comes and the location's host is available, the backup task starts right on time. (2) If 9:00 PM comes but the host is unavailable at the moment, the backup task will start on the next workday if the location's host is available. (3) If the location's host will never be available on workdays at 9:00 PM, the task never starts.
5.6.3
Example
A company uses different locations on the same network-attached storage for backing up users data and servers. The workday starts at 8AM and ends at 5 PM. Users' data should be backed up as soon as the users log off, but not earlier than 4:30 PM and not later than 10 PM. Every day at 11 PM the company's servers are backed up. So, all the users' data should be preferably backed up before this time, in order to free network bandwidth. By specifying the upper limit as 10 PM, it is supposed that the backing up of users' data does not take more than one hour. If a user is still logged on within the specified time interval, or logs off at any other time do not back up the users' data, i.e. skip task execution.
Event: When logging off, The following user: Any user. Condition: Fits the time interval, from 04:30:00 PM until 10:00:00 PM. Task start conditions: Skip the task execution.
As a result, (1) if the user logs off between 04:30:00 PM and 10:00:00 PM, the backup task will start immediately following the logging off. (2) if the user logs off at any other time, the task will be skipped.
What if...
What if a task is scheduled to be executed at a certain time and this time is outside the specified time interval? For example:
Event: Daily, Every 1 day(s); Once at 03:00:00 PM. Condition: Fits time interval, from 06:00:00 PM until 11:59:59 PM. If the task start conditions are Skip the task execution, the task will never run. If the task start conditions are Wait until the conditions are met and the Run the task anyway after check box is cleared, the task (scheduled to run at 3:00 PM) will start at 6:00 PMthe time when the condition is met. If the task start conditions are Wait until the conditions are met and the Run the task anyway after check box is selected with, say, the 1 Hour waiting time, the task (scheduled to run at 3:00 PM) will start at 4:00 PMthe time when the waiting period ends.
In this case, whether and when the task will run depends on the task start conditions:
164
5.6.4
Enables to put a backup task run on hold until all users log off from Windows on the managed machine.
Example
Run the backup task at 8 PM on the first and third Friday of every month, preferably when all users are logged off. If one of the users is still logged on at 11 PM, run the task anyway.
Event: Monthly, Months: <All>; On: <First>, <Third> <Friday>; Once at 08:00:00 PM. Condition: User logged off. Task start conditions: Wait until the conditions are met, Run the task anyway after 3 hour(s).
As a result, (1) If all users are logged off at 8PM, the backup task will start at 8PM. (2) If the last user logs off between 8PM and 11PM, the backup task will start immediately after the user has logged off. (3) If any of the users is still logged on at 11PM, the backup task starts anyway.
5.6.5
Enables to put a backup task run on hold until the specified time interval since the last successful backup completion passes.
Example:
Run the backup task after free space on the managed machine has changed by at least 1 GB, but only if more than 12 hours have passed since the last successful backup.
Event: When free space changed, Run task if free space has changed by at least: 1 GB. Condition: Time since last backup, Time since the last backup: 12 hour(s). Task start conditions: Wait until the conditions are met.
As a result, (1) if the free space changes by more than 1GB before 12 hours pass since the successful completion of the last backup, the scheduler will wait until 12 hours pass, and then will start the task. (2) if the free space changes by more than 1GB after 12 hours pass since the last backup successful completion, the backup task will start immediately. (3) if the free space never changes by more than 1GB, the task will never start. You can start the backup manually, if need be, in the Backup plans and tasks view.
165
6 Direct management
This section covers operations that can be performed directly on a managed machine by using the direct console-agent connection. The content of this section is applicable to both stand-alone and advanced editions of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10.
6.1
This section describes the views that are available through the navigation tree of the console connected to a managed machine, and explains how to work with each view.
6.1.1
Dashboard
Use the Dashboard to estimate at a glance whether the data is successfully protected on the machine. The dashboard shows the summary of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent's activities and enables you to rapidly identify and resolve any issues.
Alerts
The alerts section draws your attention to issues that have occurred on the machine and offers you ways of fixing or examining them. The most critical issues are displayed on the top. If there are no alerts or warnings at the moment, the system displays "No alerts or warnings".
Types of alerts
The table below illustrates the types of messages you may observe.
Description Failed tasks: X Tasks that need interaction: X Offer Resolve Resolve Comment Resolve will open the Backup plans and Tasks view with failed tasks, where you can examine the reason of failure. Each time a task needs human interaction, the Dashboard shows a message to inform you what action has to be performed (for example, insert new CD or Stop/Retry/Ignore on an error). Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent connects to Acronis License Server at the start and then every 15 days (the default is 1 day), as specified by the agent configuration parameters. If the license check does not succeed for 160 days, as specified by the agent configuration parameters (the default is 30 days), the agent will stop working until there has been a successful last license check. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 is stopped. For the past X days, the agent was unable to check whether its license is available on Acronis License Server. This is probably due to the license server being unavailable. You may also want to ensure that the licenses are present on the license server, or that the license key data was not corrupted. After a successful license check the agent will start
166
Failed to check the license for Connect the current edition. X day(s) remaining until the software stops working. Please make sure you have a valid license on Acronis License Server. Cannot check the license key Connect for the current edition for X days. Either Acronis License Server was unavailable, or the license key data was corrupted. Check connectivity to the server and run Acronis License Server to manage licenses.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
Please make sure you have a valid license on Acronis License Server. Trial version of product expires in X day(s) Please make sure you have a valid license on Acronis License Server. Trial period is over. Start the installer and enter a full license key. Please make sure you have a valid license on Acronis License Server. Vaults with low free space: X View vaults Connect Connect
working.
Once the trial version of the product is installed, the program starts the countdown of days remaining until the trial period expires.
View vaults will take you to the V aults view where you can examine the vault size, free space, content and take the necessary steps to increase the free space. To be able to recover an operating system when the machine fails to boot, you must: 1. Back up the system volume (and the boot volume, if it is different) 2. Create at least one bootable media (p. 349). Create now will launch the Bootable Media Builder (p. 356).
Create now
Back up now The Dashboard warns you that no data was backed up on the machine for a relatively long period of time. Back up now will take you to Create a Backup Plan page where you can instantly configure and run the backup operation. To configure the time interval that is considered as critical, select Options > Console options > Time-based alerts.
Not connec ted to View the management server for X days machines
This type of message can appear on a machine that is registered on a management server. The Dashboard warns you that the connection might be lost or the server might be unavailable and the machine is not centrally managed as a result.
Activities
The calendar lets you explore the history of the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent's activities on the machine. Right-click on any highlighted date and select View log to see the list of log entries filtered by date. On the View section (at the right of the calendar), you can select the activities to highlight depending on the presence and severity of the errors.
How it is determined Errors Highlight the date in red if at least one "Error" entry appeared in the log on this date.
167
Warnings Information
Highlight the date in yellow if no "Error" entries appeared and at least one "Warning" entry appeared in the log on this date. Highlight the date in green if only "Information" log entries appeared on this date (normal activity.)
The Select current date link focuses selection to the current date.
System view
Shows summarized statistics of backup plans, tasks, and brief information on the last backup. Click the items in this section to obtain the relevant information. This will take you to the Backup plans and tasks (p. 168) view with pre-filtered plans or tasks. For instance, if you click Local under Backup plans, the Backup plans and tasks view will be opened with backup plans filtered by the Local origin.
6.1.2
The Backup plans and tasks view keeps you informed of data protection on a given machine. It lets you monitor and manage backup plans and tasks. A backup plan is a set of rules that specify how the given data will be protected on a given machine. Physically, a backup plan is a bundle of tasks configured for execution on a managed machine. To find out what a backup plan is currently doing on the machine, check the backup plan execution state (p. 169). A backup plan state is a cumulative state of the plan's tasks.The status of a backup plan (p. 169) helps you to estimate whether the data is successfully protected. A task is a set of sequential actions to be performed on a machine when a certain time comes or certain event occurs. To keep track of a task's current progress, examine its state (p. 170). Check a task status (p. 171) to ascertain the result of a task.
Way of working
Use filters to display the desired backup plans (tasks) in the backup plans table. By default, the table displays all the plans of the managed machine sorted by name. You can also hide the unneeded columns and show the hidden ones. See the Filtering and sorting backup plans and tasks (p. 175) section for details. In the backup table, select the backup plan (task). Use the toolbar's buttons to take an action on the selected plan (task). See the Actions on backup plans and tasks (p. 172) section for details. You can run, edit, stop and delete the created plans and tasks.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
168
Use the Information panel to review detailed information on the selected plan (task). The panel is collapsed by default. To expand the panel, click the chevron. The content of the panel is also duplicated in the Plan details (p. 178) and Task details (p. 176) windows respectively.
Running
Waiting
Waiting for condition. This situation is quite normal, but delaying a backup for too long is risky. The solution may be to set the maximum delay or force the condition (tell the user to log off, enable the required network connection.) Waiting while another task locks the necessary resources. A one-time waiting case may occur when a task start is delayed or a task run lasts much longer than usual for some particular reason and this way prevents another task from starting. This situation is resolved automatically when the obstructing task comes to an end. Consider stopping a task if it hangs for too long to enable the nex t task to start. Persistent task overlapping may result from an incorrectly scheduled plan or plans. It makes sense to edit the plan in this case.
Stopping
No action is required.
Idle
No action is required.
Otherwise, see 2
following:
Task states
A task can be in one of the following states: Idle; Waiting; Running; Stopping; Need interaction. The initial task state is Idle. Once the task is started manually or the event specified by the schedule occurs, the task enters either the Running state or the Waiting state. Running A task changes to the Running state when the event specified by the schedule occurs AND all the conditions set in the backup plan are met AND no other task that locks the necessary resources is running. In this case, nothing prevents the task from running. Waiting A task changes to the Waiting state when the task is about to start, but another task using the same resources is already running. In particular, more than one backup or recovery task cannot run simultaneously on a machine. A backup task and a recovery task also cannot run simultaneously. Once the other task unlocks the resource, the waiting task enters the Running state. A task may also change to the Waiting state when the event specified by the schedule occurs but the condition set in the backup plan is not met. See Task start conditions (p. 102) for details. Need interaction Any running task can put itself into the Need interaction state when it needs human interaction such as changing media or ignoring a read error. The next state may be Stopping (if the user chooses to stop the task) or Running (on selecting Ignore/Retry or another action, such as Reboot, that can put the task to the Running state.) Stopping
170
The user can stop a running task or a task that needs interaction. The task changes to the Stopping state and then to the Idle state. A waiting task can also be stopped. In this case, since the task is not running, "stop" means removing it from the queue .
Task statuses
A task can have one of the following statuses: Error; Warning; OK. A task status is derived from the result of the last run of the task.
Status 1 Error How it is determined Last result is "Failed" How to handle Identify the failed task -> Check the task log to find out the reason of the failure, then do one or more of the following:
Edit the failed task to prevent its future failure Edit the local plan to prevent its future failure in case a
local plan has failed
171
Working with backup plans and tasks Actions on backup plans and tasks
The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with backup plans and tasks.
To Create a new backup plan, or a task Do Click New, then select one of the following:
Backup plan (p. 181) Recovery task (p. 199) Validation task (p. 217)
Backup plan Click View details. In the Plan Details (p. 178) window, review the plan details. Task View details. Click In the Task Details (p. 176) window, review the task details.
You will be taken to the Log (p. 179) view containing the list of the plan-related log entries. Task Click View log.
You will be taken to the Log (p. 179) view containing the list of the task-related log entries. Run a plan/task Backup plan Click Run.
In the Run Backup Plan (p. 176) window, select the task you need to be run. Running the backup plan starts the selected task of that plan immediately in spite of its schedule and conditions. Why can't I run the backup plan?
The task will be executed immediately in spite of its schedule and conditions.
172
Stop a plan/task
Stopping the running backup plan stops all its tasks. Thus, all the task operations will be aborted. Task Click Stop.
What will happen if I stop the task? Generally, stopping the task aborts its operation (backup, recovery, validation, exporting, conversion, migration). The task enters the Stopping state first, then becomes Idle. The task schedule, if created, remains valid. To complete the operation you will have to run the task over again.
recovery task (from the disk backup): The target volume will be deleted and
its space unallocated you will get the same r esult if the recovery is unsuccessful. To recover the "lost" volume, you will have to run the task once again.
recovery task (from the file backup): The aborted operation may cause
changes in the destination folder. Some files may be recovered, but some not, depending on the moment when you stopped the task. To recover all the files, you will have to run the task once again.
173
Edit a plan/task
Backup plan editing is performed in the same way as creation (p. 181), except for the following limitations: It is not always possible to use all scheme options, when editing a backup plan if the created archive is not empty (i.e. contains backups). 1. It is not possible to change the scheme to Grandfather-Father-Son or Tower of Hanoi. 2. If the Tower of Hanoi scheme is used, it is not possible to change the number of levels. In all other cases the scheme can be changed, and should continue to operate as if existing archives were created by a new scheme. For empty archives all changes are possible. Why can't I edit the ba ckup plan?
174
Delete a plan/task
What will happen if I delete the ba ckup plan? The plan's deletion deletes all its tasks. Why can't I delete the backup plan?
The management console will update the list of backup plans and tasks existing on the machine with the most recent information. Though the list is refreshed automatically based on events, the data may not be retrieved immediately from the managed machine, due to some latency. Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed.
175
Task details
The Task details window (also duplicated on the Information panel) aggregates all information on the selected task. When a task requires user interaction, a message and action buttons appear above the tabs. The message contains a brief description of the problem. The buttons allow you to retry or stop the task or the backup plan. Types of tasks The following table summarizes all types of tasks that exist in Acronis Backup & Recovery 10. The actual types of tasks you might observe depend on the product edition and the product component the console is connected to.
Task name Backup (disk) Backup (file) Backup (virtual machine) Recovery (disk) Description Backing up disks and volumes Backing up files and folders Backing up an entire virtual machine or its volumes Disk backup recovery
176
Recovery (file) Recovery (volume) Recovery (MBR) Recovery (disk to existing VM) Recovery (disk to new VM) Recovery (existing VM) Recovery (new VM) Validation (archive) Validation (backup) Validation (vault) Cleanup ASZ creation ASZ management Disk management Compacting Indexing
File and folder recovery Recovery of volumes from a disk backup Master boot record recovery Recovery of a disk/volume backup to an existing virtual machine Recovery of a disk/volume backup to a new virtual machine Recovery of a virtual machine backup to an existing virtual machine Recovery of a virtual machine backup to a new virtual machine Validation of a single archive Validation of backups Validation of all archives stored in a vault Deleting backups from a backup archive in accordance with retention rules Creating Acronis Secure Zone Resizing, changing password, deleting Acronis Secure Zone Disk management operations Service task performed on a storage node Deduplication task performed by the storage node in the vault after a backup is completed
Depending on the type of task and whether it is running or not, a combination of the following tabs will appear:
Task
The Task tab is common for all types of tasks. It provides general information on the selected task.
Archive
The Archive tab is available for backup, archive validation and cleanup tasks. Provides information on the archive: its name, type, size, where it is stored, etc.
Backup
The Backup tab is available for recovery, backup validation, and export tasks. Provides details on the selected backup: when it was created, its type (full, incremental, differential), information on the archive and the vault the backup is stored in.
Settings
The Settings tab displays information on scheduling and the options changed against the default values.
Progress
The Progress tab is available while the task is running. It is common for all types of tasks. The tab provides information about task progress, elapsed time and other parameters.
177
Backup plan
The Backup plan tab provides the following general information on the selected plan:
Name - name of the backup plan Origin - whether the plan was created on the managed machine using direct management (local origin), or appeared on the machine as a result of deploying a backup policy from the management server (centralized origin). Policy (for backup plans with centralized origin) - name of the backup policy, whose deployment created the backup plan. Account - the name of the account under which the plan runs Owner - the name of the user who created or last modified the plan State - execution state (p. 169) of the backup plan. Status - status (p. 169) of the backup plan. Schedule - whether the task is scheduled, or set to start manually. Last backup - how much time has passed since the last backup. Creation - backup plan creation date. Comments - description of the plan (if provided).
Source
The Source tab provides the following information on the data selected for backup:
Source type - the type of data (p. 184) selected for backing up. Items to back up - items selected to back up and their size.
Destination
The Destination tab provides the following information:
Location - name of the vault or path to the folder, where the archive is stored. Archive name - name of the archive. Archive comments - comments on the archive (if provided).
Settings
The Settings tab displays the following information:
Backup scheme - the selected backup scheme and all its settings with schedules. Validation (if selected) - events before or after which the validation is performed, and validation schedule. Backup options - backup options changed against the default values.
178
6.1.3
Log
The Log stores the history of operations performed by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 on the machine, or actions a user takes on the machine using the program. For instance, when a user edits a task, the respective entry is added to the log. When the program executes a task, it adds multiple entries. With the log, you can examine operations, results of tasks' execution including reasons for failure, if any.
non-contiguous: hold down CTRL and click the log entries one by one contiguous: select a single log entry, then hold down SHIFT and click another
entry. All the entries between the first and last selections will be selected too.
View a log entrys details 1. Select a log entry. 2. Do one of the following
Click
window.
179
1. Select a single log entry or multiple log entries. 2. Click Save Sele cted to File.
3. In the opened window, specify a path and a name for the file. Save all the log entries to a file 1. Make sure, that the filters are not set. 2. Click Save All to File.
3. In the opened window, specify a path and a name for the file. Save all the filtered log entries to a file 1. Set filters to get a list of the log entries that satisfy the filtering criteria. 2. Click Save All to File.
3. In the opened window, specify a path and a name for the file. As a result, the log entries of that list will be saved. Delete all the log entries Click Clear Log.
All the log entries will be deleted from the log, and a new log entry will be created. It will contain information about who deleted the entries and when.
Filter log entries by type Press or release the following toolbar buttons: to filter error messages to filter warning messages to filter information messages Filter log entries by the original backup plan or managed entity type Under the Backup plan (or Managed entity type) column header, select the backup plan or the type of managed entity from the list.
Filter log entries by task, Type the r equired value (task name, machine name, owner name, etc.) in the field below managed entity, the respective column header. machine, code, owner As a result you will see that the list of log entries fully or just partly coincide with the entered value. Sort log entries by date and time Click the column's header to sort the log entries in ascending order. Click it once again to sort the log entries in descending order.
180
Type - type of event (Error; Warning; Information) Date - date and time of the event occurrence Backup plan - the backup plan the event relates to (if any) Task - the task the event relates to (if any) Code - the program code of the event. Every type of event in the program has its own code. A code is an integer number that may be used by Acronis support service to solve the problem. Module - number of the program module where the event has occurred. It is an integer number that may be used by Acronis support service to solve the problem. Owner - user name of the backup plan owner (only under operating system) Message - a text description of the event.
---------------------------Log Entry Details--------------------------Type: Information Date and time: DD.MM.YYYY HH:MM:SS Backup plan: Backup plan name Task: Task name Message: Description of the operation Code: 12(3x45678A) Module: Module name Owner: Owner of the plan -----------------------------------------------------------------------
The log entry's details that you copy will have the appearance as follows:
6.2
Before creating your first backup plan (p. 348), please familiarize yourself with the basic concepts (p. 24) used in Acronis Backup & Recovery 10.
General
Plan name [Optional] Enter a unique name for the backup plan. A conscious name lets you identify the plan among others. Plan's credentials (p. 183) [Optional] The backup plan will run on behalf of the user who is creating the plan. You can change the plan account credentials if necessary. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box . Comments
181
[Optional] Type a description of the backup plan. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
What to backup
Source type (p. 184) Select the type of data to back up. The type of data depends on the agents installed on the machine. Items to backup (p. 184) Specify the data items to back up. A list of items to backup depends on the data type, specified previously. Access credentials (p. 186) [Optional] Provide credentials for the source data if the plan's account does not have access permissions to the data. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box . Exclusions (p. 186) [Optional] Set up exclusions for the specific types of files you do not wish to back up. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
Where to back up
Archive (p. 187) Specify path to the location, where the backup archive will be stored, and the archive name. It is advisable that the archive name be unique within the location. The default archive name is Archive(N) where N is the sequence number of the archive in the location you have selected. Access credentials (p. 188) [Optional] Provide credentials for the location if the plan account does not have access permissions to the location. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box. Archive comments [Optional] Enter comments on the archive. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
How to back up
Backup scheme (p. 189) Specify when and how often to back up your data; define for how long to keep the created backup archives in the selected location; set up schedule for the archive cleanup procedure. Use well-known optimized backup schemes, such as Grandfather-Father-Son and Tower of Hanoi; create a custom backup scheme, or back up data once.
Archive validation
When to validate (p. 198) [Optional] Define when and how often to perform validation and whether to validate the entire archive or the latest backup in the archive.
Backup options
Settings [Optional] Configure parameters of the backup operation, such as pre/post backup commands, maximum network bandwidth allocated for the backup stream or the backup archive compression level. If you do nothing in this section, the default values (p. 85) will be used.
182
After any of the settings is changed against the default value, a new line that displays the newly set value appears. The setting status changes from Default to Custom. Should you modify the setting again, the line will display the new value unless the new value is the default one. When the default value is set, the line disappears and so you always see only the settings that differ from the default values in this section of the Create backup plan page. To reset all the settings to the default values, click Reset to default.
Convert to VM
Applies to: Disk/volume backup, backup of Entire virtual machines or Volumes of a virtual machine Not available on machines running Linux By setting up regular conversion, you obtain a copy of your server or workstation on a virtual machine which can be readily powered on in case the original machine fails. The conversion can be performed by the same agent that performs the backup or by an agent installed on another machine. If the latter is the case, you need to store the archive in a shared location, such as a network folder or a managed vault, so that the other machine can access the archive. When to convert (p. 198) [Optional] Specify whether to convert every full, every incremental or every differential backup or convert the last created backup on schedule. Specify the conversion schedule if required. Host (p. 198) Specify the machine that will perform the conversion. The machine has to have Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows, Agent for ESX/ESXi or Agent for Hyper-V installed. Virtualization server (p. 198) Here you select the resulting virtual machine type and location. Available options depend on the host you selected in the previous step. Storage (p. 198) Choose the storage on the virtualization server or the folder to place the virtual machine files in. Resultant VMs Specify the name of the virtual machine. After you have performed all the required steps, click OK to create the backup plan. After that, you might be prompted for the password (p. 183). The plan you have created will be accessible for examination and managing in the Backup plans and tasks (p. 168) view.
6.2.1
A scheduled or postponed task has to run regardless of users being logged on. In case you have not explicitly specified the credentials, under which the task(s) will run, the program proposes using your account. Enter your password, specify another account or change the scheduled start to manual.
6.2.2
Provide the credentials for the account under which the plan's tasks will run.
183
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Run under the current user The tasks will run under the credentials with which the user who starts the tasks is logged on. If any of the tasks has to run on schedule, you will be asked for the current user's password on completing the plan creation. Use the following credentials The tasks will always run under the credentials you specify, whether started manually or executed on schedule. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
Password. The password for the account. 2. Click OK. To learn more about operations available depending on the user privileges, see the Users' privileges on a managed machine (p. 30) section.
6.2.3
Source type
Select the type of data you want to be backed up on the managed machine. The list of available data types depends on the agents running on the machine: Files Available if the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows (or for Linux) is installed. Select this option to back up specific files and folders. If you are not concerned about recovery of the operating system along with all the settings and applications, but plan to keep safe only certain data (the current project, for example), choose file backup. This will reduce the archive size, thus saving storage space. Disks/volumes Available if the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows (or for Linux) is installed. Select this option to back up disks and/or volumes. To be able to back up disks or volumes, you must have Administrator or Backup operator privileges. Backing up disks and volumes enables you to recover the entire system in case of severe data damage or hardware failure. The backup procedure is faster than copying files, and may significantly speed up the backup process when it comes to backing up large volumes of data.
Note for Linux users: We reco mmend that you unmount any volumes that contain non-journaling file systems such as the ext2 file systembefo re backing them up. Otherwise, these volu mes might contain co rrupted files upon recovery; recovery of these volumes with resize might fail.
6.2.4
Items to back up
The items to backup depend on the source type (p. 184) selected previously.
184
2. [Optional] To create an exact copy of a disk or volume on a physical level, select the Back up sector-by-sector check box. The resulting backup will be equal in size to the disk being backed up (if the Compression level option is set to None). Use the sector-by-sector backup for backing up drives with unrecognized or unsupported file systems and other proprietary data formats. 3. Click OK.
Use the table in the right part of the window to browse and select the nested items. Selecting the check box beside the Name columns header automatically selects all items in the table. Clearing this check box automatically deselects all items. 3. Click OK.
185
6.2.5
Specify the credentials required for access to the data you are going to backup.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Use the plan's credentials The program will access the source data using the credentials of the backup plan account specified in the General section. Use the following credentials The program will access the source data using the credentials you specify. Use this option if the plan's account does not have access permissions to the data. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
6.2.6
Exclusions
Set up exclusions for the specific types of files you do not wish to back up. For example, you may not want database, hidden and system files and folders, as well as files with specific extensions, to be stored in the archive.
Exclude all hidden files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the Hidden attribute. If a folder is Hidden, all of its contents including files that are not Hidden will be excluded. Exclude all system files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the System attribute. If a folder is System, all of its contents including files that are not System will be excluded.
You can view file or folder a ttributes in the file/folder properties or by using th e attrib command. For more information, refer to the Help and Support Cen ter in Windows.
Exclude files matching the following criteria Select this check box to skip files whose names match any of the criteria called file masks in the list; use the Add, Edit, Remove and Remove All buttons to create the list of file masks. You can use one or more wildcard characters * and ? in a file mask: The asterisk (*) substitutes for zero or more characters in a file name; for example, the file mask Doc*.txt yields files such as Doc.txt and Document.txt The question mark (?) substitutes for exactly one character in a file name; for example, the file mask Doc?.txt yields files such as Doc1.txt and Docs.txt but not the files Doc.txt or Doc11.txt
Exclusion examples
Criterion Example Description
186
Excludes all files named File1.log. Excludes the file named test.log located in the folder C:\Finance Excludes all files with the .log extension. Excludes all .log files with names consisting of five symbols and starting with my.
6.2.7
Archive
Specify where the archive will be stored and the name of the archive.
To back up data to a centralized vault, expand the Centralized group and click the vault. To back up data to a personal vault, expand the Personal group and click the vault. To back up data to a local folder on the machine, expand the Local folders group and click the required folder. To back up data to a network share, expand the Network folders group, select the required networked machine and, then click the shared folder. If the network share requires access credentials, the program will ask for them.
Note for Linux users: To specify a Common Internet File System (CIFS) network share which is mounted on a mount point such as / mnt/share, select this mount point instead of the network share itself.
To back up data to an FTP or SFTP server, type the server name or address in the Path field as follows: ftp://ftp_server:port _number or sftp://sftp_server:port number If the port number is not specified, port 21 is used for FTP and port 22 is used for SFTP. After entering access credentials, the folders on the server become available. Click the appropriate folder on the server. You can access the server as an anonymous user if the server enables such access. To do so, click Use anonymous access instead of entering credentials.
According to the original FTP specifica tion, cred entials required for a ccess to FTP servers are transferred through a netwo rk as plaintext. This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer.
To back up data to a locally attached tape device, expand the Tape drives group, then click the required device. To assist you with choosing the right destination, the table displays the names of the archives contained in each location you select. While you are reviewing the location content, archives can be added, deleted or modified by another user or by the program itself according to scheduled operations. Use the Refresh button to refresh the list of archives.
unique within the selected location. If you are satisfied with the automatically generated name, click OK. Otherwise enter another unique name and click OK.
Why two or more plans should not back up to the same archive
1. Backing up different sources to the same archive makes using the archive difficult from the usability standpoint. When it comes to recovery, every second counts, but you might be lost in the archive content. Backup plans that operate with the same archive should back up the same data items (say, both plans back up volume C.) 2. Applying multiple retention rules to an archive makes the archive content in some way unpredictable. Since each of the rules will be applied to the entire archive, the backups belonging to one backup plan can be easily deleted along with the backups belonging to the other. You should especially not expect the classic behavior of the GFS and Tower of Hanoi backup schemes. Normally, each complex backup plan should back up to its own archive.
6.2.8
Specify credentials required for access to the location where the backup archive will be stored. The user whose name is specified will be considered as the archive owner.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Use the plan's credentials The program will access the source data using the credentials of the backup plan account specified in the General section. Use the following credentials The program will access the source data using the credentials you specify. Use this option if the plan account does not have access permissions to the location. You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node vault. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
188
6.2.9
Backup schemes
Choose one of the available backup schemes: Back up now to create a backup task for manual start and run the task immediately after its creation. Back up later to create a backup task for manual start OR schedule one-time task execution in the future. Simple to schedule when and how often to backup data and specify retention rules. Grandfather-Father-Son to use the Grandfather-Father-Son backup scheme. The scheme does not allow data to be backed up more than once a day. You set the days of week when the daily backup will be performed and select from these days the day of weekly/monthly backup. Then you set the retention periods for the daily (referred to as "sons"), weekly (referred to as "fathers") and monthly (referred to as "grandfathers") backups. The expired backups will be deleted automatically. Tower of Hanoi to use the Tower of Hanoi backup scheme, where you schedule when and how often to back up (sessions) and select the number of backup levels (up to 16). In this scheme, the data can be backed up more than once a day. By setting up the backup schedule and selecting backup levels, you automatically obtain the rollback period the guaranteed number of sessions that you can go back at any time. The automatic cleanup mechanism maintains the required rollback period by deleting the expired backups and keeping the most recent backups of each level. Custom to create a custom scheme, where you are free to set up a backup strategy in the way your enterprise needs it most: specify multiple schedules for different backup types, add conditions and specify the retention rules.
Simple scheme
With the simple backup scheme you just schedule when and how often to back up data and set the retention rule. At the first time a full backup will be created. The next backups will be incremental.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 189
To set up the simple backup scheme, specify the appropriate settings as follows.
Backup Set up the backup schedule - when and how often to back up the data. To learn more about setting up the schedule, see the Scheduling (p. 152) section. Retention rule With the simple scheme, only one retention rule (p. 37) is available. Set the retention period for the backups.
Grandfather-Father-Son scheme
At a glance
Daily incremental, weekly differential, and monthly full backups Custom day for weekly and monthly backups Custom retention periods for backups of each type
Description
Let us suppose that we want to set up a backup plan that will regularly produce a series of daily (D), weekly (W), and monthly (M) backups. Here is a natural way to do this: the following table shows a sample two-month period for such a plan.
Mo Jan 1Jan 7 Jan 8Jan 14 Jan 15Jan 21 Jan 22Jan 28 Jan 29Feb 4 Feb 5Feb 11 Feb 12Feb 18 Feb 19Feb 25 Feb 26Mar 4 D D D D D D D D D Tu D D D D D D D D D We D D D D D D D D D Th D D D D D D D D D Fr W W W M W W W M W Sa Su -
Daily backups run every workday except Friday, which is left for weekly and monthly backups. Monthly backups run every fourth Friday, and weekly backups run on all other Fridays.
Monthly ("Grandfather") backups are full; Weekly ("Father") backups are differential; Daily ("Son") backups are incremental.
Parameters
You can set up the following parameters of a Grandfather-Father-Son (GFS) scheme.
Start backup at: Back up on: Weekly/Monthly: Specifies when to start a backup. The default value is 12:00 PM. Specifies the days on which to perform a backup. The default value is Workdays. Specifies which of the days selected in the Back up on field you want to reserve for weekly and monthly backups. A monthly backup will be performed every fourth such day. The default value is Friday.
190
Keep backups:
Specifies how long you want the backups to be stored in the archive. A term can be set in hours, days, weeks, months, or years. For monthly backups, you can also select Keep indefinitely if you want them to be saved forever. The default values for each backup type are as follows. Daily: 7 days (recommended minimum) Weekly: 4 weeks Monthly: indefinitely The retention period for weekly backups must exceed that for daily backups; the monthly backups' retention period must be gr eater than the weekly backups' retention period. We recommend setting a retention period of at least one week for daily backups.
At all times, a backup is no t deleted until all ba ckups that directly dep end on it beco me subject to deletion as well. This is why you might see a weekly o r a monthly ba ckup remain in the a rchive for a few days past its expected expira tion date. If the schedule starts with a daily or a weekly ba ckup, a full backup is created instead.
Examples
Each day of the past week, each week of the past month
Let us consider a GFS backup scheme that many may find useful.
Back up files every day, including weekends Be able to recover files as of any date over the past seven days Have access to weekly backups of the past month Keep monthly backups indefinitely. Start backup at: 11:00 PM Back up on: All days Weekly/monthly: Saturday (for example) Keep backups:
As a result, an archive of daily, weekly, and monthly backups will be created. Daily backups will be available for seven days since creation. For instance, a daily backup of Sunday, January 1, will be available through next Sunday, January 8; the first weekly backup, the one of Saturday, January 7, will be stored on the system until February 7. Monthly backups will never be deleted.
Limited storage
If you do not want to arrange a vast amount of space to store a huge archive, you may set up a GFS scheme so as to make your backups more short-lived, at the same time ensuring that your information can be recovered in case of an accidental data loss. Suppose that you need to:
Be able to recover an accidentally deleted or inadvertently modified file if this has been discovered relatively quickly Have access to a weekly backup for 10 days after it was created Keep monthly backups for half a year. Start backup at: 6:00 PM Back up on: Workdays Weekly/monthly: Friday Keep backups:
With this scheme, you will have a week to recover a previous version of a damaged file from a daily backup; as well as 10-day access to weekly backups. Each monthly full backup will be available for six months since the creation date.
Work schedule
Suppose you are a part-time financial consultant and work in a company on Tuesdays and Thursdays. On these days, you often make changes to your financial documents, statements, and update the spreadsheets etc. on your laptop. To back up this data, you may want to:
Track changes to the financial statements, spreadsheets, etc. performed on Tuesdays and Thursdays (daily incremental backup). Have a weekly summary of file changes since last month (Friday weekly differential backup). Have a monthly full backup of your files.
Moreover, assume that you want to retain access to all backups, including the daily ones, for at least six months. The following GFS scheme suits such purposes:
Start backup at: 11:30 PM Back up on: Tuesday, Thursday, Friday Weekly/monthly: Friday Keep backups: Daily: 6 months
Here, daily incremental backups will be created on Tuesdays and Thursdays, with weekly and monthly backups performed on Fridays. Note that, in order to choose Friday in the Weekly/monthly field, you need to first select it in the Back up on field. Such an archive would allow you to compare your financial documents as of the first and the last day of work, and have a five-year history of all documents, etc.
No daily backups
Consider a more exotic GFS scheme:
192
Start backup at: 12:00 PM Back up on: Friday Weekly/monthly: Friday Keep backups:
Backup is thus performed only on Fridays. This makes Friday the only choice for weekly and monthly backups, leaving no other date for daily backups. The resulting Grandfather-Father archive will hence consist only of weekly differential and monthly full backups. Even though it is possible to use GFS to create such an archive, the Custom scheme is more flexible in this situation.
Parameters
You can set up the following parameters of a Tower of Hanoi scheme.
Schedule Set up a daily (p. 153), weekly (p. 155), or monthly (p. 157) schedule. Setting up schedule parameters allows creating simple schedules (example of a simple daily schedule: a backup task will be run every 1 day at 10 AM) as well as more complex schedules (example of a complex daily schedule: a task will be run every 3 days, starting from January 15. During the specified days the task will be repeated every 2 hours from 10 AM to 10 PM). Thus, complex schedules specify the sessions on which the scheme should run. In the discussion below, "days" can be replaced with "scheduled sessions". Select from 2 to 16 backup levels. See the example stated below for details. The guaranteed number of sessions that one can go back in the archive at any time. Calculated automatically, depending on the schedule parameters and the numbers of levels you select. See the example below for details.
Example
Schedule parameters are set as follows
Number of levels: 4 This is how the first 14 days (or 14 sessions) of this scheme's schedule look. Shaded numbers denote backup levels.
1 4 2 1 3 2 4 1 5 3 6 1 7 2 8 1 9 4 10 1 11 2 12 1 13 3 14 1
193
Last-level (in this case, level 4) backups are full; Backups of intermediate levels (2, 3) are differential; First-level (1) backups are incremental.
A cleanup mechanism ensures that only the most recent backups of each level are kept. Here is how the archive looks on day 8, a day before creating a new full backup.
1 4 2 1 3 2 4 1 5 3 6 1 7 2 8 1
The scheme allows for efficient data storage: more backups accumulate toward the current time. Having four backups, we could recover data as of today, yesterday, half a week, or a week ago.
Roll-back period
The number of days we can go back in the archive is different on different days. The minimum number of days we are guaranteed to have is called the roll-back period. The following table shows full backup and roll-back periods for schemes of various levels.
Number of levels Full backup every On different days, can go back 1 to 2 days 2 to 5 days 4 to 11 days 8 to 23 days 16 to 47 days Roll-back period
2 3 4 5 6
Adding a level doubles the full backup and roll-back periods. To see why the number of recovery days varies, let us return to the previous example. Here are the backups we have on day 12 (numbers in gray denote deleted backups).
1 4 2 1 3 2 4 1 5 3 6 1 7 2 8 1 9 4 10 1 11 2 12 1
A new level 3 differential backup has not yet been created, so the backup of day five is still stored. Since it depends on the full backup of day one, that backup is available as well. This enables us to go as far back as 11 days, which is the best-case scenario. The following day, however, a new third-level differential backup is created, and the old full backup is deleted.
1 4 2 1 3 2 4 1 5 3 6 1 7 2 8 1 9 4 10 1 11 2 12 1 13 3
This gives us only a four day recovery interval, which turns out to be the worst-case scenario. On day 14, the interval is five days. It increases on subsequent days before decreasing again, and so on.
194 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
1 4
2 1
3 2
4 1
5 3
6 1
7 2
8 1
9 4
10 1
11 2
12 1
13 3
14 1
The roll-back period shows how many days we are guaranteed to have even in the worst case. For a four-level scheme, it is four days.
Parameters
Parameter Full backup
If there is only one full backup left and a full backup is in progress, then
delete the last full backup with all dependent incremental/differential backups
If there is only one full backup left, and an incremental or differential backup
is in progress, an error occurs saying there is a lack of available space This setting is recommended when backing up to a USB drive or Acronis Secure Zone. This setting is not applicable to managed vaults.
195
This setting enables deletion of the last backup in the archive, in case your storage device cannot accommodate more than one backup. However, you might end up with no backups if the program is not able to create the new backup for some reason.
Specifies when to apply the retention rules (p. 37). For example, the cleanup procedure can be set up to run after each backup, and also on schedule. This option is available only if you have set at least one retention rule in Retention rules.
Specifies a schedule for archive cleanup. For example, the cleanup can be scheduled to start on the last day of each month. This option is available only if you selected On schedule in Apply the rules.
Examples
Weekly full backup
The following scheme yields a full backup performed every Friday night. Full backup: Schedule: Weekly, every Friday, at 10:00 PM Here, all parameters except Schedule in Full backup are left empty. All backups in the archive are kept indefinitely (no archive cleanup is performed).
Monthly full, weekly differential, and daily incremental backups plus cleanup
This example demonstrates the use of all options available in the Custom scheme.
196
Suppose that we need a scheme that will produce monthly full backups, weekly differential backups, and daily incremental backups. Then the backup schedule can look as follows. Full backup: Schedule: Monthly, every Last Sunday of the month, at 9:00 PM Incremental: Schedule: Weekly, every workday, at 7:00 PM Differential: Schedule: Weekly, every Saturday, at 8:00 PM Further, we want to add conditions that have to be satisfied for a backup task to start. This is set up in the Conditions fields for each backup type. Full backup: Conditions: Location available Incremental: Conditions: User is logged off Differential: Conditions: User is idle As a result, a full backuporiginally scheduled at 9:00 PMmay actually start later: as soon as the backup location becomes available. Likewise, backup tasks for incremental and differential backups will wait until all users are logged off and users are idle, respectively. Finally, we create retention rules for the archive: let us retain only backups that are no older than six months, and let the cleanup be performed after each backup task and also on the last day of every month. Retention rules: Delete backups older than 6 months Apply the rules: After backing up, On schedule Cleanup schedule: Monthly, on the Last day of All months, at 10:00 PM By default, a backup is not deleted as long as it has dependent backups that must be kept. For example, if a full backup has become subject to deletion, but there are incremental or differential backups that depend on it, the deletion is postponed until all the dependent backups can be deleted as well. For more information, see Retention rules (p. 37).
Resulting tasks
Any custom scheme always produces three backup tasks andin case the retention rules are specifieda cleanup task. Each task is listed in the list of tasks either as Scheduled (if the schedule has been set up) or as Manual (if the schedule has not been set up). You can manually run any backup task or cleanup task at any time, regardless of whether it has a schedule. In the first of the previous examples, we set up a schedule only for full backups. However, the scheme will still result in three backup tasks, enabling you to manually start a backup of any type:
Full backup, runs every Friday at 10:00 PM Incremental backup, runs manually Differential backup, runs manually
You can run any of these backup tasks by selecting it from the list of tasks in the Backup plans and tasks section in the left pane.
197
If you have also specified the retention rules in your backup scheme, the scheme will result in four tasks: three backup tasks and one cleanup task.
6.2.10
Archive validation
Set up the validation task to check if the backed up data is recoverable. If the backup could not pass the validation successfully, the validation task fails and the backup plan gets the Error status. To set up validation, specify the following parameters 1. When to validate select when to perform the validation. As the validation is a resourceintensive operation, it makes sense to schedule the validation to the managed machine's offpeak period. On the other hand, if the validation is a major part of your data protection strategy and you prefer to be immediately informed whether the backed up data is not corrupted and can be successfully recovered, think of starting the validation right after backup creation. 2. What to validate select either to validate the entire archive or the latest backup in the archive. Validation of a file backup imitates recovery of all files from the backup to a dummy destination. Validation of a volume backup calculates a checksum for every data block saved in the backup. Validation of the archive will validate all the archives backups and may take a long time and a lot of system resources. 3. Validation schedule (appears only if you have selected the on schedule in step 1) - set the schedule of validation. For more information see the Scheduling (p. 152) section.
6.2.11
When creating a backup plan (p. 181), you can set up regular conversion of a disk or volume backup to a virtual machine. This section provides information that helps you make the appropriate settings.
Agent for Windows is installed on the host You have a choice of virtual machine types: VMware Workstation, Microsoft Virtual PC, or Parallels Workstation. Files of the new virtual machine will be placed in the folder you select. Agent for ESX/ESXi is installed on the host A VMware virtual machine will be created on the ESX/ESXi server. Virtual machines resulting from backup are not supposed to be backed up and so do not appear on the management server, unless its integration with VMware vCenter Server is enabled. If the integration is enabled, such machines appear as unmanageable. A backup policy cannot be applied to them. Agent for Hyper-V is installed on the host You can choose between creating a virtual machine on the Hyper-V server and creating a VMware Workstation, Microsoft Virtual PC or Parallels Workstation machine in the folder you select. Virtual machines created on the Hyper-V server as a result of backup, will not appear on the management server, because such machines are not supposed to be backed up.
6.3
Recovering data
When it comes to data recovery, first consider the most functional method: connect the console to the managed machine running the operating system and create the recovery task.
199
If the managed machine's operating system fails to start or you need to recover data to bare metal, boot the machine from the bootable media (p. 349) or using Acronis Startup Recovery Manager (p. 45). Then, create a recovery task. Acronis Universal Restore (p. 45) lets you recover and boot up Windows on dissimilar hardware or a virtual machine. A Windows system can be brought online in seconds while it is still being recovered. Using the proprietary Acronis Active Restore (p. 47) technology, Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 will boot the machine into the operating system found in the backup as if the system were on the physical disk. The system becomes operational and ready to provide necessary services. Thus, the system downtime will be minimal. A dynamic volume can be recovered over an existing volume, to unallocated space of a disk group, or to unallocated space of a basic disk. To learn more about recovering dynamic volumes, please turn to the Microsoft LDM (Dynamic volumes) (p. 40) section. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows has the ability to recover a disk (volume) backup to a new virtual machine of any of the following types: VMware Workstation, Microsoft Virtual PC, Parallels Workstation or Citrix XenServer virtual appliance. The virtual appliance can then be imported to XenServer. The VMware Workstation machine can be converted to the open virtualization format (OVF) using the VMware OVF tool. With Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper-V or Agent for ESX/ESXi, you can create a new virtual machine on the respective virtualization server. You might need to prepare target disks before recovery. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 includes a handy disk management utility which enables you to create or delete volumes, change a disk partitioning style, create a disk group and perform other disk management operations on the target hardware, both under the operating system and on bare metal. To find out more about Acronis Disk Director LV, see the Disk management (p. 251) section.
General
Task name [Optional] Enter a unique name for the recovery task. A conscious name lets you quickly identify the task among the others. Task credentials (p. 202) [Optional] The task will run on behalf of the user who is creating the task. You can change the task account credentials if necessary. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box .
What to recover
Archive (p. 202) Select the archive to recover data from. Data type (p. 203) Applies to: disk recovery Choose the type of data you need to recover from the selected disk backup. Content (p. 203) Select the backup and content to be recovered. Access credentials (p. 204)
200
[Optional] Provide credentials for the archive location if the task account does not have the right to access it. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
Where to recover
This section appears after the required backup is selected and the type of data to recover is defined. The parameters you specify here depend on the type of data being recovered. Disks (p. 205) Volumes (p. 206) Acronis Active Restore [OPTIONAL] The Acronis Active Restore check box is available when recovering Windows starting from Windows 2000. Acronis Active Restore brings a system online immediately after the recovery is started. The operating system boots from the backup image and the machine becomes operational and ready to provide necessary services. The data required to serve incoming requests is recovered with the highest priority; everything else is recovered in the background. See Acronis Active Restore (p. 47) for details. Files (p. 210) You may have to specify credentials for the destination. Skip this step when operating on a machine booted with bootable media. Access credentials (p. 211) [Optional] Provide credentials for the destination if the task credentials do not enable recovery of the selected data. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
When to recover
Recover (p. 211) Select when to start recovery. The task can start immediately after its creation, be scheduled for a specified date and time in the future or simply saved for manual execution.
Recovery options
Settings [Optional] Customize the recovery operation by configuring the recovery options, such as pre/post recovery commands, recovery priority, error handling or notification options. If you do nothing in this section, the default values (p. 107) will be used. After any of the settings is changed against the default value, a new line that displays the newly set value appears. The setting status changes from Default to Custom. Should you modify the setting again, the line will display the new value unless the new value is the
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 201
default one. When the default value is set, the line disappears and so you always see only the settings that differ from the default values in the Settings section. Clicking Reset to default resets all the settings to default values. After you complete all the required steps, click OK to create the commit creating of the recovery task.
6.3.1
Task credentials
Provide credentials for the account under which the task will run.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Run under the current user The task will run under the credentials with which the user who starts the tasks is logged on. If the task has to run on schedule, you will be asked for the current user's password on completing the task creation. Use the following credentials The task will always run under the credentials you specify, whether started manually or executed on schedule. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
Password. The password for the account. 2. Click OK. To learn more about using credentials in Acronis Backup & Recovery 10, see the Owners and credentials (p. 30) section. To learn more about operations available depending on the user privileges, see the User privileges on a managed machine (p. 30) section.
6.3.2
Archive selection
If the archive is stored in a centralized vault, expand the Centralized group and click the vault. If the archive is stored in a personal vault, expand the Personal group and click the vault. If the archive is stored in a local folder on the machine, expand the Local folders group and click the required folder.
If the a rchive is located on removable media, e.g. DVDs, first insert the last DVD and then insert the discs in order starting fro m the first one wh en the p rogram p rompts.
If the archive is stored on a network share, expand the Network folders group, then select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder. If the network share requires access credentials, the program will ask for them.
Note fo r Linux users: To sp ecify a Common Intern et File System (CIFS) netwo rk share which is mounted on a mount point such as /mnt/share, select this mount point instead of the n etwork sha re itself.
202
If the archive is stored on an FTP or SFTP server, type the server name or address in the Path field as follows: ftp://ftp_server:port _number or sftp://sftp_server:port number If the port number is not specified, port 21 is used for FTP and port 22 is used for SFTP. After entering access credentials, the folders on the server become available. Click the appropriate folder on the server. You can access the server as an anonymous user if the server enables such access. To do so, click Use anonymous access instead of entering credentials.
According to the original FTP specifica tion, cred entials required for a ccess to FTP servers are transferred through a netwo rk as plaintext. This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer.
If the archive is stored on a locally attached tape device, expand the Tape drives group, then click the required device. 2. In the table to the right of the tree, select the archive. The table displays the names of the archives contained in each vault/folder you select. While you are reviewing the location content, archives can be added, deleted or modified by another user or by the program itself according to scheduled operations. Use the Refresh button to refresh the list of archives. 3. Click OK.
6.3.3
Data type
Choose what type of data to recover from the selected disk backup: Disks - to recover disks Volumes - to recover volumes Files - to recover specific files and folders
6.3.4
Content selection
The representation of this window depends on the type of data stored in the archive.
Disks/volumes selection
To select a backup and disks/volumes to recover:
1. Select one of the successive backups by its creation date and time. Thus, you can revert the disk data to a certain moment in time. Specify the items to recover. By default, all items of the selected backup will be selected. If you do not want to recover certain items, just uncheck them. To obtain information on a disk/volume, right-click it and then click Information. 2. Click OK.
Selecting an MBR
You will usually select the disk's MBR if:
The operating system cannot boot The disk is new and does not have an MBR Recovering custom or non-Windows boot loaders (such as LILO and GRUB) The disk geometry is different to that stored in the backup.
203
There are probably other times when you may need to recover the MBR, but the above are the most common. When recovering the MBR of one disk to another Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 recovers Track 0, which does not affect the target disks partition table and partition layout. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 automatically updates Windows loaders after recovery, so there is no need to recover the MBR and Track 0 for Windows systems, unless the MBR is damaged.
Files selection
To select a backup and files to recover:
1. Select one of the successive backups by its creation date/time. Thus, you can revert the files/folders to a specific moment in time. 2. Specify the files and folders to recover by selecting the corresponding check boxes in the archives tree. Selecting a folder automatically selects all its nested folders and files. Use the table to the right of the archives tree to select the nested items. Selecting the check box for the Name column's header automatically selects all items in the table. Clearing this check box automatically deselects all the items. 3. Click OK.
6.3.5
Specify the credentials required for access to the location where the backup archive is stored.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Use the task credentials The program will access the location using the credentials of the task account specified in the General section. Use the following credentials The program will access the location using the credentials you specify. Use this option if the task account does not have access permissions to the location. You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node vault. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
6.3.6
Destination selection
204
Disks
Available disk destinations depend on the agents operating on the machine.
Recover to:
Physical machine Available when the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows or Agent for Linux is installed. The selected disks will be recovered to the physical disks of the machine the console is connected to. On selecting this, you proceed to the regular disk mapping procedure described below. New virtual machine (p. 209) If Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows is installed. The selected disks will be recovered to a new virtual machine of any of the following types: VMware Workstation, Microsoft Virtual PC, Parallels Workstation or Citrix XenServer virtual appliance. The virtual machine files will be saved to the destination you specify. If Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper-V or Agent for ESX/ESXi is installed. These agents enable creating a new virtual machine on the virtualization server you specify. The new virtual machine will be configured automatically, the source machine configuration being copied where possible. The configuration is displayed in the Virtual Machine Settings (p. 209) section. Check the settings and make changes if necessary. Then you proceed to the regular disk mapping procedure described below. Existing virtual machine Available when the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper-V or Agent for ESX/ESXi is installed. On selecting this, you specify the virtualization server and the target virtual machine. Then you proceed to the regular disk mapping procedure described below.
Please be awa re that th e targ et machine will be po wered off automa tically before the recovery. If you prefer to power it off manually, modify the VM po wer management option .
Disk #:
Disk # (MODEL) (p. 207) Select the destination disk for each of the source disks. NT signature (p. 206) Select the way the recovered disk's signature will be handled. The disk signature is used by Windows and the Linux kernel version 2.6 and later.
Disk destination
To specify a destination disk:
1. Select a disk where you want the selected disk to recover to. The destination disk's space should be at least the same size as the uncompressed image data. 2. Click OK.
All the data sto red on the targ et disk will be replaced by the ba cked up data, so be careful and watch out for non-backed-up data that you might need.
205
NT signature
When the MBR is selected along with the disk backup, you need to retain operating system bootability on the target disk volume. The operating system must have the system volume information (e.g. volume letter) matched with the disk NT signature, which is kept in the MBR disk record. But two disks with the same NT signature cannot work properly under one operating system.
If there a re two disks having the same NT signature and comp rising of a system volume on a machine, at the startup the operating system runs from the first disk, discovers the sa me signatu re on th e second one, automatically generates a n ew unique NT signatu re and assigns it to th e second disk. As a result, all the volumes on the second disk will lose their letters, all paths will be invalid on the disk, and p rograms won't find their files. The operating system on that disk will be unbootable.
To retain system bootability on the target disk volume, choose one of the following: Select automatically
A new NT signature will be created only if the existing one differs from the one in the backup. Otherwise, the existing NT signature will be kept.
Create new The program will generate a new NT signature for the target hard disk drive. Recover from backup The program will replace the NT signature of the target hard disk with one from the disk backup. Recovering the disk signature may be desirable due to the following reasons:
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 creates scheduled tasks using the signature of the source hard disk. If you recover the same disk signature, you don't need to re-create or edit the tasks created previously Some installed applications use disk signature for licensing and other purposes This enables to keep all the Windows Restore Points on the recovered disk
To recover VSS snapshots used by Windows Vista's "Previous Versions" feature Keep existing The program will leave the existing NT signature of the target hard disk as is.
Volumes
Available volume destinations depend on the agents operating on the machine.
Recover to:
Physical machine Available when the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows or Agent for Linux is installed. The selected volumes will be recovered to the physical disks of the machine the console is connected to. On selecting this, you proceed to the regular volume mapping procedure described below. New virtual machine (p. 209) If Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows is installed. The selected volumes will be recovered to a new virtual machine of any of the following types: VMware Workstation, Microsoft Virtual PC, Parallels Workstation or Citrix XenServer virtual appliance. The virtual machine files will be saved to the destination you specify. If Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper-V or Agent for ESX/ESXi is installed. These agents enable creating a new virtual machine on the virtualization server you specify.
206 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
The new virtual machine will be configured automatically, the source machine configuration being copied where possible. The configuration is displayed in the Virtual Machine Settings (p. 209) section. Check the settings and make changes if necessary. Then you proceed to the regular volume mapping procedure described below. Existing virtual machine Available when the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper-V or Agent for ESX/ESXi is installed. On selecting this, you specify the virtualization server and the target virtual machine. Then you proceed to the regular volume mapping procedure described below.
Please be awa re that th e targ et machine will be po wered off automa tically before recovery. If you prefer to power it off manually, modify the VM power management option.
Recover [Disk #] MBR to: [If the Master Boot Record is selected for recovery]
Disk # (p. 207) Choose the disk to recover the Master Boot Record to. NT signature: (p. 206) Select the way the disk's signature contained in the MBR will be handled. The disk signature is used by Windows and the Linux kernel version 2.6 and later.
MBR destination
To specify a destination disk:
1. Select the disk to recover the MBR to. 2. Click OK.
Volume destination
To specify a destination volume:
1. Select a volume or unallocated space where you want the selected volume to be recovered to. The destination volume/unallocated space should be at least the same size as the uncompressed image data. 2. Click OK.
All the data sto red on the targ et volume will b e replaced by th e backed up data, so be ca reful and wa tch out fo r non-backed-up data that you might need.
The Linux-style bootable media shows local disks and volumes as unmounted (sda1, sda2...).
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 207
Volume properties
Resizing and relocating
When recovering a volume to a basic MBR disk, you can resize and relocate the volume by dragging it or its borders with a mouse or by entering corresponding values in the appropriate fields. Using this feature, you can redistribute the disk space between the volumes being recovered. In this case, you will have to recover the volume to be reduced first.
Tip: A volume cannot be resized when being recovered fro m a backup split in to multiple removable media. To be able to resize the volume, copy all parts of the backup to a single location on a hard disk.
Properties
Type
A basic MBR disk can contain up to four primary volumes or up to three primary volumes and multiple logical drives. By default, the program selects the original volume's type. You can change this setting, if required.
Primary. Information about primary volumes is contained in the MBR partition table. Most operating systems can boot only from the primary volume of the first hard disk, but the number of primary volumes is limited. If you are going to recover a system volume to a basic MBR disk, select the Active check box. Active volume is used for loading an operating system. Choosing active for a volume without an installed operating system could prevent the machine from booting. You cannot set a logical drive or dynamic volume active. Logical. Information about logical volumes is located not in the MBR, but in the extended partition table. The number of logical volumes on a disk is unlimited. A logical volume cannot be set as active. If you recover a system volume to another hard disk with its own volumes and operating system, you will most likely need only the data. In this case, you can recover the volume as logical to access the data only.
File system
Change the volume file system, if required. By default, the program selects the original volume's file system. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 can make the following file system conversions: FAT 16 -> FAT 32 and Ext2 -> Ext3. For volumes with other native file systems, this option is not available. Assume you are going to recover a volume from an old, low-capacity FAT16 disk to a newer disk. FAT16 would not be effective and might even be impossible to set on the high-capacity hard disk. That's because FAT16 supports volumes up to 4GB, so you will not be able to recover a 4GB FAT16 volume to a volume that exceeds that limit, without changing the file system. It would make sense here to change the file system from FAT16 to FAT32. Older operating systems (MS-DOS, Windows 95 and Windows NT 3.x, 4.x) do not support FAT32 and will not be operable after you recover a volume and change its file system. These can be normally recovered on a FAT16 volume only.
With the default AUTO selection, the first unused letter will be assigned to the volume. If you select NO, no letter will be assigned to the recovered volume, hiding it from the OS.You should not assign letters to volumes that are inaccessible to Windows, such as to those other than FAT and NTFS.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
208
To select the virtualization server the new virtual machine will be created on
1. Choose the Place on the virtualization server that I select option. 2. In the left part of the window, select the virtualization server. Use the right part of the window to review details on the selected server. 3. Click OK to return to the Data recovery page.
Storage
Initial setting: the default storage of the virtualization server if the new machine is created on the virtualization server. Otherwise the current user's documents folder. This is the place where the new virtual machine will be created. Whether you can change the storage on the virtualization server or not, depends on the virtualization product brand and settings. VMware ESX may have multiple storages. A Microsoft Hyper-V server enables creating a new virtual machine in any local folder.
Memory
Initial setting: if not contained in the backup, the default setting of the virtualization server. This is the amount of memory allocated to the new virtual machine. The memory adjustment range depends on the host hardware, the host operating system and the virtualization product settings. For example, virtual machines may be allowed to use no more than 30% of memory.
Disks
Initial setting: the number and size of the source machine's disks. The number of disks is generally equal to that of the source machine, but might be different if the program has to add more disks to accommodate the source machine volumes because of limitations set by the virtualization product. You can add virtual disks to the machine configuration or, in some cases, delete the proposed disks.
Implementa tion of Xen ma chines is based on Microsoft Virtual PC and inherits its limita tions: up to 3 IDE disks with a maximum size of 127 GB and 1 processor. SCSI disks a re not supported .
Processors
Initial setting: if not contained in the backup or the backed up setting is not supported by the virtualization server, the default server's setting.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 209
This is the number of processors of the new virtual machine. In most cases it is set to one. The result of assignment of more than one processor to the machine is not guaranteed. The number of virtual processors may be limited by the host CPU configuration, the virtualization product and the guest operating system. Multiple virtual processors are generally available on multi-processor hosts. A multicore host CPU or hyperthreading may enable multiple virtual processors on a single-processor host.
File destination
To specify a destination:
1. Select a location to recover the backed up files to: Original location - files and folders will be recovered to the same path(s) as they are in the backup. For example, if you have backed up all files and folders in C:\Documents\Finance\Reports\, the files will be recovered to the same path. If the folder does not exist, it will be created automatically. New location - files will be recovered to the location that you specify in the tree. The files and folders will be recovered without recreating a full path, unless you clear the Recover without full path check box. 2. Click OK.
Recovery exclusions
Set up exclusions for the specific files you do not wish to recover. Use the Add, Edit, Remove and Remove All buttons to create the list of file masks. Files whose names match any of the masks will be skipped during recovery. You can use one or more wildcard characters * and ? in a file mask: The asterisk (*) substitutes for zero or more characters in a file name; for example, the file mask Doc*.txt yields files such as Doc.txt and Document.txt The question mark (?) substitutes for exactly one character in a file name; for example, the file mask Doc?.txt yields files such as Doc1.txt and Docs.txt but not the files Doc.txt or Doc11.txt Exclusion examples
Criterion By name By path Mask (*) Mask (?) Example File1.log C:\Finance\test.log *.log my???.log Description Excludes all files named File1.log. Excludes the file named test.log located in the folder C:\Finance Excludes all files with the .log extension. Excludes all .log files with names consisting of five symbols and starting with my.
The above settings are not effective for the files or folders that were explicitly selected for recovery. For example, assume that you selected the folder MyFolder and the file MyFile.tmp outside that folder, and selected to skip all .tmp files. In this case, all .tmp files in the folder MyFolder will be skipped during the recovery process, but the file MyFile.tmp will not be skipped.
210
Overwriting
Choose what to do if the program finds in the target folder a file with the same name as in the archive:
Overwrite existing file - this will give the file in the backup priority over the file on the hard disk. Overwrite existing file if it is older - this will give priority to the most recent file modification, whether it be in the backup or on the disk. Do not overwrite existing file - this will give the file on the hard disk priority over the file in the backup.
If you allow files to be overwritten, you still have an option to prevent overwriting of specific files by excluding (p. 210) them from the recovery operation.
6.3.7
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
6.3.8
When to recover
Select when to start the recovery task: Recover now - the recovery task will be started immediately after you click the final OK. Recover later - the recovery task will be started at the date and time you specify.
If you do not need to schedule the task and wish to start it manually afterwards, select the Task will be started manually (do no schedule the task) check box.
6.3.9
Universal Restore
Use Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Universal Restore when you need to recover and boot up Windows on dissimilar hardware. Universal Restore handles differences in devices that are critical for the operating system startup, such as storage controllers, motherboard or chipset. To learn more about the Universal Restore technology, see the Universal Restore (p. 45) section.
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Universal Restore is not available when: a machine is booted with Acronis Startup Recovery Manager (using F11) the backup image is located in Acronis Secure Zone
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 211
because these features are primarily meant for instant data recovery on the same machine.
Preparation
Before recovering Windows to dissimilar hardware, make sure that you have the drivers for the new HDD controller and the chipset. These drivers are critical to start the operating system. Use the CD or DVD supplied by the hardware vendor or download the drivers from the vendors Web site. The driver files should have the *.inf, *.sys or *.oem extensions. If you download the drivers in the *.exe, *.cab or *.zip format, extract them using a third-party application, such as WinRAR (http://www.rarlab.com/) or Universal Extractor (http://legroom.net/software/uniextract). The best practice is to store drivers for all the hardware used in your organization in a single repository sorted by device type or by the hardware configurations. You can keep a copy of the repository on a DVD or a flash drive; pick some drivers and add them to the bootable media; create the custom bootable media with the necessary drivers (and the necessary network configuration) for each of your servers. Or you can simply specify the path to the repository every time Universal Restore is used.
212
6.3.10
Rather than converting a TIB file to a virtual disk file, which requires additional operations to bring the virtual disk into use, Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 performs the conversion by recovery of a disk backup to a fully configured and operational new virtual machine. You have the ability to adapt the virtual machine configuration to your needs when configuring the recovery operation. With Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows, you can recover a disk (volume) backup to a new virtual machine of any of the following types: VMware Workstation, Microsoft Virtual PC, Parallels Workstation or Citrix XenServer virtual appliance. Files of the new virtual machine will be placed in the folder you select. You can start the machine using the respective virtualization software or prepare the machine files for further usage. The Citrix XenServer virtual appliance can be imported to a XenServer using Citrix XenCenter. The VMware Workstation machine can be converted to the open virtualization format (OVF) using the VMware OVF tool. With Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper-V or Agent for ESX/ESXi, you can recover a disk (volume) backup to a new virtual machine on the respective virtualization server.
Click Recover to open the Recover data page. Start creating a recovery task as described in "Recovering data (p. 199)". Select the archive and then select the disk or volume backup you want to convert.
3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
Use the Navigation pane to navigate to the vault where the archive is stored. Select the archive and then select the disk or volume backup you want to convert. Click Recover as virtual machine. The Recover data page opens with the pre-selected backup. In Data type, select Disks or Volumes depending on what you need to convert. In Content, select the disks to convert or the volumes with the Master Boot Records (MBR) of the corresponding disks. In Recover to, select New virtual machine. In VM server, select the type of the new virtual machine to be created or on which virtualization server to create the machine. In VM name, enter the name for the new virtual machine. [Optionally] Review the Virtual machine settings (p. 209) and make changes if necessary. Here you can change the path to the new virtual machine.
213
The same type of machines with the same na me cannot be created in the same fold er. Change either the VM name, or the path if you get an error message caused by identical names.
9. Select the destination disk for each of the source disks or source volumes and MBRs.
On a Microsoft Virtual PC, be sure to recover th e disk or volu me where the op erating system's loader resides to th e Hard disk 1 . Otherwise the operating system will not boot. This cannot be fixed by changing the boot device ord er in BIOS, because a Virtual PC ignores th ese settings.
10. In When to recover, specify when to start the recovery task. 11. [Optionally] Review Recovery options and change the settings from the default ones, if need be. You can specify in Recovery options > VM power management whether to start the new virtual machine automatically, after the recovery is completed. This option is available only when the new machine is created on a virtualization server. 12. Click OK. If the recovery task is scheduled for the future, specify the credentials under which the task will run. You will be taken to the Backup plans and tasks view where you can examine the state and progress of the recovery task.
6.3.11
Bootability troubleshooting
If a system was bootable at the time of backup, you expect that it will boot after recovery. However, the information the operating system stores and uses for booting up may become outdated during recovery, especially if you change volume sizes, locations or destination drives. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 automatically updates Windows loaders after recovery. Other loaders might also be fixed, but there are cases when you have to re-activate the loaders. Specifically when you recover Linux volumes, it is sometimes necessary to apply fixes or make booting changes so that Linux can boot and load correctly. Below is a summary of typical situations that require additional user actions.
214
Solution: Boot the machine from the Acronis Disk Director's bootable media and select in the menu Tools -> Activate OS Selector.
The system uses GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB) and was recovered from a normal (not from a raw, that is, sector-by-sector) backup One part of the GRUB loader resides either in the first several sectors of the disk or in the first several sectors of the volume. The rest is on the file system of one of the volumes. System bootability can be recovered automatically only when the GRUB resides in the first several sectors of the disk and on the file system to which direct access is possible. In other cases, the user has to manually reactivate the boot loader. Solution: Reactivate the boot loader. You might also need to fix the configuration file. The system uses Linux Loader (LILO) and was recovered from a normal (not from a raw, that is, sector-by-sector) backup LILO contains numerous references to absolute sector numbers and so cannot be repaired automatically except for the case when all data is recovered to the sectors that have the same absolute numbers as on the source disk. Solution: Reactivate the boot loader. You might also need to fix the loader configuration file for the reason described in the previous item. The system loader points to the wrong volume This may happen when system or boot volumes are not recovered to their original location. Solution: Modification of the boot.ini or the boot\bcd files fixes this for Windows loaders. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 does this automatically and so you are not likely to experience the problem. For the GRUB and LILO loaders, you will need to correct the GRUB configuration files. If the number of the Linux root partition has changed, it is also recommended that you change /etc/fstab so that the SWAP volume can be accessed correctly. Linux was recovered from an LVM volume backup to a basic MBR disk Such system cannot boot because its kernel tries to mount the root file system at the LVM volume. Solution: Change the loader configuration and /etc/fstab so that the LVM is not used and reactivate the boot loader.
3. Mount the proc and dev file systems to the system you are recovering:
mount -t proc none /mnt/system/proc/ mount -o bind /dev/ /mnt/system/dev/
4. Save a copy of the GRUB menu file, by running one of the following commands:
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 215
cp /mnt/system/boot/grub/menu.lst /mnt/system/boot/grub/menu.lst.backup
or
cp /mnt/system/boot/grub/grub.conf /mnt/system/boot/grub/grub.conf.backup
5. Edit the /mnt/system/boot/grub/menu.lst file (for Debian, Ubuntu, and SUSE Linux distributions) or the /mnt/system/boot/grub/grub.conf file (for Fedora and Red Hat Enterprise Linux distributions)for example, as follows:
vi /mnt/system/boot/grub/menu.lst
6. In the menu.lst file (respectively grub.conf), find the menu item that corresponds to the system you are recovering. This menu items have the following form:
title Red Hat Enterprise Linux Server (2.6.24.4) root (hd0,0) kernel /vmlinuz-2.6.24.4 ro root=/dev/sda2 rhgb quiet initrd /initrd-2.6.24.4.img
The lines starting with title, root, kernel, and initrd respectively determine:
The title of the menu item. The device on which the Linux kernel is locatedtypically, this is the boot partition or the root partition, such as root (hd0,0) in this example. The path to the kernel on that device and the root partitionin this example, the path is /vmlinuz-2.6.24.4 and the root partition is /dev/sda2. You can specify the root partition by label (such as root=LABEL=/), identifier (in the form root=UUID=some_uuid), or device name (such as root=/dev/sda2).
The path to the initrd service on that device. 7. Edit the file /mnt/system/etc/fstab to correct the names of any devices that have changed as a result of the recovery. 8. Start the GRUB shell by running one of the following commands:
chroot /mnt/system/ /sbin/grub
or
chroot /mnt/system/ /usr/sbin/grub
9. Specify the disk on which GRUB is locatedtypically, the boot or root partition:
root (hd0,0)
10. Install GRUB. For example, to install GRUB in the master boot record (MBR) of the first disk, run the following command:
setup (hd0)
13. Reconfigure the bootloader by using tools and documentation from the Linux distribution that you use. For example, in Debian and Ubuntu, you may need to edit some commented lines in the /boot/grub/menu.lst file and then run the update-grub script; otherwise, the changes might not take effect.
216
Windows Vista/2008
A part of the loader resides in the partition boot sector, the rest is in the files bootmgr, boot\bcd. At starting Windows, boot\bcd is mounted to the registry key HKLM \BCD00000000.
6.3.12
In addition to backing up data to centralized vaults managed by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node, you may want to perform a disk backup of the machine where the storage node itself is installed. This section describes how to recover the storage node registered on the management server in case the storage node and the management server are installed on different machines (if they are installed on the same machine, simply recover that machine). Consider the following scenario:
You have a machine with the management server and a machine with the storage node. The storage node is registered on the management server. You backed up the machine with the storage node earlier, and have just recovered iteither on the same machine or on a different machine. If you have recovered the storage node on the same machine and no centralized vaults managed by the storage node have been added or removed between the backup and recovery, do nothing. Otherwise, do the following: 1. Connect to the management server and remove the storage node from it.
Note: All vaults managed by the sto rage node will also be removed from the managemen t server. No archives will be lo st.
2. Add the storage node to the management server again, by specifiying the machine on which the recovered storage node is installed. 3. Re-create the necessary managed vaults.
6.4
Validation is an operation that checks the possibility of data recovery from a backup. Validation of a file backup imitates recovery of all files from the backup to a dummy destination. Validation of a disk or volume backup calculates a checksum for every data block saved in the backup. Both procedures are resource-intensive.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 217
Validation of an archive will validate all the archive's backups. A vault (or a location) validation will validate all archives stored in this vault (location). While successful validation means high probability of successful recovery, it does not check all factors that influence the recovery process. If you back up the operating system, only a test recovery in bootable environment to a spare hard drive can guarantee success of the recovery. At least ensure that the backup can be successfully validated using the bootable media.
General
Task name [Optional] Enter a unique name for the validation task. A conscious name lets you quickly identify the task among the others. Credentials (p. 219) [Optional] The validation task will run on behalf of the user who is creating the task. You can change the task credentials if necessary. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
What to validate
Validate Choose an object to validate: Archive (p. 219) - in that case, you need to specify the archive. Backup (p. 220) - specify the archive first, and then select the desired backup in this archive. Vault (p. 220) - select a vault (or other location), which archives to validate. Access Credentials (p. 221) [Optional] Provide credentials for accessing the source if the task account does not have enough privileges to access it. To access this option, select the check box for Advanced view.
When to validate
Validate (p. 221) Specify when and how often to perform validation. After you configure all the required settings, click OK to create the validation task.
218
6.4.1
Task credentials
Provide credentials for the account under which the task will run.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Run under the current user The task will run under the credentials with which the user who starts the tasks is logged on. If the task has to run on schedule, you will be asked for the current user's password on completing the task creation. Use the following credentials The task will always run under the credentials you specify, whether started manually or executed on schedule. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
Password. The password for the account. 2. Click OK. To learn more about using credentials in Acronis Backup & Recovery 10, see the Owners and credentials (p. 30) section. To learn more about operations available depending on the user privileges, see the User privileges on a managed machine (p. 30) section.
6.4.2
Archive selection
If the archive is stored in a centralized vault, expand the Centralized group and click the vault. If the archive is stored in a personal vault, expand the Personal group and click the vault. If the archive is stored in a local folder on the machine, expand the Local folders group and click the required folder.
If the a rchive is located on removable media, e.g. DVDs, first insert the last DVD and then insert the discs in order starting fro m the first one wh en the p rogram p rompts.
If the archive is stored on a network share, expand the Network folders group, then select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder. If the network share requires access credentials, the program will ask for them.
Note fo r Linux users: To sp ecify a Common Intern et File System (CIFS) netwo rk share which is mounted on a mount point such as /mnt/share, select this mount point instead of the n etwork sha re itself.
If the archive is stored on an FTP or SFTP server, type the server name or address in the Path field as follows: ftp://ftp_server:port _number or sftp://sftp_server:port number If the port number is not specified, port 21 is used for FTP and port 22 is used for SFTP. After entering access credentials, the folders on the server become available. Click the appropriate folder on the server.
219
You can access the server as an anonymous user if the server enables such access. To do so, click Use anonymous access instead of entering credentials.
According to the original FTP specifica tion, cred entials required for a ccess to FTP servers are transferred through a netwo rk as plaintext. This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer.
If the archive is stored on a locally attached tape device, expand the Tape drives group, then click the required device. 2. In the table to the right of the tree, select the archive. The table displays the names of the archives contained in each vault/folder you select. While you are reviewing the location content, archives can be added, deleted or modified by another user or by the program itself according to scheduled operations. Use the Refresh button to refresh the list of archives. 3. Click OK.
6.4.3
Backup selection
6.4.4
Location selection
To select a location
Enter the full path to the location in the Path field or select the desired location in the folders tree.
To select a centralized vault, expand the Centralized group and click the appropriate vault. To select a personal vault, expand the Personal group and click the appropriate vault. To select a local folder (CD/DVD drive, or locally attached tape device), expand the Local folders group and click the required folder. To select a network share, expand the Network folders group, select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder. If the network share requires access credentials, the program will ask for them. To select FTP or SFTP server, expand the corresponding group and click the appropriate folder on the server.
According to the original FTP specification, credentials required for access to FTP servers are transferred through a network as plaintext. This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer.
220
6.4.5
Specify the credentials required for access to the location where the backup archive is stored.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Use the task credentials The program will access the location using the credentials of the task account specified in the General section. Use the following credentials The program will access the location using the credentials you specify. Use this option if the task account does not have access permissions to the location. You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node vault. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
6.4.6
When to validate
As validation is a resource-intensive operation, it makes sense to schedule validation to the managed machine's off-peak period. On the other hand, if you prefer to be immediately informed whether the data is not corrupted and can be successfully recovered, consider starting validation right after the task creation.
Choose one of the following: Now - to start the validation task right after its creation, that is, after clicking OK on the
Validation page.
Later - to start the one-time validation task, at the date and time you specify. Specify the appropriate parameters as follows:
Date and time - the date and time when to start the task. The task will be started manually (do not schedule the task) - select this check box, if you wish to start the task manually later.
On schedule - to schedule the task. To learn more about how to configure the scheduling parameters, please see the Scheduling (p. 152) section.
6.5
Mounting an image
Mounting volumes from a disk backup (image) lets you access the volumes as though they were physical disks. Multiple volumes contained in the same backup can be mounted within a single mount operation. The mount operation is available when the console is connected to a managed machine running either Windows or Linux. Mounting volumes in the read/write mode enables you to modify the backup content, that is, save, move, create, delete files or folders, and run executables consisting of one file.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 221
Limitation: Mounting of volume backups stored on Acronis Ba ckup & Recovery 10 Storage Node is not possible.
Usage scenarios:
Sharing: mounted images can be easily shared to networked users. "Band aid" database recovery solution: mount up an image that contains an SQL database from a recently failed machine. This will give access to the database until the failed machine is recovered. Offline virus clean: if a machine is attacked, the administrator shuts it down, boots with bootable media and creates an image. Then, the administrator mounts this image in read/write mode, scans and cleans it with an antivirus program, and finally recovers the machine. Error check: if recovery failed due to a disk error, mount the image in the read/write mode. Then, check the mounted disk for errors with the chkdsk /r command.
Source
Archive (p. 222) Specify the path to the archive location and select the archive containing disk backups. Backup (p. 223) Select the backup. Access credentials (p. 223) [Optional] Provide credentials for the archive location. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
Mount settings
Volumes (p. 224) Select volumes to mount and configure the mount settings for every volume: assign a letter or enter the mount point, choose the read/write or read only access mode. When you complete all the required steps, click OK to mount the volumes.
6.5.1
Archive selection
If the archive is stored in a centralized vault, expand the Centralized group and click the vault. If the archive is stored in a personal vault, expand the Personal group and click the vault. If the archive is stored in a local folder on the machine, expand the Local folders group and click the required folder.
If the a rchive is located on removable media, e.g. DVDs, first insert the last DVD and then insert the discs in order starting fro m the first one wh en the p rogram p rompts.
If the archive is stored on a network share, expand the Network folders group, then select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder. If the network share requires access credentials, the program will ask for them.
Note fo r Linux users: To sp ecify a Common Intern et File System (CIFS) netwo rk share which is mounted on a mount point such as /mnt/share, select this mount point instead of the n etwork sha re itself.
222
If the archive is stored on an FTP or SFTP server, type the server name or address in the Path field as follows: ftp://ftp_server:port _number or sftp://sftp_server:port number If the port number is not specified, port 21 is used for FTP and port 22 is used for SFTP. After entering access credentials, the folders on the server become available. Click the appropriate folder on the server. You can access the server as an anonymous user if the server enables such access. To do so, click Use anonymous access instead of entering credentials.
According to the original FTP specifica tion, cred entials required for a ccess to FTP servers are transferred through a netwo rk as plaintext. This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer.
If the archive is stored on a locally attached tape device, expand the Tape drives group, then click the required device. 2. In the table to the right of the tree, select the archive. The table displays the names of the archives contained in each vault/folder you select. While you are reviewing the location content, archives can be added, deleted or modified by another user or by the program itself according to scheduled operations. Use the Refresh button to refresh the list of archives. 3. Click OK.
6.5.2
Backup selection
To select a backup:
1. Select one of the backups by its creation date/time. 2. To assist you with choosing the right backup, the bottom table displays the volumes contained in the selected backup. To obtain information on a volume, right-click it and then click Information. 3. Click OK.
6.5.3
Access credentials
Use the current user credentials The program will access the location using the credentials of the current user. Use the following credentials The program will access the location using the credentials you specify. Use this option if the current user account does not have access permissions to the location. You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node vault. Specify:
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
6.5.4
Volume selection
Select the volumes to mount and configure the mounting parameters for each of the selected volumes as follows: 1. Select the check box for each volume you need to mount. 2. Click on the selected volume to set its mounting parameters. Access mode - choose the mode you want the volume to be mounted in:
Read only - enables exploring and opening files within the backup without committing any changes. Read/write - with this mode, the program assumes that the backup content will be modified, and creates an incremental backup to capture the changes.
Assign letter (in Windows) - Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 will assign an unused letter to the mounted volume. If required, select another letter to assign from the drop-down list. Mount point (in Linux) - specify the directory where you want the volume to be mounted. 3. If several volumes are selected for mounting, click on every volume to set its mounting parameters, described in the previous step. 4. Click OK.
6.6
Once a volume is mounted, you can browse files and folders contained in the backup using a file manager and copy the desired files to any destination. Thus, if you need to take out only a few files and folders from a volume backup, you do not have to perform the recovery procedure.
Exploring images
Exploring mounted volumes lets you view and modify (if mounted in the read/write mode) the volume's content. To explore a mounted volume select it in the table and click Explore. The default file manager window opens, allowing the user to examine the mounted volume contents.
Unmounting images
Maintaining the mounted volumes takes considerable system resources. It is recommended that you unmount the volumes after the necessary operations are completed. If not unmounted manually, a volume will remain mounted until the operating system restarts. To unmount an image, select it in the table and click To unmount all the mounted volumes, click Unmount.
Unmount all.
6.7
The export operation creates a copy of an archive or a self-sufficient part copy of an archive in the location you specify. The original archive remains untouched. The export operation can be applied to:
224
a single backup - an archive consisting of a single full backup will be created. The export of an incremental or a differential backup is performed using consolidation of the preceding backups up to the nearest full backup your choice of backups belonging to the same archive - the resulting archive will contain only the specified backups. Consolidation is performed as required, so the resulting archive may contain full, incremental and differential backups. an entire vault that can be exported by using the command line interface. For more information, please refer to Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Command Line Reference.
Usage scenarios Export enables you to separate a specific backup from a chain of incremental backups for fast recovery, writing onto removable or detachable media or other purposes. By exporting a managed vault to a detachable media, you obtain a portable unmanaged vault that can be used in the following scenarios:
keeping an off-site copy of your vault or of the most important archives physical transportation of a vault to a distant branch office recovery without access to the storage node in case of networking problems or failure of the storage node recovery of the storage node itself.
Export from an HDD-based vault to a tape device can be considered as simple on-demand archive staging. The resulting archive's name By default, the exported archive inherits the name of the original archive. Because having multiple archives of the same names in the same location is not advisable, the following actions are disabled with the default archive name:
exporting part of an archive to the same location exporting an archive or part of an archive to a location where an archive of the same name exists exporting an archive or part of an archive to the same location twice
In any of the above cases, provide an archive name that is unique to the destination folder or vault. If you need to redo the export using the same archive name, first delete the archive that resulted from the previous export operation. The resulting archive's options The exported archive inherits the options of the original archive, including encryption and the password. When exporting a password-protected archive, you are prompted for the password. If the original archive is encrypted, the password is used to encrypt the resulting archive. Source and destination locations When the console is connected to a managed machine, you can export an archive or part of an archive to and from any location accessible to the agent residing on the machine. These include personal vaults, locally attached tape devices, removable media and, in the advanced product versions, managed and unmanaged centralized vaults. When the console is connected to a management server, two export methods are available:
225
export from a managed vault. The export is performed by the storage node that manages the vault. The destination can be a network share or a local folder of the storage node. export from an unmanaged centralized vault. The export is performed by the agent installed on the managed machine you specify. The destination can be any location accessible to the agent, including a managed vault.
Tip. When configuring export to a deduplicating managed vault, choose a machine where th e deduplication add-on to the agent is installed. Oth erwise the export task will fail.
Operations with an export task An export task starts immediately after you complete its configuration. An export task can be stopped or deleted in the same way as any other task. Once the export task is completed, you can run it again at any time. Before doing so, delete the archive that resulted from the previous task run if the archive still exists in the destination vault. Otherwise the task will fail. You cannot edit an export task to specify another name for the destination archive (this is a limitation).
Tip. You can implement the staging scenario manually, by regularly running the a rchive deletion task follo wed by the export task.
Different ways to create an export task Using the Export page is the most general way to create an export task. Here, you can export any backup, or archive you have permission to access. You can access the Export page from the Vaults view. Right-click the object to export (archive or backup) and select Export from the context menu. The Export page will be opened with the preselected object as a source. All you need to do is to select a destination and (optionally) provide a name for the task.
General
Task name [Optional] Enter a unique name for the task. A conscious name lets you quickly identify the task among the others. Task credentials (p. 227) [Optional] The export task will run on behalf of the user who is creating the task. You can change the task credentials if necessary. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
What to export
Export Select an object to export: Archive (p. 202) - in that case, you need to specify the archive only. Backups (p. 228) - specify the archive first, and then select the desired backup(s) in this archive Access credentials (p. 228) [Optional] Provide credentials for accessing the source if the task account does not have enough privileges to access it. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
226
Where to export
Archive (p. 229) Enter the path to the location where the new archive will be created. Be sure to provide a distinct name and comment for the new archive. Access credentials (p. 230) [Optional] Provide credentials for the destination if the task credentials do not have enough privileges to access it. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box. After you have performed all the required steps, click OK to start the export task.
6.7.1
Task credentials
Provide credentials for the account under which the task will run.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Run under the current user The task will run under the credentials with which the user who starts the tasks is logged on. If the task has to run on schedule, you will be asked for the current user's password on completing the task creation. Use the following credentials The task will always run under the credentials you specify, whether started manually or executed on schedule. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
Password. The password for the account. 2. Click OK. To learn more about using credentials in Acronis Backup & Recovery 10, see the Owners and credentials (p. 30) section. To learn more about operations available depending on the user privileges, see the User privileges on a managed machine (p. 30) section.
6.7.2
Archive selection
To select an archive
1. Enter the full path to the location in the Path field, or select the desired folder in the folders tree. If the archive is stored in a centralized vault, expand the Centralized group and click the vault.
If the archive is stored in a personal vault, expand the Personal group and click the vault. If the archive is stored in a local folder on the machine, expand the Local folders group and click the required folder.
If the a rchive is located on removable media, e.g. DVDs, first insert the last DVD and then insert the discs in order starting fro m the first one wh en the p rogram p rompts.
227
If the archive is stored on a network share, expand the Network folders group, then select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder. If the network share requires access credentials, the program will ask for them.
Note fo r Linux users: To sp ecify a Common Intern et File System (CIFS) netwo rk share which is mounted on a mount point such as /mnt/share, select this mount point instead of the n etwork sha re itself.
If the archive is stored on an FTP or SFTP server, type the server name or address in the Path field as follows: ftp://ftp_server:port _number or sftp://sftp_server:port number If the port number is not specified, port 21 is used for FTP and port 22 is used for SFTP. After entering access credentials, the folders on the server become available. Click the appropriate folder on the server. You can access the server as an anonymous user if the server enables such access. To do so, click Use anonymous access instead of entering credentials.
According to the original FTP specifica tion, cred entials required for a ccess to FTP servers are transferred through a netwo rk as plaintext. This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer.
If the archive is stored on a locally attached tape device, expand the Tape drives group, then click the required device. For the management server: in the folders tree, select the managed vault. 2. In the table to the right of the tree, select the archive. The table displays the names of the archives contained in each vault/folder you select. If the archive is password-protected, provide the password. While you are reviewing the location content, archives can be added, deleted or modified by another user or by the program itself according to scheduled operations. Use the Refresh button to refresh the list of archives. 3. Click OK.
6.7.3
Backup selection
6.7.4
Specify credentials required for access to the location where the source archive (or the backup) is stored.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
228
Use the task credentials The program will access the location using the credentials of the task account specified in the General section. Use the following credentials
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
The program will access the location using the credentials you specify. Use this option if the task account does not have access permissions to the location. You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node vault. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
6.7.5
Location selection
Specify a destination where the exported object will be stored. Exporting backups to the same archive is not allowed.
To export data to a centralized unmanaged vault, expand the Centralized vaults group and click the vault. To export data to a personal vault, expand the Personal vaults group and click the vault. To export data to a local folder on the machine, expand the Local folders group and click the required folder. To export data to a network share, expand the Network folders group, select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder. If the network share requires access credentials, the program will ask for them.
Note for Linux users: To specify a Common Internet File System (CIFS) network share which is mounted on a mount point such as /mnt/share, select this mount point instead of the n etwork sha re itself.
To export data to an FTP or SFTP server, type the server name or address in the Path field as follows: ftp://ftp_server:port _number or sftp://sftp_server:port number If the port number is not specified, port 21 is used for FTP and port 22 is used for SFTP. After entering access credentials, the folders on the server become available. Click the appropriate folder on the server. You can access the server as an anonymous user if the server enables such access. To do so, click Use anonymous access instead of entering credentials.
According to the original FTP specifica tion, cred entials required for a ccess to FTP servers are transferred through a netwo rk as plaintext. This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer.
To export data to a locally attached tape device, expand the Tape drives group, then click the required device. Local folders group to export data onto the hard drives that are local to the storage node.
229
Network folders group to export data to a network share. If the network share requires access credentials, the program will ask for them.
Note fo r Linux users: To sp ecify a Common Intern et File System (CIFS) netwo rk share which is mounted on a mount point such as /mnt/share, select this mount point instead of the n etwork sha re itself.
exporting part of an archive to the same location exporting an archive or part of an archive to a location where an archive of the same name exists exporting an archive or part of an archive to the same location twice
In any of the above cases, provide an archive name that is unique to the destination folder or vault. If you need to redo the export using the same archive name, first delete the archive that resulted from the previous export operation.
6.7.6
Specify credentials required for access to the location where the resulting archive will be stored. The user whose name is specified will be considered as the archive owner.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Use the task credentials The program will access the location using the credentials of the task account specified in the General section. Use the following credentials The program will access the location using the credentials you specify. Use this option if the task account does not have access permissions to the location. You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node vault. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
230
6.8
Acronis Secure Zone is a secure partition that enables keeping backup archives on a managed machine disk space and therefore recovery of a disk to the same disk where the backup resides. Certain Windows applications, such as Acronis disk management tools, can access the zone. To learn more about the advantages and limitations of the Acronis Secure Zone, see the Acronis Secure Zone (p. 44) topic in the "Proprietary Acronis technologies" section.
6.8.1
You can create Acronis Secure Zone while the operating system is running or using bootable media.
Space
Disk (p. 231) Choose a hard disk (if several) on which to create the zone. Acronis Secure Zone is created using unallocated space, if available, or at the expense of the volume's free space. Size (p. 232) Specify the exact size of the zone. Moving or resizing of locked volumes, such as the volume containing the currently active operating system, requires a reboot.
Settings
Password (p. 232) [Optional] Protect the Acronis Secure Zone from unauthorized access with a password. The prompt for the password appear at any operation relating to the zone. After you configure the required settings, click OK. In the Result confirmation (p. 232) window, review the expected layout and click OK to start creating the zone.
231
Moving or resizing of the volume from which the system is currently booted will require a reboot. Taking all free space from a system volume may cause the operating system to work unstably and even fail to start. Do not set the maximum zone size if the boot or the system volume is selected.
To set up a password
1. 2. 3. 4. Choose Use password. In the Enter the password field, type a new password. In the Confirm the password field, re-type the password. Click OK.
To disable password
1. Choose Do not use. 2. Click OK.
Result confirmation
The Result confirmation window displays the expected partition layout according to the settings you have chosen. Click OK, if you are satisfied with the layout and the Acronis Secure Zone creation will start.
Acronis Secure Zone is always created at the end of the hard disk. When calculating the final layout of the volumes, the program will first use unallocated space at the end. If there is no or not enough unallocated space at the end of the disk, but there is unallocated space between volumes, the volumes will be moved to add more unallocated space to the end. When all unallocated space is collected but it is still not enough, the program will take free space from the volumes you select, proportionally reducing the volumes' size. Resizing of locked volumes requires a reboot. However, there should be free space on a volume, so that the operating system and applications can operate; for example, for creating temporary files. The program will not decrease a volume where free space is or becomes less than 25% of the total volume size. Only when all volumes on the disk have 25% or less free space, will the program continue decreasing the volumes proportionally.
232
As is apparent from the above, setting the maximum possible zone size is not advisable. You will end up with no free space on any volume which might cause the operating system or applications to work unstably and even fail to start.
6.8.2
Acronis Secure Zone is considered as a personal vault (p. 359). Once created on a managed machine, the zone is always present in the list of Personal vaults. Centralized backup plans can use Acronis Secure Zone as well as local plans. If you have used the Acronis Secure Zone before, please note a radical change in the zone functionality. The zone does not perform automatic cleanup, that is, deleting old archives, anymore. Use backup schemes with automatic cleanup to back up to the zone, or delete outdated archives manually using the vault management functionality. With the new Acronis Secure Zone behavior, you obtain the ability to:
list archives located in the zone and backups included in each archive examine backup content mount a volume backup to copy files from the backup to a physical disk safely delete archives and backups from the archives.
To learn more about operations with vaults, see the Vaults (p. 115) section.
dragging the slider and selecting any size between the current and maximum values. The maximum size is equal to the disks unallocated space plus the total free space of all selected partitions;
typing an exact value in the Acronis Secure Zone Size field. When increasing the size of the zone, the program will act as follows:
first, it will use the unallocated space. Volumes will be moved, if necessary, but not resized. Moving of locked volumes requires a reboot. If there is not enough unallocated space, the program will take free space from the selected volumes, proportionally reducing the volumes' size. Resizing of locked partitions requires a reboot.
Reducing a system volu me to the minimum size might p reven t the machin e's opera ting system from booting.
4. Click OK.
dragging the slider and selecting any size between the current and minimum values. The minimum size is approximately 50MB, depending on the geometry of the hard disk;
typing an exact value in the Acronis Secure Zone Size field. 4. Click OK.
6.9
Acronis Startup Recovery Manager is a modification of the bootable agent (p. 349), residing on the system disk in Windows, or on the /boot partition in Linux and configured to start at boot time on pressing F11. It eliminates the need for a separate media or network connection to start the bootable rescue utility.
Activate
Enables the boot time prompt "Press F11 for Acronis Startup Recovery Manager" (if you do not have the GRUB boot loader) or adds the "Acronis Startup Recovery Manager" item to GRUB's menu (if you have GRUB). If the system fails to boot, you will be able to start the bootable rescue utility, by pressing F11 or by selecting it from the menu, respectively.
The system disk (or, the /boot pa rtition in Linux) should have at least 70 MB of free spa ce to activa te Acronis Startup Recovery Manager.
Unless you use the GRUB boot loader and it is installed in the Master Boot Record (MBR), Acronis Startup Recovery Manager activation overwrites the MBR with its own boot code. Thus, you may need to reactivate third-party boot loaders, if they are installed. Under Linux, when using a boot loader other than GRUB (such as LILO), consider installing it to a Linux root (or boot) partition boot record instead of the MBR before activating ASRM. Otherwise, reconfigure the boot loader manually after the activation.
Do not activate
Disables boot time prompt "Press F11 for Acronis Startup Recovery Manager" (or the menu item in GRUB). If Acronis Startup Recovery Manager is not activated, you will need one of the following to recover the system when it fails to boot:
boot the machine from a separate bootable rescue media use network boot from Acronis PXE Server or Microsoft Remote Installation Services (RIS).
recover an operating system that cannot start access and back up the data that has survived in a corrupted system deploy an operating system on bare metal create basic or dynamic volumes on bare metal back up sector-by-sector a disk with an unsupported file system back up offline any data that cannot be backed up online because of restricted access, being permanently locked by the running applications or for any other reason.
A machine can be booted into the above environments either with physical media, or using the network boot from Acronis PXE Server, Windows Deployment Services (WDS) or Remote Installation Services (RIS). These servers with uploaded bootable components can be thought of as a kind of bootable media too. You can create bootable media or configure the PXE server or WDS/RIS using the same wizard.
Using Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 in Windows Preinstallation Environment provides more functionality than using Linux-based bootable media. Having booted PC-compatible hardware into WinPE, you can use not only Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent, but also PE commands and scripts and other plug-ins you've added to the PE. PE-based bootable media helps overcome some Linux-related bootable media issues such as support for certain RAID controllers or certain levels of RAID arrays only. Media based on PE 2.x, that is, Windows Vista or Windows Server 2008 kernel, allows for dynamic loading of the necessary device drivers.
235
6.10.1
To enable creating physical media, the machine must have a CD/DVD recording drive or allow a flash drive to be attached. To enable PXE or WDS/RIS configuration, the machine must have a network connection. Bootable Media Builder can also create an ISO image of a bootable disk to burn it later on a blank disk.
A media with Linux-style volume handling displays the volumes as, for example, hda1 and sdb2. It tries to reconstruct MD devices and logical (LVM) volumes before starting a recovery. A media with Windows-style volume handling displays the volumes as, for example, C: and D:. It provides access to dynamic (LDM) volumes.
The wizard will guide you through the necessary operations. Please refer to Linux-based bootable media (p. 237) for details.
Windows XP Professional with Service Pack 2 (PE 1.5) Windows Server 2003 with Service Pack 1 (PE 1.6) Windows Vista (PE 2.0) Windows Vista SP1 and Windows Server 2008 (PE 2.1) Windows 7 (PE 3.0)
If you already have media with PE1.x distribution, unpack the media ISO to a local folder and start the Bootable Media Builder either from the management console, by selecting Tools > Create Bootable Media or, as a separate component. The wizard will guide you through the necessary operations. Please refer to Adding the Acronis Plug-in to WinPE 1.x (p. 241) for details. To be able to create or modify PE 2.x or 3.0 images, install Bootable Media Builder on a machine where Windows Automated Installation Kit (AIK) is installed. The further operations are described in the Adding the Acronis Plug-in to WinPE 2.x or 3.0 (p. 241) section. If you do not have a machine with WAIK, prepare as follows: 1. Download and install Windows Automated Installation Kit (WAIK). Automated Installation Kit (AIK) for Windows Vista (PE 2.0): http://www.microsoft.com/Downloads/details.aspx?familyid=C7D4BC6D-15F3-4284-9123679830D629F2&displaylang=en Automated Installation Kit (AIK) for Windows Vista SP1 and Windows Server 2008 (PE 2.1): http://www.microsoft.com/downloads/details.aspx?FamilyID=94bb6e34-d890-4932-81a55b50c657de08&DisplayLang=en Automated Installation Kit (AIK) for Windows 7 (PE 3.0): http://www.microsoft.com/downloads/details.aspx?familyid=696DD665-9F76-4177-A81139C26D3B3B34&displaylang=en 2. [optional] Burn the WAIK to DVD or copy to a flash drive.
236 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
3. Install the Microsoft .NET Framework v.2.0 from this kit (NETFXx86 or NETFXx64, depending on your hardware.) 4. Install Microsoft Core XML (MSXML) 5.0 or 6.0 Parser from this kit. 5. Install Windows AIK from this kit. 6. Install Bootable Media Builder on the same machine. It is recommended that you familiarize yourself with the help documentation supplied with Windows AIK. To access the documentation, select Microsoft Windows AIK -> Documentation from the start menu.
Using Bart PE
You can create a Bart PE image with Acronis Plug-in using the Bart PE Builder. Please refer to Building Bart PE with Acronis Plug-in from Windows distribution (p. 243) for details.
If not configured, the Acronis loader waits for someone to select whether to boot the operating system (if present) or the Acronis component.
If you set, say, 10 sec. for the bootable agent, the agent will launch 10 seconds after the menu is displayed. This enables unattended onsite operation when booting from a PXE server or WDS/RIS. 4. [optional] Remote logon settings: user name and password to be entered on the console side at connection to the agent. If you leave these fields empty, the connection will be enabled on typing any symbols in the prompt window. 5. [optional] Network settings (p. 239): TCP/IP settings to be assigned to the machine network adapters. 6. [optional] Network port (p. 240): the TCP port that the bootable agent listens for incoming connection. 7. The type of media to create. You can:
create CD, DVD or other bootable media such as removable USB flash drives if the hardware BIOS allows for boot from such media build an ISO image of a bootable disc to burn it later on a blank disc upload the selected components to Acronis PXE Server upload the selected components to a WDS/RIS.
237
8. [optional] Windows system drivers to be used by Acronis Universal Restore (p. 240). This window appears only if the Acronis Universal Restore add-on is installed and a media other than PXE or WDS/RIS is selected. 9. Path to the media ISO file or the name or IP and credentials for PXE or WDS/RIS.
Kernel parameters
This window lets you specify one or more parameters of the Linux kernel. They will be automatically applied when the bootable media starts. These parameters are typically used when experiencing problems while working with the bootable media. Normally, you can leave this field empty. You also can specify any of these parameters by pressing F11 while in the boot menu.
Parameters
When specifying multiple parameters, separate them with spaces. acpi=off Disables Advanced Configuration and Power Interface (ACPI). You may want to use this parameter when experiencing problems with a particular hardware configuration. noapic Disables Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller (APIC). You may want to use this parameter when experiencing problems with a particular hardware configuration. vga=ask Prompts for the video mode to be used by the bootable media's graphical user interface. Without the vga parameter, the video mode is detected automatically. vga=mode_number Specifies the video mode to be used by the bootable media's graphical user interface. The mode number is given by mode_number in the hexadecimal formatfor example: vga=0x318 Screen resolution and the number of colors corresponding to a mode number may be different on different machines. We recommend using the vga=ask parameter first to choose a value for mode_number. quiet Disables displaying of startup messages when the Linux kernel is loading, and starts the management console after the kernel is loaded. This parameter is implicitly specified when creating the bootable media, but you can remove this parameter while in the boot menu. Without this parameter, all startup messages will be displayed, followed by a command prompt. To start the management console from the command prompt, run the command: /bin/product nousb Disables loading of the USB (Universal Serial Bus) subsystem. nousb2 Disables USB 2.0 support. USB 1.1 devices still work with this parameter. This parameter allows you to use some USB drives in the USB 1.1 mode if they do not work in the USB 2.0 mode.
238
nodma Disables direct memory access (DMA) for all IDE hard disk drives. Prevents the kernel from freezing on some hardware. nofw Disables the FireWire (IEEE1394) interface support. nopcmcia Disables detection of PCMCIA hardware. nomouse Disables mouse support. module_name=off Disables the module whose name is given by module_name. For example, to disable the use of the SATA module, specify: sata_sis=off pci=bios Forces the use of PCI BIOS instead of accessing the hardware device directly. You may want to use this parameter if the machine has a non-standard PCI host bridge. pci=nobios Disables the use of PCI BIOS; only direct hardware access methods will be allowed. You may want to use this parameter when the bootable media fails to start, which may be caused by the BIOS. pci=biosirq Uses PCI BIOS calls to get the interrupt routing table. You may want to use this parameter if the kernel is unable to allocate interrupt requests (IRQs) or discover secondary PCI buses on the motherboard. These calls might not work properly on some machines. But this may be the only way to get the interrupt routing table.
Network settings
While creating Acronis bootable media, you have an option to pre-configure network connections that will be used by the bootable agent. The following parameters can be pre-configured:
Once the bootable agent starts on a machine, the configuration is applied to the machines network interface card (NIC.) If the settings have not been pre-configured, the agent uses DHCP auto configuration. You also have the ability to configure the network settings manually when the bootable agent is running on the machine.
239
customized. When you select an existing NIC in the wizard window, its settings are selected for saving on the media. The MAC address of each existing NIC is also saved on the media. You can change the settings, except for the MAC address; or configure the settings for a non-existent NIC, if need be. Once the bootable agent starts on the server, it retrieves the list of available NICs. This list is sorted by the slots the NICs occupy: the closest to the processor on top. The bootable agent assigns each known NIC the appropriate settings, identifying the NICs by their MAC addresses. After the NICs with known MAC addresses are configured, the remaining NICs are assigned the settings that you have made for non-existent NICs, starting from the upper nonassigned NIC. You can customize bootable media for any machine, and not only for the machine where the media is created. To do so, configure the NICs according to their slot order on that machine: NIC1 occupies the slot closest to the processor, NIC2 is in the next slot and so on. When the bootable agent starts on that machine, it will find no NICs with known MAC addresses and will configure the NICs in the same order as you did. Example The bootable agent could use one of the network adapters for communication with the management console through the production network. Automatic configuration could be done for this connection. Sizeable data for recovery could be transferred through the second NIC, included in the dedicated backup network by means of static TCP/IP settings.
Network port
While creating bootable media, you have an option to pre-configure the network port that the bootable agent listens for incoming connection. The choice is available between:
the default port the currently used port the new port (enter the port number).
If the port has not been pre-configured, the agent uses the default port number (9876.) This port is also used as default by the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console.
to search the media for the drivers that best fit the target hardware to get the mass-storage drivers that you explicitly specify from the media. This is necessary when the target hardware has a specific mass storage controller (such as a SCSI, RAID, or Fiber Channel adapter) for the hard disk.
240
The drivers will be placed in the visible Drivers folder on the bootable media. The drivers are not loaded into the target machine RAM, therefore, the media must stay inserted or connected throughout the Universal Restore operation. Adding drivers to bootable media is available on the condition that: 1. The Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Universal Restore add-on is installed on the machine where the bootable media is created AND 2. You are creating a removable media or its ISO or detachable media, such as a flash drive. Drivers cannot be uploaded on a PXE server or WDS/RIS. The drivers can be added to the list only in groups, by adding the INF files or folders containing such files. Selecting individual drivers from the INF files is not possible, but the media builder shows the file content for your information.
To add drivers:
1. Click Add and browse to the INF file or a folder that contains INF files. 2. Select the INF file or the folder. 3. Click OK. The drivers can be removed from the list only in groups, by removing INF files.
To remove drivers:
1. Select the INF file. 2. Click Remove.
Windows PE 2004 (1.5) (Windows XP Professional with Service Pack 2) Windows PE 2005 (1.6) (Windows Server 2003 with Service Pack 1). To add Acronis Plug-in to WinPE 1.x:
1. Unpack all files of your WinPE 1.x ISO to a separate folder on the hard disk. 2. Start the Bootable Media Builder either from the management console, by selecting Tools > Create Bootable Media or, as a separate component. 3. Select Bootable media type: Windows PE. 4. 5. 6. 7. Select Use WinPE files located in the folder I specify Specify path to the folder where the WinPE files are located. Specify the full path to the resulting ISO file including the file name. Check your settings in the summary screen and click Proceed. Burn the .ISO to CD or DVD using a third-party tool or copy to a flash drive.
Once a machine boots into the WinPE, Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 starts automatically.
Adding the Acronis Plug-in to the existing PE ISO. This comes in handy when you have to add the plug-in to the previously configured PE ISO that is already in use. Creating the PE ISO with the plug-in from scratch.
241
Adding the Acronis Plug-in to a WIM file for any future purpose (manual ISO building, adding other tools to the image and so on).
To be able to perform any of the above operations, install Bootable Media Builder on a machine where Windows Automated Installation Kit (WAIK) is installed. If you do not have such machine, prepare as described in How to create bootable media (p. 236).
Bootable Media Build er supports only x86 WinPE 2.x or 3.0. Th ese WnPE distributions can also work on x64 hardware. A PE image based on Win PE 2.0 requires at least 256MB RAM to wo rk. The reco mmended memo ry size for PE 2.0 is 512MB. A PE image based on Win PE 3.0 requires a t least 512MB RAM to work.
4.
5. 6. 7. 8.
Select Use WinPE files located in the folder I specify Specify path to the folder where the WinPE files are located. [optional] Specify Windows drivers to be added to Windows PE. Once you boot a machine into Windows PE, the drivers can help you access the device where the backup archive is located. Click Add and specify the path to the necessary *.inf file for a corresponding SCSI, RAID, SATA controller, network adapter, tape drive or other device. You will have to repeat this procedure for each driver you want to be included in the resulting WinPE boot media. Choose whether you want to create ISO or WIM image or upload the media on Acronis PXE Server. Specify the full path to the resulting image file including the file name, or specify the PXE server and provide the user name and password to access it. Check your settings in the summary screen and click Proceed. Burn the .ISO to CD or DVD using a third-party tool or copy to a flash drive.
Once a machine boots into WinPE, Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 starts automatically.
To create a PE image (ISO file) from the resulting WIM file: replace the default boot.wim file in your Windows PE folder with the newly created WIM file. For
the above example, type:
copy c:\AcronisMedia.wim c:\winpe_x86\ISO\sources\boot.wim
For more information on customizing Windows PE, see the Windows Preinstallation Environment Users Guide (Winpe.chm).
242
5. Copy the contents of the current folderby default: C:\Program Files\Acronis\Bootable Components\WinPEto the %BartPE folder%\plugins\Acronis. 6. Insert your Windows distribution CD if you do not have a copy of Windows installation files on the HDD. 7. Start the Bart PE builder. 8. Specify the path to the Windows installation files or Windows distribution CD. 9. Click Plugins and check whether the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 plug-in is enabled. Enable if disabled. 10. Specify the output folder and the full path to the resulting ISO file including the file name or the media to create. 11. Build the Bart PE. 12. Burn the ISO to CD or DVD (if this has not been done yet) or copy to a flash drive. Once the machine boots into the Bart PE and you configure the network connection, select Go -> System -> Storage -> Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 to start.
6.10.2
Once a machine boots from bootable media, the machine terminal displays a startup window with the IP address(es) obtained from DHCP or set according to the pre-configured values. Remote connection To connect to the machine remotely, select Connect -> Manage a remote machine in the console menu and specify one of the machine's IP addresses. Provide the user name and password if these have been configured when creating the bootable media. Local connection Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console is always present on the bootable media. Anyone who has physical access to the machine terminal can run the console and connect. Just click Run management console in the bootable agent startup window.
6.10.3
Operations on a machine booted with bootable media are very similar to backup and recovery under the operating system. The difference is as follows: 1. Disk letters seen under Windows-style bootable media might differ from the way Windows identifies drives. For example, the D: drive under the rescue utility might correspond to the E: drive in Windows.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 243
Be ca reful! To be on the safe side, it is advisable to assign unique names to the volumes.
2. The Linux-style bootable media shows local disks and volumes as unmounted (sda1, sda2...). 3. The Linux-style bootable media cannot write a backup to an NTFS-formatted volume. Switch to the Windows style if you need to do so. 4. You can switch the bootable media between the Windows style and the Linux style by selecting Tools > Change volume representation. 5. There is no Navigation tree in the media GUI. Use the Navigation menu item to navigate between views. 6. Tasks cannot be scheduled; in fact, tasks are not created at all. If you need to repeat the operation, configure it from scratch. 7. The log lifetime is limited to the current session. You can save the entire log or the filtered log entries to a file. 8. Centralized vaults are not displayed in the folder tree of the Archive window. To access a managed vault, type the following string in the Path field: bsp://node_address/vault_name/ To access an unmanaged centralized vault, type the full path to the vault's folder. After entering access credentials, you will see a list of archives located in the vault.
244
2. Click Configure iSCSI/NDAS devices (in a Linux-based media) or Run the iSCSI Setup (in a PEbased media). 3. Specify the IP address and port of the iSCSI device's host, and the name of the iSCSI initiator. 4. If the host requires authentication, specify the user name and password for it. 5. Click OK. 6. Select the iSCSI device from the list, and then click Connect. 7. If prompted, specify the user name and password to access the iSCSI device.
6.10.4
Linux-based bootable media contains the following commands and command line utilities, which you can use when running a command shell. To start the command shell, press CTRL+ALT+F2 while in the bootable media's management console.
245
dmesg dmraid e2fsck e2label echo egrep fdisk fsck fxload gawk gpm grep growisofs grub gunzip halt hexdump hotplug
lvm mdadm mkdir mke2fs mknod mkswap more mount mtx mv pccardctl ping pktsetup poweroff ps raidautorun readcd reboot
ssh sshd strace swapoff swapon sysinfo tar tune2fs udev udevinfo udevstart umount uuidgen vconfig vi zcat
6.10.5
To recover Linux Software RAID devices, known as MD devices, and/or devices created by Logical Volume Manager (LVM), known as logical volumes, you need to create the corresponding volume structure before starting the recovery. You can create the volume structure in either of the following ways:
Automatically in Linux-based bootable media by using the management console or a scriptsee Creating the volume structure automatically (p. 246). Manually by using the lvm utilitysee Creating the volume structure manually (p. 247).
246
If disk configuration has changed. An MD device or a logical volume resides on one or more disks, each of its own size. If you replaced any of these disks between backup and recoveryor if you are recovering the volumes to a different machinemake sure that the new disk configuration includes enough disks whose sizes are at least those of the original disks.
5. Return to the management console by pressing CTRL+ALT+F1, or by running the command: /bin/product 6. Click Recover, then specify the path to the archive and any other required parameters, and then click OK. If Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 could not create the volume structure (or if it is not present in the archive), create the structure manually.
247
6. If you previously mounted the backup by using the trueimagemnt utility, use this utility again to unmount the backup (see "Mounting backup volumes" later in this topic). 7. Return to the management console by pressing CTRL+ALT+F1, or by running the command: /bin/product (Do not reboot the machine at this point. Otherwise, you will have to create the volume structure again.) 8. Click Recover, then specify the path to the archive and any other required parameters, and then click OK.
Note: This procedu re does no t wo rk when connected to Acronis Ba ckup & Recovery 10 Bootable Agent remo tely, because the command shell is not available in this ca se.
Example
Suppose that you previously performed a disk backup of a machine with the following disk configuration:
The machine has two 1-gigabyte and two 2-gigabyte SCSI hard disks, mounted on /dev/sda, /dev/sdb, /dev/sdc, and /dev/sdd, respectively. The first and second pairs of hard disks are configured as two MD devices, both in the RAID-1 configuration, and are mounted on /dev/md0 and /dev/md1, respectively. A logical volume is based on the two MD devices and is mounted on /dev/my_volgroup/my_logvol.
Do the following to recover data from this archive. Step 1: Creating the volume structure 1. Boot the machine from a Linux-based bootable media. 2. In the management console, press CTRL+ALT+F2. 3. Run the following commands to create the MD devices:
mdadm --create /dev/md0 --level=1 --raid-devices=2 /dev/sd[ab] mdadm --create /dev/md1 --level=1 --raid-devices=2 /dev/sd[cd]
248
lvm pvcreate /dev/md0 /dev/md1 lvm vgcreate my_volgroup /dev/md0 /dev/md1 lvm vgdisplay
The output of the lvm vgdisplay command will contain lines similar to the following:
--- Volume group --VG Name my_volgroup ... VG Access read/write VG Status resizable ... VG Size 1.99 GB ... VG UUID 0qoQ4l-Vk7W-yDG3-uF1l-Q2AL-C0z0-vMeACu
5. Run the following command to create the logical volume; in the -L parameter, specify the size given by VG Size:
lvm lvcreate -L1.99G --name my_logvol my_volgroup
7. Press CTRL+ALT+F1 to return to the management console. Step 2: Starting the recovery In the management console, click Recover. In Archive, click Change and then specify the name of the archive. In Backup, click Change and then select the backup from which you want to recover data. In Data type, select Volumes. In Items to recover, select the check box next to my_volgroup-my_logvol. Under Where to recover, click Change, and then select the logical volume that you created in Step 1. Click the chevron buttons to expand the list of disks. 7. Click OK to start the recovery. For a complete list of commands and utilities that you can use in the bootable media environment, see List of commands and utilities available in Linux-based bootable media (p. 245). For detailed descriptions of the trueimagecmd and trueimagemnt utilities, see the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 command line reference. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
249
Num Idx Partition Flags Start Size ---- --- --------- ----- ----- --------Disk 1: Table 0 Disk 2: Table 0 ... Dynamic & GPT Volumes: DYN1 4 my_volgroup-my_logvol 12533760
You will need the volume's index, given in the Idx column, in the next step. 2. Use the --mount command, specifying the volume's index in the -i parameter. For example:
trueimagemnt --mount /mnt --filename smb://server/backups/linux_machine.tib -i 4
This command mounts the logical volume DYN1, whose index in the backup is 4, on the mount point /mnt.
To unmount a backup volume Use the --unmount command, specifying the volume's mount point as a parameter. For example:
trueimagemnt --unmount /mnt
6.10.6
Acronis PXE Server allows for booting machines to Acronis bootable components through the network. Network booting:
eliminates the need to have a technician onsite to install the bootable media into the system that must be booted during group operations, reduces the time required for booting multiple machines as compared to using physical bootable media.
Bootable components are uploaded to Acronis PXE Server using Acronis Bootable Media Builder. To upload bootable components, start the Bootable Media Builder (either from the management console, by selecting Tools > Create bootable media or as a separate component) and follow the step-by-step instructions described in the "Bootable Media Builder (p. 237)" section. Booting multiple machines from the Acronis PXE Server makes sense if there is a Dynamic Host Control Protocol (DHCP) server on your network. Then the network interfaces of the booted machines will automatically obtain IP addresses.
250
In some BIOS versions, you have to save changes to BIOS after enabling the network interface card so that the card appears in the list of boot devices. If the hardware has multiple network interface cards, make sure that the card supported by the BIOS has the network cable plugged in.
Sometimes after the volume has been backed up and its image placed into a safe storage, the machine disk configuration might change due to a HDD replacement or hardware loss. In such case with the help of Acronis Disk Director Lite, the user has the possibility to recreate the necessary disk configuration so that the volume image can be recovered exactly as it was or with any alteration of the disk or volume structure the user might consider necessary.
All operations on disks and volumes involve a certain risk of data damage. Opera tions on system, bootable or data volumes mu st be carried out very carefully to avoid potential p roblems with the booting p rocess or hard disk data storage. Operations with hard disks and volumes take a certain a mount of time, and any power loss, unin tentional turning off of the machine o r accidental p ressing of the Reset button during th e pro cedure could result in volume damage and data loss. All operations on volumes of dyn mic disks in Windows XP and Windows 2000 require Acronis Managed Ma chine Service to be run under an account with administra tor's rights.
Please take all necessary precautions (p. 252) to avoid possible data loss.
6.11.1
Basic precautions
To avoid any possible disk and volume structure damage or data loss, please take all necessary precautions and follow these simple rules: 1. Create a disk image of the disk on which volumes will be created or managed. Having your most important data backed up to another hard disk or CD will allow you to work on disk volumes being reassured that your data is safe.
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 is an extremely effective co mpreh ensive data backup and recovery solution . It crea tes a data o r disk backup copy stored in a comp ressed archive file that can be resto red in case of any acciden t.
2. Test your disk to make sure it is fully functional and does not contain bad sectors or file system errors. 3. Do not perform any disk/volume operations while running other software that has low-level disk access. Close these programs before running Acronis Disk Director Lite. With these simple precautions, you will protect yourself against accidental data loss.
6.11.2
You can run Acronis Disk Director Lite under Windows or start it from a bootable media.
252
6.11.3
On a machine with two or more operating systems, representation of disks and volumes depends on which operating system is currently running. A volume may have a different letter in different Windows operating systems. For example, volume E: might appear as D: or L: when you boot another Windows operating system installed on the same machine. (It is also possible that this volume will have the same letter E: under any Windows OS installed on the machine.) A dynamic disk created in one Windows operating system is considered as a Foreign Disk in another Windows operating system or might be unsupported by this operating system. When you need to perform a disk management operation on such machine, it is necessary to specify for which operating system the disk layout will be displayed and the disk management operation will be performed. The name of the currently selected operating system is shown on the console toolbar after The current disk layout is for:. Click the OS name to select another operating system in the Operating System Selection window. Under bootable media, this window appears after clicking Disk management. The disk layout will be displayed according to the operating system you select.
6.11.4
Acronis Disk Director Lite is controlled through the Disk management view of the console. The top part of the view contains a disks and volumes table enabling data sorting and columns customization and toolbar. The table presents the numbers of the disks, as well as assigned letter, label, type, capacity, free space size, used space size, file system, and status for each volume. The toolbar comprises of icons to launch the Undo, Redo and Commit actions intended for pending operations (p. 266). The graphic panel at the bottom of the view also graphically depicts all the disks and their volumes as rectangles with basic data on them (label, letter, size, status, type and file system). Both parts of the view also depict all unallocated disk space that can be used in volume creation.
From the volume or disk context menu (both in the table and the graphic panel) From the Disk management menu of the console From the Operations bar on the Actions and Tools pane
Note that th e list of available operations in the context menu, the Disk management menu, and the Operations bar depends on th e selected volume or disk type. The sa me is true for unallocated space a s well.
253
6.11.5
Disk operations
Acronis Disk Director Lite includes the following operations that can be performed on disks: Disk Initialization (p. 254) - initializes the new hardware added to the system Basic disk cloning (p. 254) - transfers complete data from the source basic MBR disk to the target Disk conversion: MBR to GPT (p. 256) - converts an MBR partition table to GPT Disk conversion: GPT to MBR (p. 257) - converts a GPT partition table to MBR Disk conversion: Basic to Dynamic (p. 257) - converts a basic disk to dynamic Disk conversion: Dynamic to Basic (p. 258) - converts a dynamic disk to basic
The full version of Acronis Disk Director will provide more tools and utilities for working with disks.
Acronis Disk Director Lite must obtain exclusive access to th e targ et disk. This means no other disk management utilities (like Windows Disk Management u tility) can access it at that time. If you receive a messag e sta ting that the disk cannot b e blocked , close the disk management applica tions that use this disk and start again. If you cannot determine which applications use th e disk, close them all.
Disk initialization
If you add any new disk to your machine, Acronis Disk Director Lite will notice the configuration change and scan the added disk to include it to the disk and volume list. If the disk is still not initialized or, possibly, has a file structure unknown to the machine system, that means that no programs can be installed on it and you will not be able to store any files there. Acronis Disk Director Lite will detect that the disk is unusable by the system and needs to be initialized. The Disk management view will show the newly detected hardware as a gray block with a grayed icon, thus indicating that the disk is unusable by the system.
254
case, the reason for the Clone basic disk operation can be summed up as the necessity to transfer all the source disk data to a target disk exactly as it is. Acronis Disk Director Lite allows the operation to be carried out to basic MBR disks only. To plan the Clone basic disk operation: 1. Select a disk you want to clone. 2. Select a disk as target for the cloning operation. 3. Select a cloning method and specify advanced options. The new volume structure will be graphically represented in the Disk management view immediately.
It is advisable that you deactivate A cronis Startup Recovery Manager (p. 346) (ASRM), if it is a ctive, befo re cloning a system disk. Oth erwise the cloned opera ting system might not boot. You can a ctivate the ASRM again after the cloning is completed. If dea ctiva tion is not possible, choose the As is method to clone th e disk.
(To finish the added operation you will have to commit (p. 266) it. Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them.)
You have the following two alternatives to retain system bootability on the target disk volume: 1. Copy NT signature to provide the target disk with the source disk NT signature matched with the Registry keys also copied on the target disk. 2. Leave NT signature to keep the old target disk signature and update the operating system according to the signature.
If you need more than 4 primary volumes on one disk. If you need additional disk reliability against any possible data damage. If you need to convert a basic MBR disk to basic GPT:
1. Select a basic MBR disk to convert to GPT.
256
2. Right-click on the selected volume, and then click Convert to GPT in the context menu. You will receive a warning window, stating that you are about to convert MBR into GPT. 3. By clicking OK, you'll add a pending operation of MBR to GPT disk conversion. (To finish the added operation you will have to commit (p. 266) it. Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them.)
Please note: A GPT-partitioned disk reserves the space in the end of th e partitioned area necessa ry for th e backup area, which stores copies of the GPT header and the partition table. If the disk is full and the volu me size cannot be automa tically decreased , the conversion operation of the MBR disk to GPT will fail. The opera tion is irreversible. If you have a prima ry volume, belonging to an MBR disk, and convert the disk first to GPT and then ba ck to MBR, the volume will b e logical and will not b e able to be used as a system volu me.
If you plan to install an OS that does not support GPT disks, the reverse conversion of the disk to MBR is also possible through the same menu items the name of the operation will be listed as Convert to MBR.
3. By clicking OK, you'll add a pending operation of GPT to MBR disk conversion. (To finish the added operation you will have to commit (p. 266) it. Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them.)
If you plan to use the disk as part of a dynamic disk group. If you want to achieve additional disk reliability for data storage.
257
Should you decide to revert your dynamic disks back to basic ones, e.g. if you want to start using an OS on your machine that does not support dynamic disks, you can convert your disks using the same menu items, though the operation now will be named Convert to basic.
In contrast to Windows Disk Manager the program ensures bootability of an offline operating system on the disk after the operation.
3. If you click OK in this warning window, the conversion will be performed immediately. After the conversion the last 8Mb of disk space is reserved for the future conversion of the disk from basic to dynamic.
258
In some cases the possible unallocated space and the proposed maximum volume size might differ (e.g. when the size of one mirror establishes the size of the other mirror, or the last 8Mb of disk space are reserved for the future conversion of the disk from basic to dynamic).
safe conversion of a dynamic disk to basic when it contains volumes with data for simple and mirrored volumes in multiboot systems, bootability of a system that was offline during the operation
Online The online status means that a disk is accessible in the read-write mode. This is the normal disk status. If you need a disk to be accessible in the read-only mode, select the disk and then change its status to offline by selecting Change disk status to offline from the Operations menu. Offline The offline status means that a disk is accessible in the read-only mode. To bring the selected offline disk back to online, select Change disk status to online from the Operations menu. If the disk has the offline status and the disk's name is Missing, this means that the disk cannot be located or identified by the operating system. It may be corrupted, disconnected, or powered off. For information on how to bring a disk that is offline and missing back online, please refer to the following Microsoft knowledge base article: http://technet.microsoft.com/enus/library/cc732026.aspx.
6.11.6
Volume operations
Acronis Disk Director Lite includes the following operations that can be performed on volumes: Create Volume (p. 260) - Creates a new volume with the help of the Create Volume Wizard. Delete Volume (p. 263) - Deletes the selected volume. Set Active (p. 264) - Sets the selected volume Active so that the machine will be able to boot with the OS installed there. Change Letter (p. 264) - Changes the selected volume letter Change Label (p. 265) - Changes the selected volume label Format Volume (p. 265) - Formats a volume giving it the necessary file system
259
The full version of Acronis Disk Director will provide more tools and utilities for working with volumes.
Acronis Disk Director Lite must obtain exclusive access to th e targ et volume. This means no other disk managemen t utilities (like Windows Disk Management utility) can access it at tha t time. If you receive a message stating that th e volume cannot be blocked, clo se th e disk management applications tha t use this volume and start again. If you can not d etermine which applications use the volu me, close them all.
Creating a volume
You might need a new volume to:
Recover a previously saved backup copy in the exactly as was configuration; Store collections of similar files separately for example, an MP3 collection or video files on a separate volume; Store backups (images) of other volumes/disks on a special volume; Install a new operating system (or swap file) on a new volume; Add new hardware to a machine.
In Acronis Disk Director Lite the tool for creating volumes is the Create volume Wizard.
Mirrored-Striped Volume A fault-tolerant volume, also sometimes called RAID 1+0, combining the advantage of the high I/O speed of the striped layout and redundancy of the mirror type. The evident disadvantage remains inherent with the mirror architecture - a low disk-to-volume size ratio. RAID-5 A fault-tolerant volume whose data is striped across an array of three or more disks. The disks do not need to be identical, but there must be equally sized blocks of unallocated space available on each disk in the volume. Parity (a calculated value that can be used to reconstruct data in case of failure) is also striped across the disk array. And it is always stored on a different disk than the data itself. If a physical disk fails, the portion of the RAID-5 volume that was on that failed disk can be re-created from the remaining data and the parity. A RAID-5 volume provides reliability and is able to overcome the physical disk size limitations with a higher than mirrored disk-tovolume size ratio.
You will obtain a brief description of every type of volume for better understanding of the advantages and limitations of each possible volume architecture.
If the current op erating system, installed on this machin e, does not support th e selected typ e of volume , you will receive th e appropria te wa rning. In this case the N ext button will be disabled and you will have to select another typ e of volume to proceed with th e new volu me crea tion.
After you click the Next button, you will proceed forward to the next wizard page: Select destination disks (p. 261).
261
Select a destination disk and specify the unallocated space to create the basic volume on. Select one or more destination disks to create the volume on. Select two destination disks to create the volume on. Select two or more destination disks to create the volume on. Select three destination disks to create the volume on.
To create a Simple/Spanned volume: To create a Mirrored volume: To create a Striped volume: To create a RAID-5 volume: After you choose the disks, the wizard will calculate the maximum size of the resulting volume, depending on the size of the unallocated space on the disks you chose and the requirements of the volume type you have previously decided upon. If you are creating a dynamic volume and select one or several basic disks, as its destination, you will receive a warning that the selected disk will be converted to dynamic automatically. If need be, you will be prompted to add the necessary number of disks to your selection, according to the chosen type of the future volume. If you click the Back button, you will be returned to the previous page: Select the type of volume being created (p. 261). If you click the Next button, you will proceed to the next page: Set the volume size (p. 262).
The wizard will prompt you to choose one of the Windows file systems: FAT16 (disabled, if the volume size has been set at more than 2 GB), FAT32 (disabled, if the volume size has been set at more than 2 TB), NTFS or to leave the volume Unformatted. In setting the cluster size you can choose between any number in the preset amount for each file system. Note, the program suggests the cluster size best suited to the volume with the chosen file system. If you are creating a basic volume, which can be made into a system volume, this page will be different, giving you the opportunity to select the volume Type Primary (Active Primary) or Logical. Typically Primary is selected to install an operating system to a volume. Select the Active (default) value if you want to install an operating system on this volume to boot at machine startup. If the Primary button is not selected, the Active option will be inactive. If the volume is intended for data storage, select Logical.
A Basic disk can contain up to four p rima ry volumes. If they already exist, the disk will have to be converted into dynamic, oth erwise o r Active and Primary options will b e disabled and you will only be able to select the Logical volume type. The warning message will advise you that an OS installed on this volume will not be bootable. If you use chara cters when setting a new volume label tha t are unsupported by th e cu rren tly installed opera tion system, you will get the appropria te warning and the Next button will be disabled. You will have to change the label to proceed with th e creation of the new volume.
If you click the Back button, you will be returned to the previous page: Set the volume size (p. 262). If you click the Finish button, you will complete the operation planning. To perform the planned operation click Commit in the toolbar, and then click Proceed in the Pending Operations window.
If you set a 64K cluster size for FAT16/FAT32 or on 8KB-64KB clu ster size for NTFS, Windows can mount the volume, but so me p rograms (e.g. Setup p rograms) might calcula te its disk space inco rrectly.
Delete volume
This version of Acronis Disk Director Lite has reduced functionality because it is mainly a tool for preparing bare-metal systems for recovering previously saved volume images. The features of resizing the existing volumes and creating the new volumes, using free space from the existing ones, exist on the full version of the software, so with this version deleting an existing volume sometimes might be the only way to free the necessary disk space without changing the existing disk configuration. After a volume is deleted, its space is added to unallocated disk space. It can be used for creation of a new volume or to change another volume's type.
3. By clicking OK in the Delete volume window, you'll add the pending operation of volume deletion.
263
(To finish the added operation you will have to commit (p. 266) it. Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them.)
3. If another active volume is present in the system, you will receive the warning that the previous active volume will have to be set passive first. By clicking OK in the Warning window, you'll add the pending operation of setting active volume.
Please note: even if you have the Operating System on th e new active volume, in some cases th e ma chine will not be able to boot fro m it. You will have to confirm your decision to set th e new volu me as a ctive.
(To finish the added operation you will have to commit (p. 266) it. Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them.) The new volume structure will be graphically represented in the Disk management view immediately.
The new volume structure will be graphically represented in the Disk management view immediately.
264
(To finish the added operation you will have to commit (p. 266) it. Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them.) The new label will be graphically represented in the Disk Management view of the console immediately.
Format volume
You might want to format a volume if you want to change its file system:
to save additional space which is being lost due to the cluster size on the FAT16 or FAT32 file systems
as a quick and more or less reliable way of destroying data, residing in this volume If you want to format a volume:
1. Select a volume to format. 2. Right-click on the selected volume, and then click Format in the context menu. You will be forwarded to the Format Volume window, where you will be able to set the new file system options. You can choose one of the Windows file systems: FAT16 (disabled, if the Volume Size is more than 2 GB), FAT32 (disabled, if the Volume Size is more than 2 TB) or NTFS. In the text window you will be able to enter the volume label, if necessary: by default this window is empty. In setting the cluster size you can choose between any number in the preset amount for each file system. Note, the program suggests the cluster size best suited to the volume with the chosen file system. 3. If you click OK to proceed with the Format Volume operation, you'll add a pending operation of formatting a volume. (To finish the added operation you will have to commit (p. 266) it. Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them.) The new volume structure will be graphically represented in the Disk management view.
265
If you set a 64K cluster size for FAT16/FAT32 or an 8KB-64KB clu ster size for NTFS, Windows can mount the volume, but so me p rograms (e.g. Setup p rograms) might calcula te its disk space inco rrectly.
6.11.7
Pending operations
All operations, which were prepared by the user in manual mode or with the aid of a wizard, are considered pending until the user issues the specific command for the changes to be made permanent. Until then, Acronis Disk Director Lite will only demonstrate the new volume structure that will result from the operations that have been planned to be performed on disks and volumes. This approach enables you to control all planned operations, double-check the intended changes, and, if necessary, cancel operations before they are executed. To prevent you from performing any unintentional change on your disk, the program will first display the list of all pending operations. The Disk management view contains the toolbar with icons to launch the Undo, Redo and Commit actions intended for pending operations. These actions might also be launched from the Disk management menu of the console. All planned operations are added to the pending operation list. The Undo action lets you undo the latest operation in the list. While the list is not empty, this action is available. The Redo action lets you reinstate the last pending operation that was undone. The Commit action forwards you to the Pending Operations window, where you will be able to view the pending operation list. Clicking Proceed will launch their execution. You will not be able to undo any actions or operations after you choose the Proceed operation. You can also cancel the commitment by clicking Cancel. Then no changes will be done to the pending operation list. Quitting Acronis Disk Director Lite without committing the pending operations effectively cancels them, so if you try to exit Disk management without committing the pending operations, you will receive the appropriate warning.
266
7 Centralized management
This section covers operations that can be performed centrally by using the components for centralized management. The content of this section is only applicable to advanced editions of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10.
7.1
This section describes the views that are available through the navigation tree of the console connected to the management server, and explains how to work with each view.
7.1.1
Dashboard
Use the Dashboard to estimate at a glance the health of data protection on the registered machines. The Dashboard displays the summary of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agents' activities, lets you check for free space available in managed vaults, and rapidly identify and resolve any issues.
Alerts
The alerts section draws your attention to issues that have occurred on the management server and registered machines, in centralized vaults, and offers you ways of fixing or examining them. The most critical issues are displayed at the top. If there are no alerts or warnings at the moment, the system displays "No alerts or warnings".
Types of alerts
The table below illustrates the types of messages you may observe.
Description Failed tasks: X Offer View the tasks Resolve Comment View the tasks will open the Backup plans and Tasks view with failed tasks, where you can examine the reason of failure. When at least one task existing in the management server's database needs human interaction, the Dashboard shows an alert. Click Resolve... to open the Tasks Need Interaction window wher e you can examine every case and specify your decision. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent connects to Acronis License Server at the start and then every 15 days, as specified by the agent configuration parameters. The alert is displayed if the license check was unsuccessful on at least one agent. This might happen if the license server was unavailable, or the license key data was corrupted. Click View log to find out the cause of the unsuccessful check. If the license check does not succeed for 1-60 days (as specified by the agent configuration parameters), the agent will stop working until a successful license check. Vaults with low free space: X View vaults The alert is displayed if at least one centralized vault has
View log
267
less than 10% free space. View vaults will take you to the Centralized vaults (p. 117) view where you can examine the vault size, free space, content and take the necessary steps to increase the free space. Bootable media was not created Create now To be able to recover an operating system when the machine fails to boot, you must: 1. Back up the system volume (and the boot volume, if it is different) 2. Create at least one bootable media (p. 349). Create now will launch the Bootable Media Builder (p. 356). No backups have been created for X day(s) on Y machine(s) Show list The Dashboard warns you that no data was backed up on some of the registered machines for a period of time. To configure the length of time that is considered critical, select Options > Console options > Time-based alerts. View the machines The Dashboard warns you that no connection was established between some of the r egistered machines and the management server for a period of time, thus indicating that the machines might not be centrally managed. Click View the machines to open the Machines view with the list of machines filtered by the "Last connect" field. To configure the length of time that is considered critical, select Options > Console options > Time-based alerts. It is recommended to back up the management server to protect its configuration. Install the agent on the management server machine and add the machine to AMS. Install Acronis components Install Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows to back up the machine wher e the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server resides. Click Install now to launch the installation wizard.
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Back up now Management Server has not been backed up for X day(s)
The alert is displayed only if Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows is installed on the management server. The alert warns that no data was backed up on the management server for a period of time. Back up now will take you to the Create backup plan page where you can instantly configure and run the backup operation. To configure the length of time that is considered critical, select Options > Console options > Time-based alerts.
Activities
The stacked column chart lets you explore the daily history of the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agents' activities. The history is based on the log entries, collected from the registered machines and from the management server. The chart shows the number of log entries of each type (error, warning, information) for a particular day.
268
Statistics for the selected date are displayed to the right of the chart. All the statistics fields are interactive, i.e. if you click any field, the Log view will be opened with the log entries pre-filtered by this field. At the top of the chart, you can select the activities to display depending on the presence and severity of the errors. The Select current date link focuses selection to the current date.
System view
The System view section shows summarized statistics of registered machines, tasks, backup policies, and centralized backup plans. Click the items in these sections (except for centralized backup plans) to obtain the relevant information. This will take you to the appropriate view with pre-filtered machines, tasks, or backup policies respectively. For instance, if you click Idle under Tasks, the Tasks view will be opened with tasks filtered by the Idle state. Information presented in the System view section is refreshed every time the management server synchronizes with the machines. Information in other sections is refreshed every 10 minutes and every time you access the Dashboard.
Vaults
The Vaults section displays information about centralized managed vaults. You can sort vaults by name or by used space. In some cases information about free space in a vault might be not available, for example, if the vault is located on a tape library. If the vault itself is not available (offline), the "Vault is not available" message will be displayed.
7.1.2
Backup policies
To be able to manage and protect multiple machines as a whole, you can create a backup plan template called a "backup policy". By applying this template to a group of machines, you will deploy multiple backup plans with a single action. Backup policies exist only on the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server. You do not have to connect to each machine separately to check whether the data is successfully protected. Instead, check the cumulative status of the policy (p. 270) on all managed machines the policy is applied to. To find out whether a backup policy is currently being deployed, revoked, or updated, check the deployment state (p. 270) of the policy.
269
Click the Error hyperlink to see the log entry of the latest occurred error. Select the policy and click View tasks. Check the tasks that have Failed as their last result: select a task and then click View log. Select a log entry and then click View details. This approach comes in handy if the policy state is Deployed, that is, the policies' tasks already exist on the managed machines. Select the policy and click View log. Check the "error" log entries to find out the reason of the failure: select a log entry and then click View details. This approach comes in handy if the policy has errors while being deployed, revoked or updated.
In the Tasks view, apply the Last result -> Failed filter if th ere are too many tasks. You can also sort the failed tasks by backup plans or by machines.
270
In the Log view, apply the Error filter if there are too many log en tries. You can also sort the "erro r" entries by backup plans, managed entities o r machin es.
2. Once the reason of the failure is clear, do one or more of the following:
Remove the reason of the failure. After that, you may want to start the failed task manually to maintain the backup scheme consistency, for example, if the policy uses the GFS or Tower of Hanoi backup scheme. Edit the backup policy to prevent future failure.
Use the Activities section of th e Dashboard to quickly access the "error" log entries.
Click the Warning hyperlink to see the log entry of the latest warning. Select the policy and click View tasks. Check the tasks that have Succeeded with warnings as their last result: select a task and then click View log. This approach comes in handy if the policy state is Deployed, that is, the policies' tasks already exist on the managed machines. Select the policy and click View log. Check the "warning" log entries to find out the reason for the warnings : select a log entry and then click View details. This approach comes in handy if the policy has warnings while being deployed, revoked or updated.
In the Tasks view, apply the Last result -> Succeeded with warnings filter if th ere are too many tasks. You can also sort the tasks succeeded with wa rnings by backup plans or by ma chines. In the Log view, apply the Wa rning filter if th ere are too many log entries. You can also sort the "warning" entries by backup plans, managed entities o r ma chines.
2. Once the reason of the warning is clear you might want to perform actions to prevent future warnings or failure.
Use the Activities section of th e Dashboard to quickly access the "warning" log en tries.
The procedure of creating a backup policy is described in-depth in the Creating a backup policy (p. 326) section. Apply policy to machines Click Apply to. or groups In the Machines selection (p. 272) window, specify the machines (groups) the selected backup policy will be applied to. If the machine is currently offline, the policy will be deployed when the machine comes online again.
271
Edit a policy
Click
Edit.
Editing policies is performed in the same way as creating (p. 326). Once the policy is edited, the management server updates the policy on all machines the policy was deployed to. Delete a policy Click Delete.
As a result, the policy will be revoked from the machines it was deployed to and deleted from the management server. If the machine is currently offline, the policy will be revoked when the machine comes online again. View details of a policy or revoke a policy Click View details.
In the Policy details (p. 273) window, examine information on the selected policy. There, you can also revoke the policy from the machines or groups the policy is applied to. Click View tasks.
The Tasks (p. 299) view will display a list of the tasks related to the selected policy. View log of a policy Click View log.
The Log (p. 301) view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected policy. Refresh a list of policies Click Refresh.
The management console will update the list of backup policies from the management server with the most recent information. Though the list of policies is refreshed automatically based on events, the data may not be retrieved immediately from the management server due to some latency. Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed.
Machines selection
To apply the backup policy to machines or to groups of machines
1. Choose whether to apply the selected backup policy to
Groups In the group tree, select the group(s) the policy will be applied to. The right part of the window lists the machines of the selected group.
Individual machines In the group tree, select the required group. Then, in the right part of the window, select the machines to apply the backup policy to. 2. Click OK. The Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server will deploy the policy to the selected machines and machines belonging to the selected groups.
272
Type a policy's name / owner's name in the fields below the corresponding column's header. As a result you will see the list of the backup policies, whose names (or their owners' names) fully or just partly coincide with the entered value.
Filter backup policies by deployment state, status, source type, last result, schedule
In the field below the corresponding column's header, select the required value from the list.
Policy details
The Policy details window accumulates in five tabs all information on the selected backup policy and lets you perform operations with the machines and groups of machines the policy is applied to. This information is also duplicated on the Information pane.
Backup policy
The tab displays information about the selected policy.
Source
The tab displays information about the type of source to be backed up and the source selection rules.
Destination
The tab displays information about the backup destination.
Settings
The tab displays information about the backup scheme used by the policy and backup options that were modified against the default settings.
Applied to
The tab displays a list of machines and groups the selected policy is applied to. Actions
To View details of the machine (group). Do Click View details.
In the Machine details (p. 281)/Group details (p. 290) window, examine all information on the selected machine (or the selected group). Click View tasks.
The Tasks (p. 299) view will display a list of the tasks, pre-filtered by the selected
273
machine (group). View log of the machine (group) Click View log.
The Log (p. 301) view will display a list of the log entries, pre-filtered by the selected machine (group). Click Revoke.
The management server will revoke the policy from the selected machine or group of machines. The policy itself remains on the management server.
7.1.3
Physical machines
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 lets the administrator protect data and perform management operations on multiple machines. The administrator adds a machine to the management server using the machine's name or IP address, imports machines from Active Directory, or from text files. Once a machine is registered (p. 357) on the management server, it becomes available for grouping, applying backup policies and monitoring the activities related to data protection. To estimate whether the data is successfully protected on a managed machine, the management server administrator checks its status. A machine's status is defined as the most severe status of all backup plans (p. 169) (both local and centralized) existing on the machine and all backup policies (p. 270) applied to the machine. It can be "OK", "Warnings" or "Errors".
Groups
The management server administrator has the ability to group machines. A machine can be a member of more than one group. One or more nested groups can be created inside any group created by the administrator. Grouping helps organize data protection by the company departments, by the Active Directory domains or organizational units within a domain, by various populations of users, by the site locations, etc. The main goal of grouping is protection of multiple machines with one policy. Once a machine appears in a group, the policy applied to the group is applied to the machine and the new tasks are created by the policy on the machine. Once a machine is removed from a group, the policy applied to the group will be revoked from the machine and the tasks created by the policy will be removed. Built-in group - a group that always exists on a management server. The group cannot be deleted or renamed. A built-in group cannot include nested groups. A backup policy can be applied to a built-in group. The example of a built-in group is the All physical machines group, that contains all the machines registered on the management server. Custom groups - groups created manually by the management server administrator.
Static groups Static groups contain machines manually added to the group by the administrator. A static member remains in the group until the administrator removes the member from the group or deletes the corresponding managed machine from the management server. Dynamic groups Dynamic groups contain machines added automatically according to the criteria specified by the administrator. Once the criteria are specified, the management server starts to analyze the
274
existing machines' properties and will analyze every newly registered machine. The machine that meets a certain dynamic criterion will appear in all groups that use this dynamic criterion. To learn more about grouping machines, see the Grouping the registered machines (p. 53) section. To learn more about how policies are applied to machines and groups, see the Policies on machines and groups (p. 53) section.
Way of working with machines First, add machines to the management server. Adding machines is available, when selecting the
Physical machines view, or the All physical machines group in the Navigation tree.
Select the group the required machine is in, then select the machine. Use the toolbar's operational buttons to take actions on the machine (p. 277). Use the Information panel's tabs to view detailed information about the selected machine and perform additional operations, such as start/stop tasks, revoke policies, explore the policy inheritance, etc. The panel is collapsed by default. To expand the panel, click the chevron. The content of the panel is also duplicated in the Machine details (p. 281) window. Use filtering and sorting (p. 286) capabilities for easy browsing and examination of the machines in question.
Way of working with groups In the Physical machines view, select the group. Use the toolbar's operational buttons to perform actions on the selected group (p. 286). Use the Information panel's tabs to view detailed information about the selected group and
perform additional operations, such as revoke policies or explore policy inheritance. The panel is collapsed by default. To expand the panel, click the chevron. The content of the panel is also duplicated in the Group details (p. 290) window.
Actions on machines
Registering machines on the management server
Once the machine is added or imported to the All physical machines group, it becomes registered on the management server. Registered machines are available for deploying backup policies and for performing other centralized management operations. Registration provides a trusted relationship between the agent, residing on the machine, and the management server. Adding and importing actions are available when you select the All physical machines group in the navigation tree.
To Add a new machine to the management server Do Click Add a machine to AMS.
In the Add machine (p. 277) window, select the machine that needs to be added to the management server.
Import machines from Active Click Import machines from Active Directory. Directory In the Import machines from Active Directory (p. 278) window, specify the machines or organizational units whose machines you need to import to the management server. Import machines from a text Click file
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
275
In the Import machines from file (p. 280) window, browse for a .txt or .csv file, containing the names (or IP addresses) of machines to import to the management server.
The management console addresses to the agent and initiates the registration procedure. Because registration requires the agent's participation, it cannot take place when the machine is offline. An additional agent installed on a registered machine becomes registered on the same management server automatically. Multiple agents are jointly registered and deregistered.
Applying policies
To Apply a backup policy to a machine Do Click Apply backup policy.
In the Policy selection window, specify the backup policy you need to apply to the selected machine.
Grouping actions
To Create a custom static or dynamic group Do Click Create group.
In the Create group (p. 287) window, specify the required parameters of the group. The new group will be created in the group, the selected machine is a All physical machines group). member of (except for the built-in Click Add to another group.
In the Add to group (p. 280) window, specify the group to copy the selected machine to. The backup policies applied to the groups the machine is a member of will be applied to the machine.
For machines in custom groups Add machines to a static group Click Add machines to group.
In the Add machines to group (p. 280) window, select the machines that you need to add. Click Move to another group.
In the Move to group (p. 280) window, select the group to move the machine to. All the backup policies applied to the group the machine was in will be revoked. The backup policies applied to the group the machine is now a member of will be deployed to the machine.
Click
The backup policies applied to the group will be revoked from the machine automatically.
As a result, backup policies are revoked and shortcuts to centralized vaults are deleted from the machine. If the machine is not available at the moment, these
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
276
actions will be performed on the machine as soon as the machine becomes available to the management server.
Other actions
Direct management operations Create a backup plan on a machine Click Backup.
This operation is described in depth in the Creating a backup plan (p. 181) section. Click Recover.
Recover data
This operation is described in depth in the Recovering data (p. 199) section. Connect to a machine directly Click Connect directly.
Establishes a direct connection to the managed machine. Enables to administer a managed machine and perform all the direct management operations.
Other operations View detailed information on a machine View tasks existing on a machine View log entries of a machine Update all information related to the machine Click View details.
In the Machine details (p. 281) window, examine information on the machine. Click View tasks.
The Tasks (p. 299) view will display a list of the tasks, existing on the machine. Click View log.
The Log (p. 301) view will display a list of the machine's log entries. Click Synchronize.
The management server will query the machine and update the database with the most recent information. Along with synchronizing, the refresh operation will be performed automatically in order to update the list of the machines. Click Refresh.
The management console will update the list of machines from the management server with the most recent information. Though the list of machines is refreshed automatically based on events, the data may not be retrieved immediately from the management server due to some latency. Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed.
To add a machine
1. In the Navigation tree, select Physical machines. 2. Click Add a machine to AMS on the toolbar. 3. In the IP/Name field, enter the machine's name or its IP address, or click Browse... and browse the network for the machine.
277
Note for Virtual Edition users: When adding a VMware ESX/ESXi host, enter the IP of the virtual appliance running Acronis Ba ckup & Recovery 10 Agent for ESX/ESXi.
4. Specify the user name and password of a user who is a member of the Administrators group on the machine.
Note for Virtual Edition users: When adding a VMware ESX/ESXi host, specify the user na me and password for you r vCenter o r ESX/ESXi host.
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username.)
Password. The password for the account. Select the Save password check box to store the password for future connections. 5. Click OK.
3. In the Search for field, type the machine's (or the organizational unit) name, then click Search. You can use the asterisk (*) to substitute for zero or more characters in a machine (or an organizational unit) name. The left part of the window displays the machine (or organizational unit) names that fully or just partly coincide with the entered value. Click the item you want to add for import, then click Add>>. The item will be moved to the right part of the window. To add all the found items, click Add all>>.
If more than 1000 match es are found, only the first 1000 items will be displayed. In this case, it is reco mmended that you refine you r sea rch and try again.
The right part of the window displays the items you selected for import. If required, remove the erroneously selected items by using the respective Remove and Remove all buttons. 4. Click OK to start import.
278
Adds machines that are present in the list but are not registered Deletes registered machines not present in the list
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
Deletes and then tries again to add registered machines that are present in the list, but their current availability (p. 281) is Withdrawn.
As a result, only those physical machines that are listed in the file will be present in the All physical machines group.
The registration address of each machine can be found in the Registration address column in any management server view that contains the machine (the column is hidden by default). To avoid a discrepancy, you can initially import the machines from a text file. Modify this file later as required, by adding and removing machines, but do not change the names/addresses of the machines that have to remain registered.
where:
[path_to_the_file] is the path to a .txt or .csv file containing the list of machines. The tool does not accept spaces in the path name.
279
{username password} belong to a user who is a member of the Administrators group on all machines listed in the file. If not specified, the single sign-on mechanism is used to operate on all the machines.
280
Once the machines appear in the group, the policy that was applied to the group (if any), is deployed to the machines. If any of the selected machines is not available or reachable at the moment, the action will be kept in the management server as pending and will be performed as soon as the machine becomes available to the server.
Machine details
Accumulates in four tabs all information on the selected machine. Lets the management server administrator perform operations with the backup plans and tasks existing on the machine, and policies applied to the machine. This information is also duplicated on the Information panel.
Machine
The tab displays the following information on the registered machine:
Name - name of the selected machine (taken from the Computer name in Windows) IP address - IP address of the selected machine Status - the machine's status. Determined as the most severe status (p. 169) of all backup plans (both local and centralized) existing on the machine and backup policies (p. 270) applied to the machine. Last connect - how much time has passed since the management server last connected to the machine. Last successful backup - how much time has passed since the last successful backup. Availability: Online - the machine is available for the management server. This means that the management server's last connection to the machine was successful. Connection is established every 2 minutes.
Offline - the machine is unavailable for the management server: it is turned off, or its network cable is unplugged. Unknown - this status is displayed until the first connection between the management server and the machine is established after adding the machine or starting the management server's service. Withdrawn - the machine was registered on another management server, or the Standalone management parameter is selected in the Options > Machine options > Machine management (p. 82). As a result, it is not possible to control the machine from the current management server. However, you are able to regain control over the machine by specifying the management server address in the Machine management settings. Expired - the trial period of the machine's agent has expired. To specify a full license key, use the Change License functionality, or run the setup program and follow its instructions.
Installed agents - full name of Acronis agents, installed on the machine. Operating system - the operating system the machine's agent runs. Processor - the type of CPU used in the managed machine CPU clock - clock rate of the CPU RAM - memory size Comments - the machine's description (taken from the Computer description in Windows)
281
Backup policies
Displays a list of backup policies applied to the selected machine and lets the management server administrator perform the following operations:
To View details of a policy Do Click View details.
In the Policy details (p. 273) window, examine all information related to the selected backup policy. View tasks of a policy Click View tasks.
The Tasks (p. 299) view will display a list of the tasks related to the selected backup policy. View log of a policy Click View log.
The Log (p. 301) view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected backup policy. Revoke policy from the machine. Click Revoke.
The management server will revoke the policy from the machine. The policy itself remains on the management server. In case the machine is a member of a group and the policy is applied to the group, you cannot revoke the policy from a single machine without firstly removing the machine from the group.
Click
Explore inheritance.
The Inheritance order (p. 286) window will display the inheritance order of the policy appliied to the machine.
Filtering and sorting Filtering and sorting of the backup policies is performed in the same way as for the Backup policies view. See the Filtering and sorting backup policies (p. 272) section for details.
282
You will be taken to the Log (p. 179) view containing the list of the plan-related log entries. Task Click View log.
You will be taken to the Log (p. 179) view containing the list of the task-related log entries. Run a plan/task Backup plan Click Run.
In the Run Backup Plan (p. 176) window, select the task you need to run. Running the backup plan starts the selected task of that plan immediately in spite of its schedule and conditions. Task Click Run.
The task will be executed immediately in spite of its schedule and conditions. Stop a plan/task Backup plan Click Stop.
Stopping the running backup plan stops all its tasks. Thus, all the task operations will be aborted. Task Click Stop.
What will happen if I stop the task? Generally, stopping the task aborts its operation (backup, recovery, validation, exporting, conversion, migration). The task enters the Stopping state first, then becomes Idle. The task schedule, if created, remains valid. To complete the operation you will have to run the task again.
recovery task (from the disk backup): The target volume will be deleted and its
space unallocated you will get the same result if the recovery is unsuccessful. To recover the "lost" volume, you will have to run the task once again.
recovery task (from the file backup): The aborted operation may cause
changes in the destination folder. Some files may be recovered, but some not, depending when you stopped the task. To recover all the files, you will have to run the task once again.
283
Edit a plan/task
Backup plan editing is performed in the same way as creation (p. 181), except for the following limitations: It is not always possible to change backup scheme properties if the created archive is not empty (i.e. contains backups). 1. It is not possible to change the scheme to Grandfather-Father-Son or Tower of Hanoi. 2. If the Tower of Hanoi scheme is used, it is not possible to change the number of levels. In all other cases the scheme can be changed, and should continue to operate as if the existing archives were created by a new scheme. For empty archives all changes are possible. Why can't I edit the ba ckup plan?
What will happen if I delete the ba ckup plan? The plan's deletion deletes all its tasks. Why can't I delete the backup plan?
284
Refresh table
Click
Refresh.
The management console will update the list of backup plans and tasks existing on the machine with the most recent information. Though the list is refreshed automatically based on events, the data may not be retrieved immediately from the managed machine, due to some latency. Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed.
Filtering and sorting Filtering and sorting of the backup policies is performed in the same way as in the Backup plans and tasks view for direct management. See the Filter and sort backup plans and tasks (p. 175) section for details.
Member of
This tab appears only if the selected machine is added to one or more custom groups and displays a list of the groups the machine is a member of. Operations
To View details of a group Do Click View details.
You will be taken to the Group details window, where you can examine all information related to this group. View tasks related to a group Click View tasks.
You will be taken to the Tasks view with pre-filtered tasks related to the selected backup group. View log related to a group Click View log.
This opens Log view with pre-filtered log entries of the selected group. Remove machine from a group. Click Remove.
The centralized plans, which were deployed to the parent group, will no longer affect this machine.
You can create a dynamic group based on the list of the hosted virtual machines. To do this, click Create a dynamic group. The created group will be accessible in the Virtual machines view (p. 292).
Inheritance order
The Inheritance order window lets you examine where the policy applied to the machine came from. The policy that was directly applied to the machine is displayed as follows: Machine name The policy that is applied on the machine through inheritance is displayed as in the following example: Group1 > Group2 > Group3 > Machine1 Group1 in the root contains Group2 to which the policy is applied directly. Group2, in turn, contains child Group3 that inherits the policy from the parent and applies the policy to Machine1 respectively. The machine (or group) to which the policy was applied directly is boldfaced and marked with an icon. All items are interactive, i.e. when you click on a machine or a group, its parent group view will be opened.
Actions on groups
Actions are available when you select the then click on a group. Physical machines view in the Navigation tree, and
286
Click
Create group.
In the Create group (p. 287) window, specify the required parameters of the group. Custom groups can be created in the root folder ( other custom groups. Physical m achines), or in
Click
In the Policy selection window, specify the backup policy you need to apply to the selected group. If ther e are child groups in the selected group, the backup policy will be applied to them as well. Click View details.
In the Group details (p. 290) window, examine information on the selected group. Click Rename.
In the Name column, type a new name for the selected group. Built-in groups cannot be renamed.
Click
Edit.
In the Edit group (p. 289) window, change the required parameters of the group. Move one custom group to another Click Move to.
In the Move to group (p. 289) window, specify a group that will be a new parent of the selected group. Click Delete.
Deletion of a parent group will delete its child groups as well. Backup policies applied to the parent group and inherited by its child groups will be revoked from all members of the deleted groups. The the policies that are directly applied to the members will remain. Refresh a list of groups Click Refresh.
The management console will update the list of groups from the management server with the most recent information. Though the list of groups is refreshed automatically based on events, the data may not be retrieved immediately from the management server due to some latency. Manual Refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed.
Operating system
287
All the machines running the selected operating system will be members of the dynamic group.
Organizational unit (p. 288) All the machines belonging to the specified organizational unit (OU) will be members of the dynamic group. IP address range All the machines whose IP addresses are within the specified IP range will be members of the dynamic group.
Listed in txt/csv file (p. 289) All the machines that are listed in the specified .txt or .csv file will be members of the dynamic group. 3. In the Comments field, enter a description of the created group. 4. Click OK.
the member changes so that it no longer meets the criteria the administrator changes the criteria so that the member no longer meets the criteria
There is no way to remove a machine from a dynamic group manually except for deleting the machine from the management server.
288
Select an organizational unit from the Active Directory tree by clicking Browse, or typing it manually. If the domain access credentials were not specified in the management server options, the program will ask you to provide them. The credentials will be saved in the Domain access credentials (p. 80) option. For example, suppose that the domain us.corp.example.com has OU1 (which is in the root), OU1 has OU2, and OU2 has OU3. And you need to add the machines of OU3. So, the criterion will be: OU=OU3, OU=OU2, OU=OU1 If OU3 has child containers and you also need to add the machines of those containers to the group, select the Include child containers check box.
289
Changing the type of group will result in its conversion. Any custom group can be converted to a dynamic group if it was static, and vice versa.
When converting a static group to dynamic, provide grouping criteria. All the members that exist in the static group that do not match the provided criteria will be removed from the dynamic group. When converting a dynamic group to static, two options are available either to leave the current content of the group or to empty the group.
Group details
Aggregates in two tabs all information on the selected group. Allows performing operations with the policies applied to the group. This information is also duplicated in the Information panel.
Group
Displays the following information on the group:
Name - name of the selected group Parent group (for subgroups only) - name of the parent group Machines - number of machines in the group Type - type of the group (static, or dynamic) Criteria (for dynamic groups only) - grouping criteria Comments - the group description (if specified)
Backup policies
Displays a list of backup policies related to the group and allows performing the following operations:
To View details of a policy Do Click View details.
In the Policy details (p. 273) window, examine all information related to the selected backup policy. View tasks of a policy Click View tasks.
The Tasks (p. 299) view will display a list of the tasks related to the selected backup policy. View log of a policy Click View log.
The Log (p. 301) view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected backup policy. Revoke a policy from the group. Click Revoke.
The management server revokes the policy from the group. While the changes are being transferred to the machines and the agents are deleting the backup plans, the policy state of the group is Revoking.The policy itself remains on the management server. Click Explore inheritance.
The Inheritance order (p. 291) window will display the inheritance order of the policy applied to the group.
290
Filtering and sorting Filtering and sorting of the backup policies is performed in the same way as for the Backup policies view. See the Filtering and sorting backup policies (p. 272) section for details.
Inheritance order
The Inheritance order window lets you examine where the policy applied to the group came from. The policy that is directly applied to the group is displayed as follows: Group name The following example illustrates how the policy that is applied on the group through inheritance is displayed. Group1 > Group2 > Group3 Group1 in the root contains Group2 to which the policy is applied directly. Group2, in turn, contains child Group3 that inherits the policy from the parent. The group to which the policy was applied directly is boldfaced and marked with an icon. All items are interactive, i.e. when you click on a group, its parent group view will be opened.
7.1.4
Virtual machines
You can centrally manage virtual machines using either of the following methods or both: Adding a virtual machine as a physical machine Install Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows or Agent for Linux on the virtual machine and register (p. 277) it on the management server. The machine will be treated as a physical one. You will be able to apply any backup policy to the machine, including policies that back up files. This approach comes in handy when:
the machine is not hosted on a virtualization server the virtualization product installed on the host server is not supported by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Advanced Server Virtual Edition you want to use pre/post backup or pre/post data capture commands on the machine you want to apply file backup policies to the machine.
Adding a virtual machine as a virtual machine On Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server, a machine is considered virtual if it can be backed up from the virtualization host without installing an agent on the machine. This is possible when using Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Advanced Server Virtual Edition. A virtual machine appears on the management server after registration of the virtualization server that hosts the machine, provided that Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent for virtual machines is installed on that server. Adding Hyper-V virtual machines 1. Integration services have to be installed in the guest systems. 2. Install Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper-V on the Hyper-V host. The agent is installed as an add-on to Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows.
291
3. Register (p. 277) the Hyper-V host on the management server. If the machine is already registered, skip this step. 4. The virtual machines hosted on the Hyper-V server appear in the All virtual machines group. Adding ESX/ESXi virtual machines 1. VMware Tools have to be installed in the guest systems. 2. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for ESX/ESXi is delivered as a virtual appliance. Do either of the following:
or
Deploy the agent (p. 294) to the ESX/ESXi server Install and configure the agent manually as described in "Installing ESX/ESXi virtual appliance" Add (p. 277) the virtual appliance to the management server as an ordinary physical machine
The virtual machines hosted on the ESX/ESXi server (except for the virtual appliance with the agent) appear in the All virtual machines group. Virtual machines added to the management server as virtual machines are present under the Virtual machines in the Navigation tree. This section describes available operations with these machines.
292
Using this criterion, you can create a dynamic group of virtual machines hosted on all registered Hyper-V (or ESX/ESXi, respectively) servers. Any machine added to the servers will appear in this group. Any machine deleted from the servers will disappear from this group.
Host/VA
Using this criterion, you can create a dynamic group of virtual machines hosted on a specified virtualization server or managed by the specified virtual appliance.
As a result, a group that has the same name as the vCenter Server appears on the management server under Virtual machines. For more information, please refer to "VMware vCenter integration (p. 81)."
The group that has the same name as the vCenter Server will be removed and the policies applied to this group or its child groups will be revoked. Virtual machines remain in the All virtual machines group and in other groups if their host is managed by Agent for ESX/ESXi. Policies applied to these groups or directly to the machines continue functioning on the machines. This way, by removing the integration you remove only the machines that are not manageable.
293
You can add a single host to the list by specifying its IP address or name. Provide a user name and password for every host you add to the list. A vCenter Server cannot be specified in this window. When you select a host or cluster where the agent is already installed, the right panel of the ESX Agent Deployment window displays: Update ESX agent on this host. Other settings are not available. If you only need the update, proceed directly to step 6. 4. [Optional] The agents' settings You can deploy Agents for ESX/ESXi with default settings or specify custom settings for any agent. The settings are as follows: Datastore: This is the datastore on the ESX/ESXi host where the virtual appliance will be stored. When deploying the agent onto a vCenter cluster, this is the datastore shared by all the servers included into the cluster. For more information, please see "Support for vCenter clusters (p. 295)". Network interface: This is the host's internal network the virtual appliance will be included in. If there are multiple networks on the host, the program selects the one that is more suitable for the agent operation and specifies this network as default. Only those networks that have a connection to the host's Service Console (or Management Network, in terms of the VMware Infrastructure) are available for selection. This is critical to the operation of the agent. The next setting appears differently, depending on how you are going to deploy the agent. When deploying through the vCenter server - The account that will be used for agent connection to the vCenter server. When deploying directly to the ESX/ESXi server - The account that will be used for agent connection to the ESX server.
294
The management server will use this account to establish a trusted relationship with the agent during registration. Centralized backup plans and recovery tasks, originating from the management server, will run under this account by default. This means the account must have the necessary privileges on the vCenter Server. By default, the software will use the account that you have already specified, either when configuring integration with the vCenter, or when getting access to the ESX/ESXi server. You have the option to specify credentials for a different account if need be. The virtual appliance's time zone will be set automatically according to the management server's time zone. You can change the time zone directly in the virtual appliance GUI as described in "Installing ESX/ESXi Virtual Appliance." Changing the account or network settings is also possible but is not recommended, unless it is absolutely necessary. 5. Licenses Click Provide license. When installing the trial product version, select Use the following trial license key and enter the trial license key. Deduplication is always enabled in the trial version. When installing the purchased product, select Use a license from the following Acronis License Server and specify the license server that has the appropriate number of licenses for Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Advanced Server Virtual Edition. You need one license for every host you selected. To be able to deduplicate backups, an agent needs a separately sold license for deduplication. If you have imported such licenses into the license server, you can select the Enable deduplication... check box to let the agents acquire these licenses. 6. Click Deploy ESX agent.
The VA can be deployed to either C or D. If there is no storage shared by all the servers, you can import the VA manually into any of the hosts. This will work, but backup performance will be far from optimal. After deployment, the agent virtual appliance can appear on any of the hosts included in the cluster, depending on how the load balancing is configured.
7.1.5
Storage nodes
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node helps you to optimize usage of various resources required for the enterprise data protection. This goal is achieved through organizing managed vaults (p. 355) that serve as dedicated storages of the enterprise backup archives. Storage node enables you to:
relieve managed machines of unnecessary CPU load by using the storage node-side cleanup (p. 357) and storage node-side validation (p. 358). drastically reduce backup traffic and storage space taken by the archives by using deduplication (p. 61). prevent access to the backup archives, even in case the storage medium is stolen or accessed by a malefactor, by using encrypted vaults (p. 354).
To learn more about Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node, see the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node (p. 18) section.
Storage nodes list with toolbar The toolbar lets you perform operations (p. 297) with the selected storage node. The list of storage nodes displays online and offline storage nodes added to the management server. It also informs you about the total number of backups and archives on the storage node. Information panel Contains the detailed information about the selected storage node and lets you manage the compacting task. The panel is collapsed by default. To expand the panel, click the chevron. The content of the pane is also duplicated in the Storage node details (p. 298) window.
296
For information about user rights on a storage node and in its managed vaults, see User rights on a storage node (p. 67). 3. Add (p. 298) the storage node to the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server. 4. Create a managed vault (p. 119): specify the path to the vault, select the storage node that will manage the vault and select the management operations such as deduplication or encryption. 5. Create a backup policy (p. 326) or a backup plan that will use the managed vault.
In the Add storage node (p. 298) window, specify the machine the storage node is installed on. Adding a storage node establishes a trusted relationship between the management server and the storage node, in the same way as when you add machines to the server. Once the storage node is added to the management server, you will be able to create managed vaults on the node.
Click
Remove.
Once the storage node is removed from the management server, the vaults being managed by the storage node disappear from the vault list (p. 115) and become unavailable for performing operations. All the plans and tasks that use these vaults will fail. All the databases and vaults of this storage node remain untouched. It is possible to add the previously removed storage node to the management server again. As a result, all the vaults managed by the storage node will appear in the vault list and become available once again for all the plans and tasks that used these vaults.
Create a centralized managed vault on the selected storage node Change the compacting task schedule
Click
Create vault.
The Cr eate managed vault page (p. 119) will be opened with the pre-selected storage node. Perform the remaining steps to create the vault. After deleting backups from deduplicating vaults, either manually or during cleanup, unreferenced data may appear in the deduplicating vaults and their databases. The compacting procedure deletes such data in order to free up more storage space. Only one compacting task is available per storage node. Click Reschedule compacting.
In the Schedule window, set up the schedule for the compacting procedure. Only the time events (daily (p. 153), weekly (p. 155), and monthly (p. 157) schedules) are available for setting up. The preset is: Start the task every 1 week on Sunday at 03:00:00 AM. Repeat once.
297
Click
View details.
In the Storage node details (p. 298) window (the content of which is duplicated on the Information panel), examine information about the storage node and the vaults managed by this node. You can also manage the compacting task: manually start and stop the task. Click Refresh.
The management console will update the list of storage nodes from the management server with the most recent information. Though the list of storage nodes is refreshed automatically based on events , the data may not be retrieved immediately from the management server due to some latency. Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed.
User name. When entering a name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain). The user account has to be a member of the Administrators group on the machine.
Password. The password for the account. Select the Save password check box to store the password for the account. 3. Click OK. Because registration requires the storage node's participation, it cannot take place when the machine is offline.
Name - the name of the machine where the storage node is installed IP - the IP address of the machine where the storage node is installed Availability: Unknown - this status is displayed until the first connection between the management server and the storage node is established after adding the storage node or starting the management server's service.
298
Online - the storage node is available for the management server. This means that the last management server's connection to the node was successful. Connection is established every 2 minutes. Offline - the storage node is unavailable. Withdrawn - the storage node was registered on another management server. As a result, it is not possible to control the node from the current management server.
Archives - the total number of archives stored in all the vaults managed by the storage node Backups - the total number of backups stored within the archives in all the vaults managed by the storage node.
Vaults
This tab displays a list of the vaults, managed by the storage node. To open a managed vault for detailed examination and to perform operations on it, select the vault, then click View vault (on the tab's toolbar). In the Centralized vault (p. 116) view, perform the required actions.
Services
This tab displays the compacting task scheduling parameters.
Service tasks
This tab lets the management server administrator manage the compacting task and review its parameters. Only one compacting task can exist on a storage node.
7.1.6
Tasks
The Tasks view lets you monitor and manage tasks existing on the registered machines. You can view tasks' details, their states and execution results, as well as run, stop and delete tasks. To find out what a task is currently doing on a machine, check the task execution state. The status of a task helps you to estimate whether the task is successfully accomplished. To learn more about task states and statuses, see the Task states (p. 170) and Task statuses (p. 171) sections.
Actions on tasks
The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with tasks.
To Create a new backup plan, or a task on a registered machine Do Click New, and select one of the following:
Backup plan (p. 181) Recovery task (p. 199) Validation task (p. 217)
Then, you have to specify the registered machine on which the selected task, or
299
View details. Click In the Tasks details (p. 176) window, examine all information related to the selected task. Click View log.
The Log (p. 301) view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected task. Run a t ask Click Run.
The task will be executed immediately in spite of its schedule. Stop a task Click Stop.
What will happen if I stop the task? Generally, stopping the task aborts its operation (backup, recovery, validation, exporting, conversion, migration). The task enters the Stopping state first, then becomes Idle. The task schedule, if created, remains valid. To complete the operation you will have to run the task over again.
recovery task (from the disk backup) : The target volume will be deleted and
its space unallocated the same result you will get if the recovery is unsuccessful. To recover the lost volume, you will have to run the task once again.
recovery task (from the file backup): The aborted operation may cause
changes in the destination folder. Some files may be recovered, but some not, depending on the period when you stopped the task. To recover all the files, you will have to run the task once again. Edit a task Click Edit.
300
Click
Refresh.
The management console will update the list of tasks existing on the machines with the most recent information. Though the list of tasks is refreshed automatically based on events, the data may not be retrieved immediately from the managed machine due to some latency. Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed.
7.1.7
Log
The Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 log stores the history of actions the software does on a machine or a user does on a machine using the software. For example, when a user edits a task, an entry is
301
added to the log. When the software executes a task, it adds multiple entries saying what it is currently doing.
The maximum number of entries stored in the centralized log is 50000. The maximum number of entries that can be displayed is 10000. In case the number of log entries is greater than 10000, use filtering and sorting capabilities to display the desired log entries in the table. You can also hide the unneeded columns and show the hidden ones. See the Filtering and sorting log entries (p. 303) section for details. Select the log entry (or log entries) to take action on it (them). See the Actions on log entries (p. 303) section for details. Use the Information panel to review the detailed information on the selected log entry. The panel is collapsed by default. To expand the panel, click the chevron. The content of the panel is also duplicated in the Log entry details (p. 304) window.
Ways to open the "Log" view with the pre-filtered log entries
Having selected items in other administration views (Dashboard, Machines, Backup policies, Tasks), you can open the Log view with already filtered log entries for the item in question. Thus, you do not have to configure filters in the log table by yourself.
View Dashboard Machines Backup policies Tasks Action In the calendar, right-click on any highlighted date, and then select View log. The Log view will appear with the list of the log entries already filtered by the date in question. Select a machine or a group of machines, then click View log. The Log view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected machine or group. Select a backup policy, then click View log. The Log view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected policy. Select a task, and then click View log. The Log view appears with the log entries belonging to the selected task.
302
non-contiguous: hold down CTRL and click the log entries one by one contiguous: select a single log entry, then hold down SHIFT and click another
entry. All the entries between the first and last selections will be selected too.
View a log entrys details 1. Select a log entry. 2. Do one of the following
Click
window.
3. In the opened window, specify a path and a name for the file. Save all the log entries to a file 1. Make sure, that the filters are not set. 2. Click Save All to File.
3. In the opened window, specify a path and a name for the file. Save all the filtered log entries to a file 1. Set filters to get a list of the log entries that satisfy the filtering criteria. 2. Click Save All to File.
3. In the opened window, specify a path and a name for the file. As a result, the log entries of that list will be saved. Delete all the log entries Click Clear Log.
All the log entries will be deleted from the log, and a new log entry will be created. It will contain information about who deleted the entries and when. Set up the logging level Click Configure logging level.
In the Logging level (p. 78) window, specify whether to collect log events from the registered machines to the centralized log.
303
Filter log entries by type Press or release the following toolbar buttons: to filter error messages to filter warning messages to filter information messages Filter log entries by the original backup plan or managed entity type Under the Backup plan (or Managed entity type) column header, select the backup plan or the type of managed entity from the list.
Filter log entries by task, Type the r equired value (task name, machine name, owner name, etc.) in the field below managed entity, the respective column header. machine, code, owner As a result you will see that the list of log entries fully or just partly coincide with the entered value. Sort log entries by date and time Click the column's header to sort the log entries in ascending order. Click it once again to sort the log entries in descending order.
304
Type - Type of event (Error; Warning; Information) Date - Date and time when the event took place Policy - The backup policy the event relates to (if any) Task - The task the event relates to (if any) Managed entity type - Type of managed entity where the event has occurred (if any) Managed entity - The name of the managed entity where the event has occurred (if any) Machine - The name of the machine where the event has occurred (if any) Code - Blank or the program error code if the event type is error. Error code is an integer number that may be used by Acronis support service to solve the problem. Module - Blank or the number of program module where an error was occurred. It is an integer number that may be used by Acronis support service to solve the problem. Owner - User name of the policy/backup plan owner (p. 30)
The log entry's details that you copy will have the following appearance:
7.1.8
Reporting
Reporting provides the management server administrator with detailed and well-structured information concerning the enterprise data protection operations. Reports can be used as an instrument for profound analysis of the whole backup infrastructure within a corporate network. The management server generates reports using statistics and logs which are collected from registered machines and are stored in the dedicated databases. Reports are generated based on report templates. The templates define the information to be included in the report and the way the information is represented. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server offers report templates for:
Registered machines Backup policies existing on the management server Local and centralized backup plans existing on the registered machines Local and centralized tasks existing on the registered machines Archives and backups stored in the centralized managed vaults Statistics about centralized managed vaults Task activities history
Reports about machines, backup policies, backup plans, tasks, and archives and backups contain information as of the current time. Reports about vaults' statistics and task activities are interval-based and provide historical information for the specified time interval that can last from days to years, depending on the amount of data kept in the databases.
Generating reports
To start generating a report, select a report template in the Reports view, and then click Generate on the toolbar. There are two types of report templates: customizable and predefined. In a customizable report template, you can specify which entries to include in the report, by using filters. A predefined report template is preset so that you can generate a report with one click.
305
The report will contain the information selected, grouped and sorted according to the template settings. The report appears in a separate interactive window that enables expanding and collapsing the tables. You can export the report to an XML file and open it later using Microsoft Excel or Microsoft Access.
Filters
Under Filters, choose which machines to include in the report. Only the machines that meet all filter criteria are included.
Machines: The list of machines. Select either physical machines or virtual machines. Status: The machine statusesOK, Warning, and/or Error. Last connection (physical machines only): The period within which the last connection between the machines and the management server occurred. Last successful backup: The period within which the last successful backup finished on each of the machines. Next backup: The period within which the next scheduled backup will start on each of the machines. Operating system: The operating systems that the machines run. IP address (physical machines only): The range for the latest-known IP addresses of the machines. Availability (physical machines only): The types of the machines' availabilityOnline or Offline.
With the default filter settings, the report includes all physical machines.
Report view
Under Report view, choose how the report will look:
Select whether to show all items in a single table or to group them by a particular column. Specify which table columns to show, and in which order. Specify how to sort the table.
Filters
Under Filters, choose which backup policies to include in the report. Only the backup policies that meet all filter criteria are included.
Backup policies: The list of backup policies. Source type: The type of data backed up under the backup policiesDisks/volumes and/or Files. Deployment state: The deployment states of the backup policiesfor example, Deployed. Status: The statuses of the backup policiesOK, Warning, and/or Error.
306
Schedule: The types of the backup policies' schedulesManual and/or Scheduled. Manual schedule means that the corresponding centralized backup plan runs only when you start it manually. Owner: The list of users who created the backup policies.
With the default filter settings, the report includes all backup policies.
Report view
Under Report view, choose how the report will look:
Select whether to show all items in a single table or to group them by a particular column. Specify which table columns to show, and in which order. Specify how to sort the table.
Filters
Under Filters, choose which backup plans to include in the report. Only the backup plans that meet all filter criteria are included.
Origin: The types of origin of the backup plansLocal and/or Centralized. Backup policies (available only for centralized backup plans): The backup policies on which the centralized backup plans are based. Machines: The list of machines on which the backup plans exist. Execution state: The execution states of the backup plansfor example, Running. Status: The statuses of the backup plansOK, Warning, and/or Error. Last finish time: The period within which the last backup finished under each of the backup plans. Schedule: The types of the backup plans' schedulesManual and/or Scheduled. Manual schedule means that a backup plan runs only when you start it manually. Owner: The list of users who created the backup plans.
With the default filter settings, the report includes all backup plans from all machines.
Report view
Under Report view, choose how the report will look:
Select whether to show all items in a single table or to group them by a particular column. Specify which table columns to show, and in which order. Specify how to sort the table.
307
Filters
Under Filters, choose which tasks to include in the report. Only the tasks that meet all filter criteria are included.
Origin: The types of origin of the tasksCentralized, Local, and/or Local without backup plan. A centralized task belongs to a centralized backup plan. A local task might not belong to a backup plan (for example, a recovery task). Backup policies (centralized tasks only): The backup policies on which the tasks are based. Machines: The list of machines on which the tasks exist. Type: The task typesfor example, disk backup tasks. Execution state: The execution states of the tasksfor example, Running. Last result: The last results of the tasksSucceeded, Succeeded with warnings, and/or Failed. Schedule: The types of the tasks' schedulesManual or Scheduled. Manual schedule means that a task runs only when you start it manually. Owner: The list of users who created the tasks. Duration: The limits for the amount of time within which each of the tasks last ran.
With the default filter settings, the report includes all tasks from all machines.
Report view
Under Report view, choose how the report will look:
Select whether to show all items in a single table or to group them by a particular column. Specify which table columns to show, and in which order. Specify how to sort the table.
Filters
Under Filters, choose which archives to include in the report. Only the archives that meet all filter criteria are included.
Vaults: The list of centralized managed vaults that store the archives. Machines: The list of registered machines from which the archives were created. Type: The archive typesdisk-level archives and/or file-level archives. Owner: The list of users who created the archives. Creation time: The period within which the newest backup was created in each of the archives. Occupied space: The limits for the space occupied by each of the archives. Data backed up: The limits for the total size of data that is currently stored in each of the archives. This size may differ from the occupied space because of compression or deduplication. Number of backups: The limits for the number of backups that each of the archives contains.
With the default filter settings, the report includes all archives that are stored in the centralized managed vaults.
308
Report view
Under Report view, choose how the report will look:
Select whether to show all items in a single table or to group them by a particular column. Specify which table columns to show, and in which order. Specify how to sort the table.
Report coverage
Under Report coverage, choose the time interval for which you want to generate the report. The report will show the state of the selected vaults at the specified time on each day in the report period.
Filters
Under Filters, select which centralized managed vaults to include in the report, and whether to include information about the combined total of all the selected vaults. A combined total is the total free and occupied space, total amount of backed up data, total number of archives and backups, and average ratios across the selected vaults. With the default filter settings, the report includes information about all centralized managed vaults plus the combined total.
Report view
Under Report view, choose how the report will look:
Specify which table columns to show, and in which order. Select which diagrams to include in the report. The diagrams show space usage in the vaults.
Report coverage
Under Report coverage, choose the time interval for which you want to generate the report.
Filters
Under Filters, choose which tasks to include in the report. Only the tasks that meet all filter criteria are included.
Origin: The types of origin of the tasksCentralized, Local, and/or Local without backup plan. A centralized task belongs to a centralized backup plan. A local task might not belong to a backup plan (for example, a recovery task).
309
Backup policies (centralized tasks only): The backup policies on which the tasks are based. The default setting means all backup policies that ever existed during the report period. Machines: The list of machines on which the tasks exist. Type: The task typesfor example, disk backup tasks. Owner: The list of users who created the tasks.
With the default filter settings, the report includes all tasks that existed on the registered machines any time during the report period.
Column selection
In the Column Selection window, you can choose which table columns and to include in the report and in which order. The tables in the report will contain columns, from left to right, as listed in Display in report. The topmost column in the list will be the leftmost column in the report. When choosing the columns to display, use the left arrow and right arrow buttons to include or exclude columns, and the up arrow and down arrow buttons to change the order of columns. Some columnssuch as Machine name in a report about machinescannot be excluded from the list, or moved up or down in it.
Report view
In order for your web browser to correctly display dates and other information in generated reports, enable active content (JavaScript). You can allow active content to run temporarily for the currently displayed webpage, or enable it permanently. To allow active content to run temporarily in Internet Explorer, click the Information bar that appears at the top of the webpage by default, and then click Allow blocked content.
7.2
There are three ways to configure various parameters of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components in Windows:
310
By using the graphical user interface (GUI) By modifying the Windows registry
In Linux, instead of using the administrative template and modifying the registry, parameters are configured by editing the corresponding configuration files. If the values of any of these parameters set through the administrative template differ from those set through the graphical user interface, the template-based parameters take precedence and are effective immediately; the parameters shown in the GUI will be changed accordingly. The following subtopics describe each way of configuration and the parameters that can be configured through it.
7.2.1
The following are the parameters of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components that can be set by using Acronis Administrative Template. For information on how to apply the administrative template, see How to load Acronis Administrative Template (p. 311). The administrative template contains the configuration parameters of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent, Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server, and Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node, as described in the correspondent subtopics of this topic.
Once the template is loaded, you can open it and edit the desired settings. After loading the template or editing its settings, you should restart the configured component(s) or some of their services. For detailed information about Windows GPO Editor please see: http://msdn2.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa374163.aspx For detailed information about Group Policies please see:
311
http://msdn2.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa374177.aspx
Vault Warnings and Limits Specifies the amount of free space in a vault (both as an absolute value and as a percentage) below which a warning or error is recorded in the log. This parameter contains the following settings: Vault Free Space Warning Limit Description: Specifies the amount of free space in a managed vault, in megabytes, below which a warning is recorded in the storage node's log. Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value: 200 A vault's free space is the amount of free space on the mediumsuch as a disk volumethat stores the vault. When the amount of free space in a vault is equal to the value in Vault Free Space Warning Limit or less, a warning is recorded in the storage node's log, indicating the vault in question. You can view storage node warnings in the Dashboard. Vault Free Space Warning Percentage Description: Specifies the amount of free space in a managed vault, as a percentage of its total size, below which a warning is recorded in the storage node's log. Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 100 Default value: 10 The total size of a vault is the vault's free space plus the size of all archives that are contained in the vault. For example, suppose that two vaults, Vault A and Vault B, are both stored on a disk volume. Suppose further that the size of the archives in Vault A is 20 GB and the size of the archives in Vault B is 45 GB. If the volume has 5 GB of free space, then the total size of Vault A is 20 GB + 5 GB = 25 GB, and that of Vault B is 45 GB + 5 GB = 50 GB, regardless of the size of the volume. The percentage of free space in a vault is the vault's free space divided by the vault's total size. In the previous example, Vault A has 5 GB / 25 GB = 20% of free space, and Vault B has 5 GB / 50 GB = 10% of free space. When the percentage of free space in a vault is equal to the value in Vault Free Space Warning Percentage or less, a warning is recorded in the storage node's log, indicating the vault in question. You can view storage node warnings in the Dashboard.
Note: The parameters Vault Free Space Warning Limit and Vault Free Space Warning Percentage are independent of ea ch other: a warning will b e record ed every time that either of the thresholds is reached .
Vault Free Space Error Limit Description: Specifies the amount of free space in a managed vault, in megabytes, below which an error is recorded in the storage node's log and any backup to the vault becomes prohibited. Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value: 50 When the amount of free space in a vault is equal to the value in Vault Free Space Error Limit or less, an error is recorded in the storage node's log. Backups performed to the vault will keep failing until the vault's free space is above the limit. Vault Database Free Space Warning Limit
313
Description: Specifies the amount of free space, in megabytes, on the volume containing a managed vault's database, below which a warning is recorded in the storage node's log. Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value: 20 If the amount of free space on the volume containing a managed vault's database is less than the value in Vault Database Free Space Warning Limit, a warning is recorded in the storage node's log, indicating the vault in question. You can view storage node warnings in the Dashboard. The database is stored on the storage node in a local folder whose name is specified in Database path when creating the vault. Vault Database FreeSpace Error Limit Description: Specifies the amount of free space on the volume containing a managed vault's database, in megabytes, below which an error is recorded in the storage node's log and any backup to the vault becomes prohibited. Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value: 10 If the amount of free space on the disk containing a managed vault's database is less than the value of Vault Database Free Space Error Limit, an error is recorded in the storage node's log. Backups performed to the vault will keep failing until the amount of free space is above the limit. You can view storage node errors in the Dashboard. The database is stored on the storage node in a local folder whose name is specified in Database path when creating the vault.
314
Specifies how to clean up the centralized event log stored in the management server's reporting database. This parameter has the following settings: Max Size Description: Specifies the maximum size of the centralized event log, in kilobytes. Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value: 1048576 (that is, 1 GB) Percentage to Keep Description: Specifies the percentage of the maximum log size to keep on cleanup Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 100 Default value: 95 For details on how the centralized event log is cleaned up, see Log cleanup rules (p. 78). Windows Event Log Specifies when to record Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server's events into the Application event log in Windows. This parameter has two settings: Trace State Description: Specifies whether to record Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server's events into the event log. Possible values: True or False Default value: False Trace Level Description: Specifies the minimum level of severity of events to be recorded into the event log. Only events of levels greater than or equal to the value in Trace Level will be recorded. Possible values: 0 (Internal event), 1 (Debugging information), 2 (Information), 3 (Warning), 4 (Error), or 5 (Critical error) Default value: 4 (only errors and critical errors will be recordedif Trace State is set to True) SNMP Specifies the types of the management server's events to send notifications about by means of Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP). This parameter contains the following settings: Trace State Description: Specifies whether to send the SNMP notifications. Possible values: True or False Default value: False Trace Level Description: Specifies the minimum level of severity of events for sending SNMP notifications about them. Only notifications about events of levels greater than or equal to Trace Level will be sent. Possible values: 0 (Internal event), 1 (Debugging information), 2 (Information), 3 (Warning), 4 (Error), or 5 (Critical error) Default value: 4 (only errors and critical errors will be sentif Trace State is set to True) SNMP Address
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 315
Description: Specifies the network name or IP address of the SNMP server. Possible values: Any string 0 to 32765 characters long Default value: Empty string SNMP Community Description: Specifies the community name for the SNMP notifications. Possible values: Any string 0 to 32765 characters long Default value: public Synchronization Specifies how Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server connects to registered machines for deployment of centralized policies, retrieval of logs and backup plan states, and similar actionscollectively called synchronization. This parameter has the following settings: Maximum Connections Description: Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous synchronization connections to keep. Possible values: Any integer number between 1 and 500 Default value: 200 If the total number of online registered machines does not exceed the value in Maximum Connections, connections to those machines are always kept, and the management server periodically performs synchronization with each machine. Otherwise, it connects to a number of registered machines depending on the allotted number of simultaneous connections. After synchronization for a machine is complete, the management server may disconnect from that machine and use the free connection for synchronization with another machine, and so on. (Note: Connections to machines with high synchronization prioritysee Period-High Priority later in this topicare likely to be always kept.) Synchronization connections are unrelated to connections such as those between Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server and Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console. Maximum Workers Description: Specifies the maximum number of threads to use for synchronization. Possible values: Any integer number between 1 and 100 Default value: 30 The management server's process uses special threadscalled worker threads or workers to perform synchronization for a registered machine which is connected for synchronization. Each worker performs synchronization for exactly one machine at a time. A connected machine to be synchronized waits for an available worker. For this reason, the actual number of workers will never exceed the maximum number of connections (see Maximum Connections described previously). Period (in seconds) Description: Specifies how often, in seconds, to perform synchronization for machines that have a normal synchronization prioritytypically, the machines without currently running centralized backup tasks. Possible values: Any integer number between 120 and 2147483647
316
Default value: 120 Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server tries to perform synchronization for each normal-priority machine once in the number of seconds given by Period, by using an available worker thread (see Maximum Workers described previously). If there are fewer worker threads than normal-priority machines, the actual interval between synchronizations may be longer than the value of this parameter. Period-High Priority (in seconds) Description: Specifies how often, in seconds, to perform synchronization for machines that have a high synchronization prioritytypically, the machines with currently running centralized backup tasks. Possible values: Any integer number between 15 and 2147483647 Default value: 15 This parameter is analogous to the Period parameter described previously. Real-Time Monitoring Description: Specifies whether to perform real-time monitoring of registered machines instead of using a polling mechanism. Possible values: True or False Default value: False By default, Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server connects to registered machines to perform synchronizationin particular, to retrieve data such as backup logs. This approach is known as a polling mechanism. If Real Time Monitoring is set to True, the management server instead sends requests to machines to provide new data whenever it will appear, and then enters a listening mode. This approach is called real-time monitoring. Real-time monitoring may reduce network trafficfor example, when centralized backup tasks run infrequently. However, it is effective only when there are relatively few registered machines. Avoid enabling real-time monitoring if the number of registered machines exceeds the maximum number of simultaneous connections (see Maximum Connections earlier in this topic). Second Connection Attempt Description: Specifies whether to try to connect to a registered machine by using its lastknown IP address after an attempt to connect to it by using its host name has failed. Possible values: True or False Default value: False When connecting to a registered machine, Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server first uses the machine's network nameprovided that the machine was added to the management server by name. If Second Connection Attempt is set to True and a connection to the machine by using its network name has failed, the management server performs a second connection attempt, this time using the latest IP address which was associated with that network name. We recommend setting Second Connection Atempt to True only in networks which often experience problems with their DNS servers, and provided that the machines' IP addresses change infrequentlyas in cases of fixed IP addresses or long DHCP lease times. This setting has no effect on machines that were added to the management server by IP address.
317
Offline Period Threshold (in seconds) Description: Specifies the maximum interval, in seconds, between attempts to connect to a registered machine which appears to be offline. Possible values: Any integer number between 120 and 2147483647 Default value: 1800 Normally, the management server connects to each registered machine with a certain time interval (see Period and Period-High Priority earlier in this section). When the management server discovers that the machine is offline, it doubles this interval; it keeps doubling this interval on each further attempt until reaching the value specified in Offline Period Threshold. If the machine comes back online, the time interval becomes normal again. This approach aims at efficient use of the management server resources and reducing the network load. Backup Specifies the location and initial size of the snapshot storagea temporary file that is used when backing up data by taking a snapshot. This file is deleted as soon as the backup is complete. With the default settings, the snapshot storage is created in a Windows' temporary files folder and occupies 50 percent of the space available on the volume containing that folder. This size may then grow if more space is needed for the snapshot. You may want to increase the initial size of the snapshot storageor to place it on a different volumewhen experiencing problems with backing up data that changes extensively during backup. This parameter is used when creating a backup policy and applies to all centralized backup plans that will be based on this policy. Changes to this parameter do not affect already existing backup policies (and their centralized backup plans). This parameter has the following settings: Snapshot Storage Path Description: Specifies the folder in which to place the snapshot storage. Possible values: Any string 0 to 32765 characters long Default value: Empty string An empty string means a temporary files folder, which is typically given by the TMP or TEMP environment variable. You can specify a local folder on any volume, including a volume you are backing up. Snapshot Storage Absolute Size Description: Specifies the initial size of the snapshot storage, in megabytes. Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value: 0 If this setting is 0, the management server uses the Snapshot Storage Relative Size setting. The initial size will not exceed the available space minus 50 MB. Snapshot Storage Relative Size This setting is effective only when the Snapshot Storage Absolute Size setting is 0. Description: Specifies the initial size of the snapshot storage as a percentage of the disk space that is available at the time of starting the backup. Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 100 Default value: 50
318 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
If this setting is 0, the snapshot storage will not be created. The initial size will not exceed the available space minus 50 MB. Without the snapshot storage, taking snapshots is still possible. The size of the snapshot storage does not affect the size of the backup.
319
If the value is 0, no reconnection attempts will be performed; the agent will only check for the license as determined by License Check Interval. License Server Address Description: Specifies the network name or IP address of Acronis License Server. Possible values: Any string 0 to 32765 characters long Default value: Empty string Log Cleanup Rules Specifies how to clean up the agent log. This parameter has the following settings: Max Size Description: Specifies the maximum size of the agent log folder, in kilobytes. Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value: 1048576 (that is, 1 GB) Percentage To Keep Description: Specifies the percentage of the maximum log size to keep on cleanup. Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 100 Default value: 95 For details on how the agent log is cleaned up, see Log cleanup rules (p. 84). Windows Event Log Specifies when to record Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent's events into the Application event log in Windows. This parameter has two settings: Trace State Description: Specifies whether to record the agent's events into the event log. Possible values: True or False Default value: False Trace Level Description: Specifies the minimum level of severity of events to be recorded into the event log. Only events of levels greater than or equal to the value in Trace Level will be recorded. Possible values: 0 (Internal event), 1 (Debugging information), 2 (Information), 3 (Warning), 4 (Error), or 5 (Critical error) Default value: 4 (only errors and critical errors will be recordedif Trace State is set to True) SNMP Specifies the types of the agent's events to send notifications about by means of Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP). This parameter has the following settings: Trace State Description: Specifies whether to send the SNMP notifications. Possible values: True or False Default value: False Trace Level
320
Description: Specifies the minimum level of severity of events for sending SNMP notifications about them. Only notifications about events of levels greater than or equal to Trace Level will be sent. Possible values: 0 (Internal event), 1 (Debugging information), 2 (Information), 3 (Warning), 4 (Error), or 5 (Critical error) Default value: 4 (only errors and critical errors will be recordedif Trace State is set to True) SNMP Address Description: Specifies the network name or IP address of the SNMP server. Possible values: Any string 0 to 32765 characters long Default value: Empty string SNMP Community Description: Specifies the community name for the SNMP notifications. Possible values: Any string 0 to 32765 characters long Default value: public Backup Specifies the location and initial size of the snapshot storagea temporary file that is used when backing up data by taking a snapshot. This file is deleted as soon as the backup is complete. With the default settings, the snapshot storage is created in a Windows' temporary files folder and initially occupies 50 percent of the space available on the volume containing that folder. This size may then grow if more space is needed for the snapshot. You may want to increase the initial size of the snapshot storageor to place it on a different volumewhen experiencing problems with backing up data that changes extensively during backup. This parameter is used when creating a backup plan. Changes to this parameter do not affect already existing backup plans. This parameter has the following settings: Snapshot Storage Path Description: Specifies the folder in which to create the snapshot storage. Possible values: Any string 0 to 32765 characters long Default value: Empty string An empty string means a temporary files folder, which is typically given by the TMP or TEMP environment variable. You can specify a local folder on any volume, including a volume you are backing up. Snapshot Storage Absolute Size Description: Specifies the initial size of the snapshot storage, in megabytes. Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value: 0 If this setting is 0, the management server uses the Snapshot Storage Relative Size setting. The initial size will not exceed the available space minus 50 MB. Snapshot Storage Relative Size This setting is effective only when the Snapshot Storage Absolute Size setting is 0. Description: Specifies the initial size of the snapshot storage as a percentage of the disk space that is available at the time of starting the backup.
321
Possible values: Any integer number between 0 and 100 Default value: 50 If this setting is 0, the snapshot storage will not be created. The initial size will not exceed the available space minus 50 MB. Without the snapshot storage, taking snapshots is still possible. The size of the snapshot storage does not affect the size of the backup.
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node
Connection parameters
Remote Agent ports Specifies the port that the component will use for incoming and outgoing communication with other Acronis components. Select one of the following: Not Configured The component will use the default TCP port number 9876. Enabled The component will use the specified port; type the port number in the Server TCP Port box. Disabled The same as Not configured. Client Encryption options Specifies whether to encrypt the transferred data when the component acts as a client application, and whether to trust self-signed SSL certificates. Select one of the following: Not Configured The component will use the default settings, which is to use encryption if possible and to trust self-signed SSL certificates (see the following option). Enabled Encryption is enabled. In Encryption, select one of the following: Enabled Data transfer will be encrypted if encryption is enabled on the server application, otherwise it will be unencrypted. Disabled Encryption is disabled; any connection to a server application which requires encryption will not be established. Required Data transfer will be performed only if encryption is enabled on the server application (see "Server Encryption options"); it will be encrypted.
322
Authentication parameters Selecting the Trust self-signed certificates check box allows the client to connect to the server applications that use self-signed SSL certificates such as certificates created during the installation of Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 componentssee SSL certificates (p. 74). You should keep this check box selected, unless you have a Public Key Infrastructure (PKI) in your environment. In Use Agent Certificate Authentication, select one of the following: Do not use The use of SSL certificates is disabled. Any connection to a server application which requires the use of SSL certificates will not be established. Use if possible The use of SSL certificates is enabled. The client will use SSL certificates if their use is enabled on the server application, and will not use them otherwise. Always use The use of SSL certificates is enabled. The connection will be established only if the use of SSL certificates is enabled on the server application. Disabled The same as Not configured. Server Encryption options Specifies whether to encrypt the transferred data when the component acts as a server application. Select one of the following: Not Configured The component will use the default setting, which is to use encryption if possible (see the following option). Enabled Encryption is enabled. In Encryption, select one of the following: Enabled Data transfer will be encrypted if encryption is enabled on the client application, otherwise it will be unencrypted. Disabled Encryption is disabled; any connection to a client application which requires encryption will not be established. Required Data transfer will be performed only if encryption is enabled on the client application (see "Client Encryption options"); it will be encrypted. Authentication parameters In Use Agent Certificate Authentication, select one of the following: Do not use The use of SSL certificates is disabled. Any connection to a client application which requires the use of SSL certificates will not be established. Use if possible The use of SSL certificates is enabled. The server will use SSL certificates if their use is enabled on the client application, and will not use them otherwise.
323
Always use The use of SSL certificates is enabled. The connection will be established only if the use of SSL certificates is enabled on the client application. Disabled The same as Not configured.
3 4 5
Event tracing parameters are specified as the following settings in the administrative template: File Trace Minimal Level Description: Specifies the minimum severity level of events to be recorded in the file. Only events of levels greater than or equal to File Trace Minimal Level will be recorded. Possible values: Any severity level from Unknown through Critical, or Blocked to not record any events Default value: 2 (meaning that events with severity levels two through five will be recorded) The log files are located inside the folder %ALLUSERSPROFILE%\Application Data\Acronis, in the Logs subfolder for the particular component. Win32 Trace Minimal Level Description: Specifies the minimum severity level of events to be recorded in the System event log. Only events of levels greater than or equal to Win32 Trace Minimal Level will be recorded. Possible values: Any severity level from Unknown through Critical, or Blocked to not record any events Default value: 4 (meaning that events about errors and critical errors will be recorded) Customer Experience Program
324
Specifies whether the machine where the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 component is installed will participate in the Customer Experience Program. Select one of the following: Not Configured By default, the machine does not participate in the Customer Experience Program. Enabled In Enable sending reports to Acronis, select one of the following: Enable Information about the hardware configuration, the most and least used features and about any problems will be automatically collected from the machine and sent to Acronis on a regular basis. The end results are intended to provide software improvements and enhanced functionality to better meet the needs of Acronis customers. Acronis does not collect any personal data. The terms of participation can be found on the Acronis Web site. Disable The information will not be sent. Disabled The same as Not configured.
7.2.2
The following parameters can be set through the graphical user interface (GUI): For Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server: Collecting Logs, Windows Event Log, SNMP, SNMP Address, and SNMP Community For Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent: Windows Event Log, SNMP, SNMP Address, SNMP Community and Customer Experience Program
You will find the description of these parameters in the correspondent topic about configuration through the administrative template.
7.2.3
The following two parameters determine paths to Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node's internal databases, which contain information about managed vaults. They can be modified only by editing the registry.
When to modify
While the database located in the folder determined by DatabasePath is typically small, the tape database, located at TapeDatabasePath, may be large if the tape library contains thousands of archives, and you may want to store the tape database on a volume other that the system volume.
Parameters
Important: We do not recommend modifying th ese pa rameters. If you do need to modify either of th em, you should do this before creating any correspondent (tape o r non-tape) managed vaults. Otherwise, the storage node will lose a ccess to those vaults un til you re-a tta ch them, and re-attaching a vaultesp ecially a deduplicating onemay take a consid erable a mount of time.
DatabasePath Description: Specifies the folder where Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node stores its non-tape vaults database.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 325
This database contains a list of vaults that are managed by the storage node, other than tape vaults (see the next parameter). Its typical size does not exceed a few kilobytes. Possible values: Any string 0 to 32765 characters long Default value: C:\Program Files\Acronis\StorageNode Registry key: HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Acronis\ASN\Configuration\StorageNode\DatabasePath TapesDatabasePath Description: Specifies the folder where Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node stores its tape vaults database. This database contains a list of tape vaults that are managed by the storage node. Its size depends on the number of archives stored in the tape libraries, and approximately equals 10 MB per hundred archives. Possible values: Any string 0 to 32765 characters long Default value: C:\Documents and Settings\All Users\Application Data\Acronis\BackupAndRecovery\TapeLocation\ Registry key: HKLM\SOFTWARE\Acronis\BackupAndRecovery\TapeLocation\TapesDatabasePath
7.3
A backup policy can be applied to both Windows and Linux machines. To create a backup policy, perform the following steps.
General
Policy name [Optional] Enter a unique name for the backup policy. A conscious name lets you identify the policy among the others. Source type Select the type of items to back up: Disk/volumes or Files. Policy credentials (p. 328) [Optional] You can change the policy account credentials if necessary. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box. Policy comments [Optional] Type a description of the backup policy. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
What to back up
Items to back up (p. 329) Specify which data items to back up on each machine the policy will be deployed to. On each of the machines, the agent will find the data items using the rules you specify. For example, if the selection rule is [All volumes], the entire machine will be backed up. Access credentials (p. 333) [Optional] Provide credentials for the source data if the backup policy account does not have access permissions to the data. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box. Exclusions (p. 333) [Optional] Set up exclusions for the specific types of files you do not wish to back up. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
326 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
Where to back up
Archive (p. 334) Specify the path to the location, where the backup archive will be stored, and the archive name. It is advisable that the archive name be unique within the location. The location must be available at the time when the management server starts to deploy the policy. Access credentials (p. 335) [Optional] Provide credentials for the location if the backup policy account does not have access permissions to the location. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box. Archive comments [Optional] Enter comments to the archive. To access this option, select the Advanced view check box.
How to back up
Backup scheme (p. 336) Specify when and how often to back up your data, define for how long to keep the created backup archives in the selected location, set up a schedule for the archive cleanup procedure. Use well-known optimized backup schemes, such as Grandfather-Father-Son and Tower of Hanoi, create a custom backup scheme or back up data once.
Archive validation
When to validate [Optional] Define when and how often to perform validation and whether to validate the entire archive or the latest backup in the archive.
Backup options
Settings [Optional] Configure parameters of the backup operation, such as pre/post backup commands, maximum network bandwidth allocated for the backup stream or the backup archive compression level. If you do nothing in this section, the default values (p. 85) as set in the management server, will be used. After any of the settings is changed against the default value, a new line that displays the newly set value appears. The setting status changes from Default to Custom. Should you modify the setting again, the line will display the new value unless the new value is the default one. When the default value is set, the line disappears and so you always see only the settings that differ from the default values in this section of the Create Backup Policy page. To reset all the settings to the default values, click Reset to default. During the backup operation, the registered machines' default backup options are ignored.
Convert to VM
Applies to: Disk/volume backup Not effective for machines running Linux By setting up regular conversion, you obtain a copy of your server or workstation on a virtual machine which can be readily powered on in case the original machine fails. The conversion can be performed by any machine that is registered on the management server and has Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent with the corresponding functionality. The archive has to be stored in a shared location, such as a network folder or a managed vault, so that the selected machine can access the archive.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 327
When to convert (p. 198) [Optional] Specify whether to convert every full, every incremental or every differential backup or convert the last created backup on schedule. Specify the conversion schedule if required. Host (p. 198) Specify the machine that will perform the conversion. The machine has to have Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows, Agent for ESX/ESXi or Agent for Hyper-V installed. Virtualization server (p. 198) Here you select the resulting virtual machine type and location. Available options depend on the host you selected in the previous step. Storage (p. 198) Choose the storage on the virtualization server or the folder to place the virtual machine files in. Resultant VMs Specify a name for the virtual machines to be created. The default name consists of variables that reflect the policy name and the name of the machine that will be backed up. You can add suffixes to the name but never delete variables, since each virtual machine has to have a distinct and unique name. Folder on VMware vCenter If the management server is integrated with vCenter Server, the resultant virtual machines will appear in the Acronis Backups folder on the vCenter. You can specify a subfolder for the machines resulting from execution of the policy. After you have performed all the required steps, click OK to create the backup policy.
7.3.1
Policy credentials
Provide the credentials under which the centralized tasks will run on the machines.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Use Acronis service credentials The tasks will run under the Acronis service account, whether started manually or executed on schedule. Use the following credentials The tasks will run under the credentials you specify, whether started manually or executed on schedule. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
Password. The password for the account. 2. Click OK. To learn more about Acronis service credentials, see the Rights for Acronis services (p. 69) section. To learn more about operations available depending on the user privileges, see the User privileges on a managed machine (p. 30) section.
328
7.3.2
Items to back up
Specify selection rules for backing up items, selected in the Source type field of the General section. Volumes to back up selection rules (p. 329) Files to back up selection rules (p. 332)
Windows volumes Volume C: System volume Type C:\ or select it from the list Type or select: [SYSTEM] The system volume contains the hardwarespecific files that are needed to start Windows, such as Ntldr, Boot.ini, and Ntdetect.com. There is only one system volume even if multiple Windows operating systems are installed on the computer. For more details, see "Note on Windows machines" below. Boot volume Type or select: [BOOT] Refers to the registered machine's boot volume. The boot volume contains the Windows folder and the supporting files for the Windows operating system (typically located in the Windows\System32 folder). It may or may not be the same as the system volume. If multiple operating systems are installed on the computer, this is the boot volume of the operating system in which the agent is working. For more details, see "Note on Windows machines" below.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 329
Refers to all volumes other than removable media. Fixed volumes include volumes on SCSI, ATAPI, ATA, SSA, SAS and SATA devices, and on RAID arrays.
Linux volumes First partition on the first IDE hard disk of a Linux machine Type or select: /dev/hda1 hda1 is the standard device name for the first partition of the first IDE hard disk drive. For more details, see "Note on Linux machines" below. sda1 is the standard device name for the first partition of the first SCSI hard disk drive. For more details, see "Note on Linux machines" below. md1 is the standard device name for the first partition of the first software RAID drive. For more details, see "Note on Linux machines" below.
First partition on the Type or select: /dev/sda1 first SCSI hard disk of a Linux machine First partition on the first software RAID hard disk of a Linux machine Type or select: /dev/md1
What does a disk or volume backup store? For supported file systems, a disk or volume backup stores only those sectors that contain data. This reduces the resulting backup size and speeds up the backup and recovery operations. Windows The swap file (pagefile.sys) and the file that keeps the RAM content when the machine goes into hibernation (hiberfil.sys) are not backed up. After recovery, the files will be re-created in the appropriate place with the zero size. A volume backup stores all other files and folders of the selected volume independent of their attributes (including hidden and system files), the boot record, the file allocation table (FAT) if it exists, the root and the zero track of the hard disk with the master boot record (MBR). The boot code of GPT volumes is not backed up. A disk backup stores all volumes of the selected disk (including hidden volumes such as the vendor's maintenance partitions) and the zero track with the master boot record. Linux A volume backup stores all files and folders of the selected volume independent of their attributes, a boot record and the file system super block. A disk backup stores all disk volumes as well as the zero track with the master boot record. Volumes with unsupported file systems will be backed up sector-by-sector. Note on Windows machines Windows operating systems prior to Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2 keep system files and the loader on the same volume, unless a different volume has been specified during the system installation. If Windows files and the loader are on the same volume, selecting either [SYSTEM] or [BOOT] is enough to back up the entire operating system. Otherwise select both [SYSTEM] and [BOOT].
330 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
Operating systems starting from Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2 create a dedicated system volume called System Reserved. If you select [SYSTEM], only this dedicated volume will be backed up. Always select both [SYSTEM] and [BOOT] when backing up machines running these operating systems. Since backup policies are commonly applied to multiple machines with various operating systems, Acronis recommends that you always select both the system and the boot volumes for backup, to ensure the integrity of every operating system. Note on Linux machines You can include both Windows and Linux volumes (partitions) in one centralized backup policy. For instance, it is possible to set up a policy to back up volume C: on Windows machines and partition /dev/hda1 on Linux machines. Unlike Windows, there is no clear distinction between a volume (partition) and a folder (directory) in Linux. Linux has the root partition (denoted as /), to which elements of various typesincluding hard disks, directories, and system devicesare attached (mounted), forming a tree similar to the file and folder structure in Windows. For example, let a Linux machine contain a hard disk which is split into three volumes, or partitions: the first, second, and third partitions. These partitions are available in the tree as /dev/hda1, /dev/hda2, and /dev/hda3, respectively. To perform a disk backup of the, say, third partition, one can type /dev/hda3 in the row of the Volumes to back up selection rules dialog box. Furthermore, a Linux partition can be mounted anywhere inside the tree. Say, /dev/hda3, can be mounted as a subdirectory inside the tree, such as /home/usr/docs. In this case, one can type either /dev/hda3 or /home/usr/docs in the Volume field to perform a disk backup of the third partition. In general, when setting up a centralized policy to perform volume backups of Linux machines, make sure that the paths entered in the Volume field correspond to partitions (such as /dev/hda2 or /home/usr/docs in the previous example), and not to directories.
Disk type; hd for IDE drives, sd for SCSI drives, md for software RAID drives (for example, dynamic volumes); Disk number; a for the first disk, b for the second disk, etc.; Partition number on the disk; 1 for the first partition, 2 for the second partition, etc.
To guarantee backing up selected disks regardless of their type, consider including three entries in the Volumes to back up selection rules dialog box, one for each possible type. For example, to back up the first hard disk of each Linux machine under a centralized policy, you may want to type the following lines in the Volume field: /dev/hda1 /dev/sda1
331
/dev/mda1
Windows
Full path Point to the folders and files to be backed up. If you specified a path to a file or folder explicitly, the policy will back up this item on each machine where this exact path will be found.
To include File Text.doc in folder D:\Work Folder C:\Windows In the Files and folders column, type or select: D:\Work\Text.doc C:\Windows
Environment variables Some environment variables point to Windows folders. Using such variables instead of full folder and file paths ensures that proper Windows folders are backed up regardless of where Windows is located on a particular machine.
To include Program Files folder Windows folder In the Files and folders column, type or select %PROGRAMFILES% %WIN DIR% Comments Points to the Program Files folder (for example, C:\Program Files) Points to the folder where Windows is located (for example, C:\Windows) Points to the folder where the common data of all user profiles is located (typically, C:\Documents and Settings\All Users in Windows XP and C:\ProgramData in Windows Vista)
You can use other environment variables or a combination of environment variables and text. For example, to refer to the Acronis folder in the machines' Program Files folder, type: %PROGRAMFILES%\Acronis Templates Templates are similar to environment variables, but are already pre-customized.
To include In the Files and folders column, type or select: Comments
332
All files on all volumes on [All Files] a machine All user profiles existing on a machine [All Profiles Folder]
Points to all files on all volumes of the machine. Points to the folder where all user profiles are located (typically, C:\Documents and Settings in Windows XP, and C:\Users in Windows Vista).
Linux
To include Text file file.txt on the volume /dev/hda3 mounted on /home/usr/docs Home directory of the common users The root user's home directory Directory for all userrelated programs Directory for system configuration files In the Files and folders column, type or select: /dev/hda3/file.txt or /home/usr/docs/file.txt /home /root /usr /etc
7.3.3
Specify credentials required for access to the data you are going to back up.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Use the policy credentials The program will access the source data using the credentials of the backup policy account specified in the General section. Use the following credentials The program will access the source data using the credentials you specify. Use this option if the policy credentials do not have access permissions to the data. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain) Password. The password for the account. 2. Click OK.
7.3.4
Exclusions
Set up exclusions for the specific types of files you do not wish to back up. For example, you may not want database, hidden and system files and folders, as well as files with specific extensions, to be stored in the archive.
Exclude all hidden files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the Hidden attribute. If a folder is Hidden, all of its contents including files that are not Hidden will be excluded. Exclude all system files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the System attribute. If a folder is System, all of its contents including files that are not System will be excluded.
You can view file or folder a ttributes in the file/folder properties or by using th e attrib command. For more information, refer to the Help and Support Cen ter in Windows.
Exclude files matching the following criteria Select this check box to skip files whose names match any of the criteria called file masks in the list; use the Add, Edit, Remove and Remove All buttons to create the list of file masks. You can use one or more wildcard characters * and ? in a file mask: The asterisk (*) substitutes for zero or more characters in a file name; for example, the file mask Doc*.txt yields files such as Doc.txt and Document.txt The question mark (?) substitutes for exactly one character in a file name; for example, the file mask Doc?.txt yields files such as Doc1.txt and Docs.txt but not the files Doc.txt or Doc11.txt
Exclusion examples
Criterion By name By path Mask (*) Mask (?) Example File1.log C:\Finance\test.log *.log my???.log Description Excludes all files named File1.log. Excludes the file named test.log located in the folder C:\Finance Excludes all files with the .log extension. Excludes all .log files with names consisting of five symbols and starting with my.
7.3.5
Archive
Specify where to store the archives and define names for the new backup archives.
To store archives in a centralized vault, expand the Centralized group and click the vault. To store archives on a network share, expand the Network folders group, then select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder. If the network share requires access credentials, the program will ask for them. To store archives on an FTP or SFTP server, expand the corresponding group and reach the appropriate server, then select the folder that will be used for storing archives.
According to the original FTP specifica tion, cred entials required for a ccess to FTP servers are transferred through a netwo rk as plaintext. This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer.
334
Enter the full path to the folder in the Path field. This path will be created on each machine the policy will be applied to.
Store each machine's archive in the machine's Acronis Secure Zone Acronis Secure Zone has to be created on each machine the policy will be applied to. For information on how to create Acronis Secure Zone, see the Creating Acronis Secure Zone (p. 231) section.
7.3.6
Specify credentials required for access to the location where the backup archive will be stored. The user name of these credentials will be considered as the archive owner.
To specify credentials
1. Select one of the following:
Use the policy credentials The program will access the location using the credentials of the backup policy specified in the General section. Use the following credentials The program will access the location using the credentials you specify. Use this option if the policy credentials do not have access permissions to the location. You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node. Specify:
User name. When entering the name of an Active Directory user account, be sure to also specify the domain name (DOMAIN\Username or Username@domain)
335
7.3.7
Choose one of the available backup schemes: Back up now to create a backup task for manual start and run the task immediately after its creation. Back up later to create a backup task for manual start OR schedule one-time task execution in the future. Simple to schedule when and how often to backup data and specify retention rules. Grandfather-Father-Son to use the Grandfather-Father-Son backup scheme. The scheme does not allow data to be backed up more than once a day. You set the days of week when the daily backup will be performed and select from these days the day of weekly/monthly backup. Then you set the retention periods for the daily (referred to as "sons"), weekly (referred to as "fathers") and monthly (referred to as "grandfathers") backups. The expired backups will be deleted automatically. Tower of Hanoi to use the Tower of Hanoi backup scheme, where you schedule when and how often to back up (sessions) and select the number of backup levels (up to 16). In this scheme, the data can be backed up more than once a day. By setting up the backup schedule and selecting backup levels, you automatically obtain the rollback period the guaranteed number of sessions that you can go back at any time. The automatic cleanup mechanism maintains the required rollback period by deleting the expired backups and keeping the most recent backups of each level. Custom to create a custom scheme, where you are free to set up a backup strategy in the way your enterprise needs it most: specify multiple schedules for different backup types, add conditions and specify the retention rules.
336
Select this check box, if you do not need to put the backup task on a schedule and wish to start it manually afterwards.
Simple scheme
With the simple backup scheme you just schedule when and how often to back up data and set the retention rule. At the first time a full backup will be created. The next backups will be incremental. To set up the simple backup scheme, specify the appropriate settings as follows.
Backup Set up the backup schedule - when and how often to back up the data. To learn more about setting up the schedule, see the Scheduling (p. 152) section. Retention rule With the simple scheme, only one retention rule (p. 37) is available. Set the retention period for the backups.
Grandfather-Father-Son scheme
At a glance
Daily incremental, weekly differential, and monthly full backups Custom day for weekly and monthly backups Custom retention periods for backups of each type
Description
Let us suppose that we want to set up a backup plan that will regularly produce a series of daily (D), weekly (W), and monthly (M) backups. Here is a natural way to do this: the following table shows a sample two-month period for such a plan.
Mo Jan 1Jan 7 Jan 8Jan 14 Jan 15Jan 21 Jan 22Jan 28 Jan 29Feb 4 Feb 5Feb 11 Feb 12Feb 18 Feb 19Feb 25 Feb 26Mar 4 D D D D D D D D D Tu D D D D D D D D D We D D D D D D D D D Th D D D D D D D D D Fr W W W M W W W M W Sa Su -
Daily backups run every workday except Friday, which is left for weekly and monthly backups. Monthly backups run every fourth Friday, and weekly backups run on all other Fridays.
Monthly ("Grandfather") backups are full; Weekly ("Father") backups are differential; Daily ("Son") backups are incremental.
Parameters
You can set up the following parameters of a Grandfather-Father-Son (GFS) scheme.
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 337
Specifies when to start a backup. The default value is 12:00 PM. Specifies the days on which to perform a backup. The default value is Workdays. Specifies which of the days selected in the Back up on field you want to reserve for weekly and monthly backups. A monthly backup will be performed every fourth such day. The default value is Friday. Specifies how long you want the backups to be stored in the archive. A term can be set in hours, days, weeks, months, or years. For monthly backups, you can also select Keep indefinitely if you want them to be saved forever. The default values for each backup type are as follows. Daily: 7 days (recommended minimum) Weekly: 4 weeks Monthly: indefinitely The retention period for weekly backups must exceed that for daily backups; the monthly backups' retention period must be greater than the weekly backups' retention period. We recommend setting a retention period of at least one week for daily backups.
Keep backups:
Advanced settings:
To specify Advanced scheduling settings (p. 159), click Change in the Advanced settings area.
At all times, a backup is no t deleted until all ba ckups that directly dep end on it beco me subject to deletion as well. This is why you might see a weekly o r a monthly ba ckup remain in the a rchive for a few days past its expected expira tion date. If the schedule starts with a daily or a weekly ba ckup, a full backup is created instead.
Examples
Each day of the past week, each week of the past month
Let us consider a GFS backup scheme that many may find useful.
Back up files every day, including weekends Be able to recover files as of any date over the past seven days Have access to weekly backups of the past month Keep monthly backups indefinitely. Start backup at: 11:00 PM Back up on: All days Weekly/monthly: Saturday (for example) Keep backups: Daily: 1 week
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
338
As a result, an archive of daily, weekly, and monthly backups will be created. Daily backups will be available for seven days since creation. For instance, a daily backup of Sunday, January 1, will be available through next Sunday, January 8; the first weekly backup, the one of Saturday, January 7, will be stored on the system until February 7. Monthly backups will never be deleted.
Limited storage
If you do not want to arrange a vast amount of space to store a huge archive, you may set up a GFS scheme so as to make your backups more short-lived, at the same time ensuring that your information can be recovered in case of an accidental data loss. Suppose that you need to:
Perform backups at the end of each working day Be able to recover an accidentally deleted or inadvertently modified file if this has been discovered relatively quickly Have access to a weekly backup for 10 days after it was created Keep monthly backups for half a year. Start backup at: 6:00 PM Back up on: Workdays Weekly/monthly: Friday Keep backups: Daily: 1 week
With this scheme, you will have a week to recover a previous version of a damaged file from a daily backup; as well as 10-day access to weekly backups. Each monthly full backup will be available for six months since the creation date.
Work schedule
Suppose you are a part-time financial consultant and work in a company on Tuesdays and Thursdays. On these days, you often make changes to your financial documents, statements, and update the spreadsheets etc. on your laptop. To back up this data, you may want to:
Track changes to the financial statements, spreadsheets, etc. performed on Tuesdays and Thursdays (daily incremental backup). Have a weekly summary of file changes since last month (Friday weekly differential backup). Have a monthly full backup of your files.
Moreover, assume that you want to retain access to all backups, including the daily ones, for at least six months. The following GFS scheme suits such purposes:
Start backup at: 11:30 PM Back up on: Tuesday, Thursday, Friday Weekly/monthly: Friday
339
Here, daily incremental backups will be created on Tuesdays and Thursdays, with weekly and monthly backups performed on Fridays. Note that, in order to choose Friday in the Weekly/monthly field, you need to first select it in the Back up on field. Such an archive would allow you to compare your financial documents as of the first and the last day of work, and have a five-year history of all documents, etc.
No daily backups
Consider a more exotic GFS scheme:
Start backup at: 12:00 PM Back up on: Friday Weekly/monthly: Friday Keep backups: Daily: 1 week Weekly: 1 month
Monthly: indefinitely
Backup is thus performed only on Fridays. This makes Friday the only choice for weekly and monthly backups, leaving no other date for daily backups. The resulting Grandfather-Father archive will hence consist only of weekly differential and monthly full backups. Even though it is possible to use GFS to create such an archive, the Custom scheme is more flexible in this situation.
Parameters
You can set up the following parameters of a Tower of Hanoi scheme.
Schedule Set up a daily (p. 153), weekly (p. 155), or monthly (p. 157) schedule. Setting up schedule parameters allows creating simple schedules (example of a simple daily schedule: a backup task will be run every 1 day at 10 AM) as well as more complex schedules (example of a complex daily schedule: a task will be run every 3 days, starting from January 15. During the specified days the task will be repeated every 2 hours from 10 AM to 10 PM). Thus, complex schedules specify the sessions on which the scheme should run. In the discussion below, "days" can be replaced with "scheduled sessions". Select from 2 to 16 backup levels. See the example stated below for details. The guaranteed number of sessions that one can go back in the archive at any time. Calculated automatically, depending on the schedule parameters and the numbers of
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
340
Example
Schedule parameters are set as follows
Number of levels: 4 This is how the first 14 days (or 14 sessions) of this scheme's schedule look. Shaded numbers denote backup levels.
1 4 2 1 3 2 4 1 5 3 6 1 7 2 8 1 9 4 10 1 11 2 12 1 13 3 14 1
Last-level (in this case, level 4) backups are full; Backups of intermediate levels (2, 3) are differential; First-level (1) backups are incremental.
A cleanup mechanism ensures that only the most recent backups of each level are kept. Here is how the archive looks on day 8, a day before creating a new full backup.
1 4 2 1 3 2 4 1 5 3 6 1 7 2 8 1
The scheme allows for efficient data storage: more backups accumulate toward the current time. Having four backups, we could recover data as of today, yesterday, half a week, or a week ago.
Roll-back period
The number of days we can go back in the archive is different on different days. The minimum number of days we are guaranteed to have is called the roll-back period. The following table shows full backup and roll-back periods for schemes of various levels.
Number of levels Full backup every On different days, can go back 1 to 2 days 2 to 5 days 4 to 11 days 8 to 23 days 16 to 47 days Roll-back period
2 3 4 5 6
Adding a level doubles the full backup and roll-back periods. To see why the number of recovery days varies, let us return to the previous example. Here are the backups we have on day 12 (numbers in gray denote deleted backups).
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010 341
1 4
2 1
3 2
4 1
5 3
6 1
7 2
8 1
9 4
10 1
11 2
12 1
A new level 3 differential backup has not yet been created, so the backup of day five is still stored. Since it depends on the full backup of day one, that backup is available as well. This enables us to go as far back as 11 days, which is the best-case scenario. The following day, however, a new third-level differential backup is created, and the old full backup is deleted.
1 4 2 1 3 2 4 1 5 3 6 1 7 2 8 1 9 4 10 1 11 2 12 1 13 3
This gives us only a four day recovery interval, which turns out to be the worst-case scenario. On day 14, the interval is five days. It increases on subsequent days before decreasing again, and so on.
1 4 2 1 3 2 4 1 5 3 6 1 7 2 8 1 9 4 10 1 11 2 12 1 13 3 14 1
The roll-back period shows how many days we are guaranteed to have even in the worst case. For a four-level scheme, it is four days.
Parameters
Parameter Full backup
When there is insufficient space while backing up The archive will be cleaned up only during backup and only if there is not enough space to create a new backup. In this case, the program will act as follows:
If there is only one full backup left and a full backup is in progress, then
delete the last full backup with all dependent incremental/differential backups
If there is only one full backup left, and an incremental or differential backup
is in progress, an error occurs saying there is a lack of available space This setting is recommended when backing up to a USB drive or Acronis Secure Zone. This setting is not applicable to managed vaults. This setting enables deletion of the last backup in the archive, in case your storage device cannot accommodate more than one backup. However, you might end up with no backups if the program is not able to create the new backup for some reason. Apply the rules (only if the retention rules are set) Specifies when to apply the retention rules (p. 37). For example, the cleanup procedure can be set up to run after each backup, and also on schedule. This option is available only if you have set at least one retention rule in Retention rules.
Specifies a schedule for archive cleanup. For example, the cleanup can be scheduled to start on the last day of each month. This option is available only if you selected On schedule in Apply the rules.
Examples
Weekly full backup
The following scheme yields a full backup performed every Friday night. Full backup: Schedule: Weekly, every Friday, at 10:00 PM Here, all parameters except Schedule in Full backup are left empty. All backups in the archive are kept indefinitely (no archive cleanup is performed).
Retention rules: Delete backups older than 12 months Apply the rules: After backing up By default, a one-year-old full backup will not be deleted until all incremental backups that depend on it become subject to deletion too. For more information, see Retention rules (p. 37).
Monthly full, weekly differential, and daily incremental backups plus cleanup
This example demonstrates the use of all options available in the Custom scheme. Suppose that we need a scheme that will produce monthly full backups, weekly differential backups, and daily incremental backups. Then the backup schedule can look as follows. Full backup: Schedule: Monthly, every Last Sunday of the month, at 9:00 PM Incremental: Schedule: Weekly, every workday, at 7:00 PM Differential: Schedule: Weekly, every Saturday, at 8:00 PM Further, we want to add conditions that have to be satisfied for a backup task to start. This is set up in the Conditions fields for each backup type. Full backup: Conditions: Location available Incremental: Conditions: User is logged off Differential: Conditions: User is idle As a result, a full backuporiginally scheduled at 9:00 PMmay actually start later: as soon as the backup location becomes available. Likewise, backup tasks for incremental and differential backups will wait until all users are logged off and users are idle, respectively. Finally, we create retention rules for the archive: let us retain only backups that are no older than six months, and let the cleanup be performed after each backup task and also on the last day of every month. Retention rules: Delete backups older than 6 months Apply the rules: After backing up, On schedule Cleanup schedule: Monthly, on the Last day of All months, at 10:00 PM By default, a backup is not deleted as long as it has dependent backups that must be kept. For example, if a full backup has become subject to deletion, but there are incremental or differential backups that depend on it, the deletion is postponed until all the dependent backups can be deleted as well. For more information, see Retention rules (p. 37).
Resulting tasks
Any custom scheme always produces three backup tasks andin case the retention rules are specifieda cleanup task. Each task is listed in the list of tasks either as Scheduled (if the schedule has been set up) or as Manual (if the schedule has not been set up). You can manually run any backup task or cleanup task at any time, regardless of whether it has a schedule.
344
In the first of the previous examples, we set up a schedule only for full backups. However, the scheme will still result in three backup tasks, enabling you to manually start a backup of any type:
Full backup, runs every Friday at 10:00 PM Incremental backup, runs manually Differential backup, runs manually
You can run any of these backup tasks by selecting it from the list of tasks in the Backup plans and tasks section in the left pane. If you have also specified the retention rules in your backup scheme, the scheme will result in four tasks: three backup tasks and one cleanup task.
7.3.8
Archive validation
Set up the validation task to check if the backed up data is recoverable. If the backup could not pass the validation successfully, the validation task fails and the backup plan gets the Error status. To set up validation, specify the following parameters 1. When to validate select when to perform the validation. As the validation is a resourceintensive operation, it makes sense to schedule the validation to the managed machine's offpeak period. On the other hand, if the validation is a major part of your data protection strategy and you prefer to be immediately informed whether the backed up data is not corrupted and can be successfully recovered, think of starting the validation right after backup creation. 2. What to validate select either to validate the entire archive or the latest backup in the archive. Validation of a file backup imitates recovery of all files from the backup to a dummy destination. Validation of a volume backup calculates a checksum for every data block saved in the backup. Validation of the archive will validate all the archives backups and may take a long time and a lot of system resources. 3. Validation schedule (appears only if you have selected the on schedule in step 1) - set the schedule of validation. For more information see the Scheduling (p. 152) section.
345
Glossary A
Acronis Active Restore
The Acronis proprietary technology that brings a system online immediately after the system recovery is started. The system boots from the backup (p. 352) and the machine becomes operational and ready to provide necessary services. The data required to serve incoming requests is recovered with the highest priority; everything else is recovered in the background. Limitations:
the backup must be located on the local drive (any device available through the BIOS except for network boot) does not work with Linux images.
enables recovery of a disk to the same disk where the disk's backup resides offers a cost-effective and handy method for protecting data from software malfunction, virus attack, operator error eliminates the need for a separate media or network connection to back up or recover the data. This is especially useful for mobile users can serve as the primary location for dual destination backup.
Limitation: Acronis Secure Zone cannot be organized on a dynamic disk (p. 352) or a disk using the GPT partitioning style. Acronis Secure Zone is considered as a personal vault (p. 356).
Agent-side cleanup
Cleanup (p. 350) performed by an agent (p. 346) according to the backup plan (p. 348) that produces the archive (p. 347). Agent-side cleanup is performed in unmanaged vaults (p. 359).
Agent-side validation
Validation (p. 359) performed by an agent (p. 346) according to the backup plan (p. 348) that produces the archive (p. 347). Agent-side validation is performed in unmanaged vaults (p. 359).
Archive
See Backup archive (p. 347).
B
Backup
The result of a single backup operation (p. 347). Physically, it is a file or a tape record that contains a copy of the backed up data as of specific date and time. Backup files created by Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 have a TIB extension. The TIB files resulting from backup consolidation (p. 351) are also called backups.
Backup operation
An operation that creates a copy of the data that exists on a machine's (p. 355) hard disk for the purpose of recovering or reverting the data to a specified date and time.
347
Backup options
Configuration parameters of a backup operation (p. 347), such as pre/post backup commands, maximum network bandwidth allotted for the backup stream or data compression level. Backup options are a part of a backup plan (p. 348).
what data to back up where to store the backup archive (p. 347) (the backup archive name and location) the backup scheme (p. 349), that includes the backup schedule and [optionally] the retention rules [optionally] the archive validation rules (p. 359) the backup options (p. 347). back up volume C: (this is the data the plan will protect) name the archive MySystemVolume and place it to \\server\backups\ (this is the backup archive name and location) perform full backup monthly on the last day of the month at 10:00AM and incremental backup on Sundays at 10:00PM. Delete backups that are older than 3 months (this is a backup scheme) validate the last backup immediately after its creation (this is a validation rule) protect the archive with a password (this is an option).
Physically, a backup plan is a bundle of tasks (p. 358) configured for execution on a managed machine (p. 355). A backup plan can be created directly on the machine (local plan) or appears on the machine as a result of a backup policy (p. 348) deployment (centralized plan (p. 350)).
348
5. On each machine, the agent installed on the machine creates a backup plan (p. 348) using other rules specified by the policy. Such backup plan is called a centralized plan (p. 350). 6. On each machine, the agent installed on the machine creates a set of centralized tasks (p. 350) that will carry out the plan.
Backup scheme
A part of the backup plan (p. 348) that includes the backup schedule and [optionally] the retention rules and the cleanup (p. 350) schedule. For example: perform full backup (p. 354) monthly on the last day of the month at 10:00AM and incremental backup (p. 355) on Sundays at 10:00PM. Delete backups that are older than 3 months. Check for such backups every time the backup operation is completed. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 provides the ability to use well-known optimized backup schemes, such as GFS (p. 354) and Tower of Hanoi (p. 358), to create a custom backup scheme or back up data once.
Bootable agent
A bootable rescue utility that includes most of the functionality of the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent (p. 346). Bootable agent is based on Linux kernel. A machine (p. 355) can be booted into a bootable agent using either bootable media (p. 349) or Acronis PXE Server. Operations can be configured and controlled either locally through the GUI or remotely using the console (p. 351).
Bootable media
A physical media (CD, DVD, USB flash drive or other media supported by a machine (p. 355) BIOS as a boot device) that contains the bootable agent (p. 349) or Windows Preinstallation Environment (WinPE) (p. 359) with the Acronis Plug-in for WinPE (p. 346). A machine can also be booted into the above environments using the network boot from Acronis PXE Server or Microsoft Remote Installation Service (RIS). These servers with uploaded bootable components can also be thought of as a kind of bootable media. Bootable media is most often used to:
recover an operating system that cannot start access and back up the data that has survived in a corrupted system deploy an operating system on bare metal create basic or dynamic volumes (p. 354) on bare metal back up sector-by-sector a disk that has an unsupported file system back up offline any data that cannot be backed up online because of restricted access, being permanently locked by the running applications or for any other reason.
Built-in group
A group of machines that always exists on a management server (p. 356). A management server has two built-in groups that contain all machines of each type: All physical machines (p. 356), All virtual machines (p. 359). Built-in groups cannot be deleted, moved to other groups or manually modified. Custom groups cannot be created within built-in groups. There is no way to remove a physical machine from the
349
built-in group except for deleting the machine from the management server. Virtual machines are deleted as a result of their host server deletion. A backup policy (p. 348) can be applied to a built-in group.
C
Centralized backup plan
A backup plan (p. 348) that appears on the managed machine (p. 355) as a result of deploying a backup policy (p. 348) from the management server (p. 356). Such plan can be modified only by editing the backup policy.
Centralized management
Management of the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 infrastructure through a central management unit known as Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server (p. 356). The centralized management operations include:
creating, applying and managing backup policies (p. 348) creating and managing static (p. 357) and dynamic groups (p. 353) of machines (p. 355) managing the tasks (p. 358) existing on the machines creating and managing centralized vaults (p. 350) for storing archives managing storage nodes (p. 357) monitoring activities of the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components, viewing the centralized log and more.
Centralized task
A task (p. 358) belonging to a centralized backup plan (p. 350). Such task appears on the managed machine (p. 355) as a result of deploying a backup policy (p. 348) from the management server (p. 356) and can be modified only by editing the backup policy.
Centralized vault
A networked location allotted by the management server (p. 356) administrator to serve as storage for the backup archives (p. 347). A centralized vault can be managed by a storage node (p. 357) or be unmanaged. The total number and size of archives stored in a centralized vault are limited by the storage size only. As soon as the management server administrator creates a centralized vault, the vault name and path to the vault are distributed to all machines registered (p. 357) on the server. The shortcut to the vault appears on the machines in the Centralized vaults list. Any backup plan (p. 348) existing on the machines, including local plans, can use the centralized vault. On a machine that is not registered on the management server, a user having the privilege to back up to the centralized vault can do so by specifying the full path to the vault. If the vault is managed, the user's archives will be managed by the storage node as well as other archives stored in the vault.
Cleanup
Deleting backups (p. 347) from a backup archive (p. 347) in order to get rid of outdated backups or prevent the archive from exceeding the desired size.
350 Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
Cleanup consists in applying to an archive the retention rules set by the backup plan (p. 348) that produces the archive. This operation checks if the archive has exceeded its maximum size and/or for expired backups. This may or may not result in deleting backups depending on whether the retention rules are violated or not. For more information please refer to Retention rules (p. 37).
Consolidation
Combining two or more subsequent backups (p. 347) belonging to the same archive (p. 347) into a single backup. Consolidation might be needed when deleting backups, either manually or during cleanup (p. 350). For example, the retention rules require to delete a full backup (p. 354) that has expired but retain the next incremental (p. 355) one. The backups will be combined into a single full backup which will be dated with the incremental backup's date. Since consolidation may take a lot of time and system resources, retention rules provide an option to not delete backups with dependencies. In our example, the full backup will be retained until the incremental one also becomes obsolete. Then both backups will be deleted.
D
Deduplicating vault
A managed vault (p. 355) in which deduplication (p. 351) is enabled.
Deduplication
A method of storing different duplicates of the same information only once. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 can apply the deduplication technology to backup archives (p. 347) stored on storage nodes (p. 357). This minimizes storage space taken by the archives, backup traffic and network usage during backup.
Differential backup
A differential backup stores changes to the data against the latest full backup (p. 354). You need access to the corresponding full backup to recover the data from a differential backup.
Direct management
Any management operation that is performed on a managed machine (p. 355) using the direct console (p. 351)-agent (p. 346) connection (as opposed to centralized management (p. 350) when the
351
operations are configured on the management server (p. 356) and propagated by the server to the managed machines). The direct management operations include:
creating and managing local backup plans (p. 355) creating and managing local tasks (p. 355), such as recovery tasks creating and managing personal vaults (p. 356) and archives stored there viewing the state, progress and properties of the centralized tasks (p. 350) existing on the machine viewing and managing the log of the agent's operations disk management operations, such as clone a disk, create volume, convert volume.
A kind of direct management is performed when using bootable media (p. 349). Some of the direct management operations can also be performed via the management server GUI. This presumes, however, either an explicit or an implicit direct connection to the selected machine.
Disk group
A number of dynamic disks (p. 352) that store the common configuration data in their LDM databases and therefore can be managed as a whole. Normally, all dynamic disks created within the same machine (p. 355) are members of the same disk group. As soon as the first dynamic disk is created by the LDM or another disk management tool, the disk group name can be found in the registry key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Services\dmio\Boot Info\Primary Disk Group\Name. The next created or imported disks are added to the same disk group. The group exists until at least one of its members exists. Once the last dynamic disk is disconnected or converted to basic, the group is discontinued, though its name is kept in the above registry key. In case a dynamic disk is created or connected again, a disk group with an incremental name is created. When moved to another machine, a disk group is considered as foreign and cannot be used until imported into the existing disk group. The import updates the configuration data on both the local and the foreign disks so that they form a single entity. A foreign group is imported as is (will have the original name) if no disk group exists on the machine. For more information about disk groups please refer to the following Microsoft knowledge base article: 222189 Description of Disk Groups in Windows Disk Management http://support.microsoft.com/kb/222189/EN-US/
352
Dynamic disk
A hard disk managed by Logical Disk Manager (LDM) that is available in Windows starting with Windows 2000. LDM helps flexibly allocate volumes on a storage device for better fault tolerance, better performance or larger volume size. A dynamic disk can use either the master boot record (MBR) or GUID partition table (GPT) partition style. In addition to MBR or GPT, each dynamic disk has a hidden database where the LDM stores the dynamic volumes' configuration. Each dynamic disk holds the complete information about all dynamic volumes existing in the disk group which makes for better storage reliability. The database occupies the last 1MB of an MBR disk. On a GPT disk, Windows creates the dedicated LDM Metadata partition, taking space from the Microsoft Reserved Partition (MSR.)
Disk 1 MBR LDM database
Disk 2
1 MB GPT
For more information about dynamic disks please refer to the following Microsoft knowledge base articles: Disk Management (Windows XP Professional Resource Kit) http://technet.microsoft.com/enus/library/bb457110.aspx 816307 Best practices for using dynamic disks on Windows Server 2003-based computers http://support.microsoft.com/kb/816307
Dynamic group
A group of machines (p. 355) which is populated automatically by the management server (p. 356) according to membership criteria specified by the administrator. Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 offers the following membership criteria:
A machine remains in a dynamic group as long as the machine meets the group's criteria. The machine is removed from the group automatically as soon as
the machine's properties change so that the machine does not meet the criteria anymore OR the administrator changes the criteria so that the machine does not meet them anymore.
There is no way to remove a machine from a dynamic group manually except for deleting the machine from the management server.
353
Dynamic volume
Any volume located on dynamic disks (p. 352), or more precisely, on a disk group (p. 352). Dynamic volumes can span multiple disks. Dynamic volumes are usually configured depending on the desired goal:
to increase the volume size (a spanned volume) to reduce the access time (a striped volume) to achieve fault tolerance by introducing redundancy (mirrored and RAID-5 volumes.)
E
Encrypted archive
A backup archive (p. 347) encrypted according to the Advanced Encryption Standard (AES). When the encryption option and a password for the archive are set in the backup options (p. 347), each backup belonging to the archive is encrypted by the agent (p. 346) before saving the backup to its destination. The AES cryptographic algorithm operates in the Cipher-block chaining (CBC) mode and uses a randomly generated key with a user-defined size of 128, 192 or 256 bits. The encryption key is then encrypted with AES-256 using a SHA-256 hash of the password as a key. The password itself is not stored anywhere on the disk or in the backup file; the password hash is used for verification purposes. With this two-level security, the backup data is protected from any unauthorized access, but recovering a lost password is not possible.
Encrypted vault
A managed vault (p. 355) to which anything written is encrypted and anything read is decrypted transparently by the storage node (p. 357), using a vault-specific encryption key stored on the node. In case the storage medium is stolen or accessed by an unauthorized person, the malefactor will not be able to decrypt the vault contents without access to the storage node. Encrypted archives (p. 354) will be encrypted over the encryption performed by the agent (p. 346).
Export
An operation that creates a copy of an archive (p. 347) or a self-sufficient part copy of an archive in the location you specify. The export operation can be applied to a single archive, a single backup (p. 347) or to your choice of backups belonging to the same archive. An entire vault (p. 359) can be exported by using the command line interface.
F
Full backup
A self-sufficient backup (p. 347) containing all data chosen for backup. You do not need access to any other backup to recover the data from a full backup.
354
G
GFS (Grandfather-Father-Son)
A popular backup scheme (p. 349) aimed to maintain the optimal balance between a backup archive (p. 347) size and the number of recovery points (p. 356) available from the archive. GFS enables recovering with daily resolution for the last several days, weekly resolution for the last several weeks and monthly resolution for any time in the past. For more information please refer to GFS backup scheme (p. 31).
I
Image
The same as Disk backup (p. 352).
Incremental backup
A backup (p. 347) that stores changes to the data against the latest backup. You need access to other backups from the same archive (p. 347) to restore data from an incremental backup.
L
Local backup plan
A backup plan (p. 348) created on a managed machine (p. 355) using direct management (p. 351).
Local task
A task (p. 358) belonging to a local backup plan (p. 355) or a task that does not belong to any plan, such as a recovery task. A local task belonging to a backup plan can be modified by editing the plan only; other local tasks can be modified directly.
M
Machine
A physical or virtual computer uniquely identified by an operating system installation. Machines with multiple operating systems (multi-boot systems) are considered as multiple machines.
Managed machine
A machine (p. 355), either physical or virtual, where at least one Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent (p. 346) is installed.
Managed vault
A centralized vault (p. 350) managed by a storage node (p. 357). Archives (p. 347) in a managed vault can be accessed as follows: bsp://node_address/vault_name/archive_name/
355
Physically, managed vaults can reside on a network share, SAN, NAS, on a hard drive local to the storage node or on a tape library locally attached to the storage node. The storage node performs storage node-side cleanup (p. 357) and storage node-side validation (p. 358) for each archive stored in the managed vault. An administrator can specify additional operations that the storage node will perform (deduplication (p. 351), encryption). Any managed vault is self-contained, that is, contains all metadata the storage node needs to manage the vault. In case the storage node is lost or its database is corrupted, the new storage node retrieves the metadata and re-creates the database. When the vault is attached to another storage node, the same procedure takes place.
a single entry point to the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 infrastructure an easy way to protect data on numerous machines (p. 355) using backup policies (p. 348) and grouping enterprise-wide monitoring functionality the ability to create centralized vaults (p. 350) for storing enterprise backup archives (p. 347) the ability to manage storage nodes (p. 357).
If there are multiple management servers on the network, they operate independently, manage different machines and use different centralized vaults for storing archives.
Media builder
A dedicated tool for creating bootable media (p. 349).
P
Personal vault
A local or networked vault (p. 359) created using direct management (p. 351). Once a personal vault is created, a shortcut to it appears under the Personal vaults item of the Navigation pane. Multiple machines can use the same physical location; for example, a network share; as a personal vault.
Physical machine
On Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server, a physical machine is the same as a registered machine (p. 357). A virtual machine is considered physical if an Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent is installed on the machine and the machine is registered on the management server.
Plan
See Backup plan (p. 348).
Policy
See Backup policy (p. 348).
356
R
Recovery point
Date and time to which the backed up data can be reverted to.
Registered machine
A machine (p. 355) managed by a management server (p. 356). A machine can be registered on only one management server at a time. A machine becomes registered as a result of the registration (p. 357) procedure.
Registration
A procedure that adds a managed machine (p. 355) to a management server (p. 356). Registration sets up a trust relationship between the agent (p. 346) residing on the machine and the server. During registration, the console retrieves the management server's client certificate and passes it to the agent which uses it later to authenticate clients attempting to connect. This helps prevent any attempts by network attackers from establishing a fake connection on behalf of a trusted principal (the management server).
S
Selection rule
A part of the backup policy (p. 348). Enables the management server (p. 356) administrator to select the data to back up within a machine.
Static group
A group of machines which a management server (p. 356) administrator populates by manually adding machines to the group. A machine remains in a static group until the administrator removes it from the group or from the management server.
relieve managed machines (p. 355) of unnecessary CPU load by using the storage node-side cleanup (p. 357) and storage node-side validation (p. 358) drastically reduce backup traffic and storage space taken by the archives (p. 347) by using deduplication (p. 351) prevent access to the backup archives, even in case the storage medium is stolen or accessed by a malefactor, by using encrypted vaults (p. 354).
Since the cleanup schedule exists on the machine (p. 355) the agent (p. 346) resides on, and therefore uses the machines time and events, the agent has to initiate the storage node-side cleanup every time the scheduled time or event comes. To do so, the agent must be online. The following table summarizes the cleanup types used in Acronis Backup & Recovery 10.
Cleanup Agent-side Applied to: Initiated by: Performed by: Schedule set by: Retention rules set by: Archive Agent Agent Backup plan Backup plan Storage node-side Archive Agent Storage node Backup plan Backup plan
T
Task
In Acronis Backup & Recovery 10, a task is a set of sequential actions to be performed on a managed machine (p. 355) when a certain time comes or a certain event occurs. The actions are described in an xml script file. The start condition (schedule) exists in the protected registry keys.
Tower of Hanoi
A popular backup scheme (p. 349) aimed to maintain the optimal balance between a backup archive (p. 347) size and the number of recovery points (p. 356) available from the archive. Unlike the GFS (p. 354) scheme that has only three levels of recovery resolution (daily, weekly, monthly resolution), the Tower of Hanoi scheme continuously reduces the time interval between recovery points as the backup age increases. This allows for very efficient usage of the backup storage. For more information please refer to "Tower of Hanoi backup scheme (p. 35)".
U
Universal Restore (Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Universal Restore)
The Acronis proprietary technology that helps boot up Windows on dissimilar hardware or a virtual machine. The Universal Restore handles differences in devices that are critical for the operating system start-up, such as storage controllers, motherboard or chipset. The Universal Restore is not available:
358
when the machine is booted with Acronis Startup Recovery Manager (p. 346) (using F11) or
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
the image being recovered is located in Acronis Secure Zone (p. 346) or when using Acronis Active Restore (p. 346),
because these features are primarily meant for instant data recovery on the same machine. Universal Restore is not available when recovering Linux.
Unmanaged vault
Any vault (p. 359) that is not a managed vault (p. 355).
V
Validation
An operation that checks the possibility of data recovery from a backup (p. 347). Validation of a file backup imitates recovery of all files from the backup to a dummy destination. The previous product versions considered a file backup valid when the metadata contained in its header was consistent. The current method is time-consuming but much more reliable. Validation of a volume backup calculates a checksum for every data block saved in the backup. This procedure is also resource-intensive. While the successful validation means a high probability of successful recovery, it does not check all factors that influence the recovery process. If you back up the operating system, only a test recovery under the bootable media to a spare hard drive can guarantee successful recovery in the future.
Validation rules
A part of the backup plan (p. 348). Rules that define when and how often to perform validation (p. 359) and whether to validate the entire archive (p. 347) or the latest backup in the archive.
Vault
A place for storing backup archives (p. 347). A vault can be organized on a local or networked drive or detachable media, such as an external USB drive. There are no settings for limiting a vault size or the number of backups in a vault. You can limit the size of each archive using cleanup (p. 350), but the total size of archives stored in the vault is limited by the storage size only.
Virtual machine
On Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server, a machine (p. 355) is considered virtual if it can be backed up from the virtualization host without installing an agent (p. 346) on the machine. A virtual machine appears on the management server after registration of the virtualization server that hosts the machine, provided that Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 agent for virtual machines is installed on that server.
W
WinPE (Windows Preinstallation Environment)
A minimal Windows system based on any of the following kernels:
359
Windows Server 2003 with Service Pack 1 (PE 1.6) Windows Vista (PE 2.0) Windows Vista SP1 and Windows Server 2008 (PE 2.1).
WinPE is commonly used by OEMs and corporations for deployment, test, diagnostic and system repair purposes. A machine can be booted into WinPE via PXE, CD-ROM, USB flash drive or hard disk. The Acronis Plug-in for WinPE (p. 346) enables running the Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent (p. 346) in the preinstallation environment.
360
Index
A
A policy on a machine or a group 55 About Windows loaders 223 Access credentials 229, 230 Access credentials for archive location 189, 195 Access credentials for destination 208, 218, 234, 237 Access credentials for location 207, 211, 338, 347 Access credentials for source 188, 192, 225, 227, 233, 235, 337, 345 Acronis Active Restore 45, 48, 206, 208, 218, 360, 373 Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 87, 333 Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent for Windows 86, 330 Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components 16 Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server 80, 325 Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 overview 7 Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node 323 Acronis Plug-in for WinPE 360, 363, 374 Acronis PXE Server 257 Acronis PXE Server Installation 257 Acronis Secure Zone 45, 238, 360, 373 Acronis Secure Zone Disk 238 Acronis Secure Zone Size 238, 239 Acronis security groups 67 Acronis Startup Recovery Manager 46, 206, 241 Acronis Startup Recovery Manager (ASRM) 262, 360, 373 Acronis WOL Proxy 20, 82 Action pages 12, 13, 15
Actions on backup plans and tasks 174, 177 Actions on backup policies 276, 278 Actions on centralized vaults 53, 120, 121, 122 Actions on groups 282, 295 Actions on log entries 185, 186, 312, 313 Actions on machines 282 Actions on personal vaults 120, 151, 152 Actions on storage nodes 64, 69, 306 Actions on tasks 309 Actions with archives on tapes in a library 131 Adding a machine to another group 284, 288 Adding a machine to the management server 282, 283, 285, 301, 305 Adding a storage node 306, 307, 308 Adding machines to a group 284, 288 Adding the Acronis Plug-in to WinPE 1.x 243, 248 Adding the Acronis Plug-in to WinPE 2.x or 3.0 243, 248 Additional settings 44, 89, 107, 111, 117 Administering a managed machine 171 Administering Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server 274 Advanced scheduling settings 20, 82, 158, 160, 162, 164, 351 Agent (Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Agent) 19, 25, 50, 361, 362, 363, 365, 368, 369, 371, 372, 373, 374 Agent for Windows 16 Agent-side cleanup 361, 371 Agent-side validation 361, 372 Archive 188, 193, 338, 346, 360, 361 Archive protection 88, 89 Archive selection 207, 209, 225, 226, 229, 233, 234 Archive validation 189, 204, 358
At Windows Event Log event 165 Attaching a managed vault 123, 127
Backup splitting 88, 101 Basic concepts 8, 25, 50, 188 Basic disk cloning 260, 261 Basic precautions 259 Bootability troubleshooting 221 Bootable agent 46, 241, 360, 363 Bootable media 9, 20, 25, 102, 172, 206, 241, 242, 259, 275, 360, 363, 366, 370 Bootable Media Builder 20 Building Bart PE with Acronis Plug-in from Windows distribution 244, 250 Built-in group 55, 363
B
Back up later scheme 196, 349 Back up now scheme 196, 348 Backing up dynamic volumes (Windows) 41, 207 Backing up to tape library 132 Backup 25, 29, 361, 364, 365, 366, 368, 369, 373 Backup archive (Archive) 18, 25, 361, 362, 364, 365, 368, 369, 370, 371, 372, 373 Backup operation 361, 362 Backup options 362, 368 Backup performance 96 Backup plan (Plan) 8, 19, 25, 50, 188, 361, 362, 363, 364, 365, 369, 370, 371, 372, 373 Backup plan details 174, 178, 184, 291 Backup plan execution states 173, 174, 184, 281 Backup plan statuses 83, 173, 174, 184, 289 Backup plans and tasks 173, 190 Backup plan's credentials 188, 190 Backup policies 276 Backup policy (Policy) 18, 50, 362, 364, 365, 370, 371 Backup policy deployment states 276, 277 Backup policy statuses 276, 277, 281, 289 Backup policy's state and statuses 59, 277 Backup priority 88, 96 Backup scheme 362, 363, 369, 372 Backup scheme selection 338, 348 Backup schemes 189, 195 Backup selection 225, 227, 229, 230, 233, 235
362
C
Case to analyze 137, 138, 144 Centralized backup plan 46, 50, 362, 363, 364 Centralized log entry details 312, 315 Centralized management 50, 274, 364, 365 Centralized task 363, 364, 366 Centralized vault 18, 19, 51, 364, 369, 370 Centralized vaults 120, 309 Change volume label 266, 272 Change volume letter 266, 271 Changing disk status 266 Choosing a backup scheme 136 Choosing the operating system for disk management 259, 266 Cleanup 25, 128, 361, 363, 364, 365, 371, 373 Client and server applications 71 Cloning method and advanced options 262 Collecting system information 273 Column selection 321 Common operations 153 Communication between Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components 71
Components for centralized management 17 Compression level 88, 96 Conditions 104, 167 Configuring Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 components 321 Configuring communication settings 71, 72, 75 Configuring iSCSI and NDAS devices 251 Connecting to a machine booted from media 250 Console (Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Console) 25, 360, 363, 365 Console options 78 Consolidation 129, 361, 365 Content selection 207, 210 Create volume wizard 268 Creating a backup plan 178, 180, 188, 205, 225, 284, 292, 310 Creating a backup policy 279, 306, 337 Creating a custom static or dynamic group 284, 296, 298 Creating a managed centralized vault 123, 124, 130, 306, 307 Creating a personal vault 152 Creating a volume 266, 267 Creating Acronis Secure Zone 152, 238, 347 Creating an unmanaged centralized vault 123, 126 Creating the volume structure automatically 253 Creating the volume structure manually 253, 254 Criteria of the choice 136 Cumulative state and status of a policy 62 Custom backup scheme 38, 161, 163, 201, 355 Customer Experience Program 87
D
Daily schedule 158, 200, 307, 353 Dashboard 171, 173, 274 Data type 207, 210 Decreasing Acronis Secure Zone 240 Deduplicating vault 365 Deduplication 17, 19, 20, 51, 62, 121, 129, 365, 370, 371 Deduplication best practices 64 Deduplication ratio 65 Deduplication restrictions 63, 65 Default backup and recovery options 84, 85, 87 Default backup options 87, 189, 338 Default recovery options 109, 208 Delete volume 266, 270 Deleting Acronis Secure Zone 241 Deleting archives and backups 154, 155 Deploying and updating Agent for ESX/ESXi 83, 301, 303 Destination selection 211 Differential backup 361, 365 Direct management 51, 171, 360, 365, 369, 370 Disk backup (Image) 205, 360, 366, 369 Disk conversion basic to dynamic 261, 264 dynamic to basic 261, 264, 265 GPT to MBR 261, 264 MBR to GPT 261, 263 Disk destination 212 Disk group 41, 366, 368 Disk initialization 260, 261 Disk management 43, 207, 258 Disk operations 260 Disks 207, 211 Disks/volumes selection 210 Domain access credentials 82, 298
363
Drivers for Universal Restore 245, 247 Dual destination 45, 88, 103 Dynamic disk 41, 360, 366, 367, 368 Dynamic group 364, 367 Dynamic volume 41, 363, 368
G
Getting started 8 Getting started with a tape library 130 GFS (Grandfather-Father-Son) 363, 369, 372 GFS backup scheme 32, 128, 136, 369 GFS Example 1 138 GFS Example 2 138, 141 GFS Example 3 138, 143 Grandfather-Father-Son scheme 196, 349 Group details 281, 282, 296, 299 Grouping the registered machines 9, 53, 55, 282
E
Editing custom groups 296, 298 E-mail 89, 98, 111, 114 Encrypted archive 368 Encrypted vault 306, 368, 371 Error handling 88, 103, 111, 116 Event tracing 81, 84, 99, 115 Exclusions 188, 192, 337, 346 Export 368 Exporting archives and backups 154, 155, 231
H
Hardware 128 HDD writing speed 88, 97 How deduplication works 63 How to convert a disk backup to a virtual machine 220 How to create bootable media 243, 249 How to load Acronis Administrative Template 72, 322 How to reactivate GRUB and change its configuration 222
F
Fast incremental/differential backup 88, 100 File destination 208, 217 File-level backup snapshot 88, 94, 95 File-level security 88, 101, 102, 111, 113 Files selection 211 Files to back up selection rules 340, 343 Filtering and sorting archives 122, 151, 156 Filtering and sorting backup plans and tasks 173, 182, 293 Filtering and sorting backup policies 276, 280, 290, 300 Filtering and sorting log entries 185, 186, 312, 314 Filtering and sorting machines 282, 295 Filtering and sorting tasks 309, 311 Fits time interval 169 Fonts 79 Format volume 266, 272 Full backup 361, 363, 365, 368
I
Image 369 Importing machines from a text file 283, 287 Importing machines from Active Directory 283, 286 Increasing Acronis Secure Zone 240 Incremental backup 361, 363, 365, 369 Inheritance of policies 57 Inheritance order 290, 294, 300 Introducing Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 7
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
364
Inventory 129, 133, 149 Items to back up 188, 191, 337, 340
K
Kernel parameters 244, 245
Management server (Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Management Server) 10, 19, 50, 79, 362, 363, 364, 365, 366, 367, 370, 371 Management server administrator rights 69 Management server options 80 Managing a tape library 124, 133 Managing Acronis Secure Zone 240 Managing mounted images 231 MBR destination 214 Media builder 172, 275, 370 Media components 88, 102 Merging and moving personal vaults 153 Messenger service (WinPopup) 89, 99, 111, 114 Monthly schedule 162, 200, 307, 353 Mounting an image 228 Move one group to another 296, 298 Moving a machine to another group 284, 288 Multi-volume snapshot 88, 95
L
Labeling 133, 134 License Server 20 Limitations 129 Linux-based bootable media 243, 244, 251, 257 List of commands and utilities available in Linux-based bootable media 252, 256 Listed in txt/csv file criterion 297, 298 Local backup plan 46, 366, 369 Local task 366, 369 Location selection 225, 227, 234, 236 Location's host is available 168 Log 178, 185, 279, 281, 285, 290, 291, 300, 310, 312 Log cleanup rules 80, 86, 326, 331 Log entry details 185, 187 Logging level 80, 314
N
Network connection speed 88, 97 Network port 244, 247 Network port configuration 73, 74 Network settings 244, 246 Notifications 98, 113 NT signature 212, 214 Number of tasks 79, 311
M
Machine 18, 361, 362, 363, 364, 366, 367, 369, 370, 371, 372, 373 Machine details 281, 282, 285, 286, 289 Machine management 84, 286, 289 Machine options 83, 99, 100, 115, 116 Machines selection 279 Main area, views and action pages 10, 14 Managed machine 10, 25, 79, 360, 362, 364, 365, 369, 371, 372 Managed vault 51, 305, 365, 368, 369, 371, 372, 373 Management Console 8, 20 Management Server 8, 17
O
Operations with a machine 56 Operations with archives stored in a vault 120, 121, 151, 153 Operations with backups 120, 122, 151, 154 Operations with panes 13 Options 78 Organizational unit criterion 82, 297
365
Overview 62, 109, 120, 124, 127, 306 Overwriting 217 Owners and credentials 31, 150, 209, 226, 234, 316
Privileges for centralized management 66 Privileges for local connection 67 Privileges for remote connection in Windows 67 Proprietary Acronis technologies 45 Protecting the servers 53 Protecting the virtual machines 54 Protecting the workstations 54 PXE and DHCP on the same server 258 PXE Server 19
P
Parameters set through administrative template 322 Parameters set through GUI 336 Parameters set through Windows registry 336 Password for Acronis Secure Zone 238, 239 Pending operations 260, 261, 262, 264, 271, 272, 273 Personal vault 360, 366, 370 Personal vaults 46, 150 Physical machine 363, 370 Physical machines 281 Plan 370 Policies on machines and groups 55, 282 Policy 370 Policy credentials 337, 339 Policy deployment state on a group 61 Policy deployment state on a machine 59 Policy details 276, 279, 280, 290, 300 Policy status on a group 61 Policy status on a machine 60, 83 Pop-up messages 78 Post-backup command 92 Post-data capture command 94 Post-recovery command 112 Pre/Post commands 88, 91, 93, 111 Pre/Post data capture commands 88, 92, 95 Pre-backup command 91 Pre-data capture command 93 Pre-recovery command 112 Prerequisites 130
R
Recovering data 155, 178, 206, 220, 285, 310 Recovering from tape library 132 Recovering MD devices and logical volumes 109, 253 Recovering the storage node 224 Recovery exclusions 217, 218 Recovery point 369, 371, 372 Recovery priority 111, 113 Registered machine 79, 364, 370, 371 Registration 19, 50, 55, 84, 281, 371 Report about the archives and backups 319 Report about the backup plans 318 Report about the backup policies 317 Report about the machines 317 Report about the task activities 320 Report about the tasks 318 Report about the vaults' statistics 320 Report view 321 Reporting 316 Rescan 124, 131, 133, 150 Result confirmation 238, 239 Retention rules 38, 196, 202, 203, 204, 349, 356, 357, 358, 365 Rights for Acronis services 70, 339 RSM Media Pools 128, 129
366
Run backup plan 178, 182, 291 Running Acronis Disk Director Lite 259
Storage node (Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Storage Node) 18, 51, 364, 365, 368, 369, 370, 371, 372 Storage node details 306, 307, 308 Storage nodes 305 Storage node-side cleanup 19, 120, 305, 370, 371 Storage node-side validation 19, 120, 305, 370, 371, 372 Support for vCenter clusters 303, 304, 305 Supported file systems 21 Supported operating systems 21 Synchronizing machines with a text file 286 System requirements 23
S
Scheduling 104, 157, 196, 205, 228, 349, 359 Secure communication 71 Select destination disks 268, 269 Select the type of volume being created 268, 269 Selecting a host that will perform conversion 189, 190, 205, 339 Selecting disks and volumes 191 Selecting files and folders 192 Selecting source and target disks 262 Selection rule 60, 362, 371 Set active volume 266, 271 Set the volume options 269 Set the volume size 269, 270 Setting up a conversion schedule 189, 205, 339 Setting up a display mode 251 Setting up a machine to boot from PXE 257 Setting up centralized data protection in a heterogeneous network 9, 51 Setting up regular conversion to a virtual machine 205 Setting up SNMP services on the receiving machine 86 Simple scheme 196, 349 SNMP notifications 81, 85, 89, 100, 111, 116 Source files exclusion 88, 90 Source type 184, 188, 190, 191 SSL certificates 71, 73, 75, 334 Startup page 78 Static group 364, 371 Storage Node 9, 18, 43, 51, 306
T
Tape compatibility table 44, 128, 129, 150 Tape libraries 43, 127 Tape library as a managed vault 130 Tape planning 136, 147 Example 1 148 Example 2 149 Tape rotation 128, 136 Tape support 43, 88, 106, 128, 132, 134 Task 25, 362, 364, 369, 372 Task credentials 208, 225, 233, 234 Task details 173, 174, 178, 182, 291, 310 Task failure handling 88, 105 Task start conditions 88, 104, 157, 167, 175 Task states 173, 175, 309 Task statuses 173, 176, 309 Tasks 279, 281, 285, 290, 300, 309 Tasks need interaction 173 Technical support 23 Temporarily disabling a backup plan 153, 182
367
Time since last backup 170 Time-based alerts 79 ToH Example 1 144, 145, 148 ToH Example 2 144, 146 ToH Example 3 144, 147 Tower of Hanoi 363, 372 Tower of Hanoi backup scheme 36, 128, 136, 372 Tower of Hanoi scheme 200, 353 Types of connection to a managed machine 66 Types of dynamic volumes 267
Vault 25, 46, 240, 368, 370, 373 Vault database path 124, 125 Vault encryption 124, 125 Vault path 124, 125, 126 Vaults 41, 119, 225, 240, 307 Views 14 Virtual machine 363, 373 Virtual machine settings 212, 213, 216, 220 Virtual machine type / virtualization server selection 212, 213, 215 Virtual machines 300 Virtual machines on a management server 294, 301 VM protection options 82 VMware vCenter integration 83, 302, 303 Volume destination 212, 214 Volume operations 266 Volume properties 214 Volume selection 229, 231 Volume Shadow Copy Service 88, 92, 95 Volumes 207, 213 Volumes to back up selection rules 340
U
Understanding Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 25 Understanding centralized management 50 Understanding states and statuses 174 Universal Restore 17, 20, 208, 218, 247 Universal Restore (Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Universal Restore) 45, 47, 206, 218, 372 Unmanaged vault 361, 373 User is idle 168 User logged off 170 User privileges on a managed machine 31, 67, 68, 190, 209, 226, 234, 339 User privileges on a storage node 68, 121, 306 Using a single tape drive 44 Using the Grandfather-Father-Son tape rotation scheme 33, 137 Using the management console 8, 10 Using the Tower of Hanoi tape rotation scheme 38, 144
W
Weekly schedule 160, 200, 307, 353 What if 149 When deduplication is most effective 64 When to recover 208, 218 When to validate 225, 228 Why is the program asking for the password? 190 Windows event log 81, 84, 89, 99, 111, 115 WinPE (Windows Preinstallation Environment) 360, 363, 373 Work across subnets 258 Working under bootable media 250 Working with backup plans and tasks 177
Copyright Acronis, Inc., 2000-2010
V
Validating vaults, archives and backups 123, 152, 154, 155, 178, 224, 310 Validation 25, 128, 361, 372, 373 Validation rules 362, 373
368
369